]> code.delx.au - gnu-emacs/blob - src/xterm.c
Merge from trunk
[gnu-emacs] / src / xterm.c
1 /* X Communication module for terminals which understand the X protocol.
2
3 Copyright (C) 1989, 1993-2011 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
4
5 This file is part of GNU Emacs.
6
7 GNU Emacs is free software: you can redistribute it and/or modify
8 it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by
9 the Free Software Foundation, either version 3 of the License, or
10 (at your option) any later version.
11
12 GNU Emacs is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
13 but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
14 MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the
15 GNU General Public License for more details.
16
17 You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License
18 along with GNU Emacs. If not, see <http://www.gnu.org/licenses/>. */
19
20 /* New display code by Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>. */
21 /* Xt features made by Fred Pierresteguy. */
22
23 #include <config.h>
24 #include <signal.h>
25 #include <stdio.h>
26 #include <setjmp.h>
27
28 #ifdef HAVE_X_WINDOWS
29
30 #include "lisp.h"
31 #include "blockinput.h"
32
33 /* Need syssignal.h for various externs and definitions that may be required
34 by some configurations for calls to signal later in this source file. */
35 #include "syssignal.h"
36
37 /* This may include sys/types.h, and that somehow loses
38 if this is not done before the other system files. */
39 #include "xterm.h"
40 #include <X11/cursorfont.h>
41
42 /* Load sys/types.h if not already loaded.
43 In some systems loading it twice is suicidal. */
44 #ifndef makedev
45 #include <sys/types.h>
46 #endif /* makedev */
47
48 #include <sys/ioctl.h>
49
50 #include "systime.h"
51
52 #include <fcntl.h>
53 #include <ctype.h>
54 #include <errno.h>
55 #include <setjmp.h>
56 #include <sys/stat.h>
57 /* Caused redefinition of DBL_DIG on Netbsd; seems not to be needed. */
58 /* #include <sys/param.h> */
59
60 #include "charset.h"
61 #include "character.h"
62 #include "coding.h"
63 #include "frame.h"
64 #include "dispextern.h"
65 #include "fontset.h"
66 #include "termhooks.h"
67 #include "termopts.h"
68 #include "termchar.h"
69 #include "emacs-icon.h"
70 #include "disptab.h"
71 #include "buffer.h"
72 #include "window.h"
73 #include "keyboard.h"
74 #include "intervals.h"
75 #include "process.h"
76 #include "atimer.h"
77 #include "keymap.h"
78 #include "font.h"
79 #include "fontset.h"
80 #include "xsettings.h"
81 #include "xgselect.h"
82 #include "sysselect.h"
83
84 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
85 #include <X11/Shell.h>
86 #endif
87
88 #ifdef HAVE_SYS_TIME_H
89 #include <sys/time.h>
90 #endif
91
92 #include <unistd.h>
93
94 #ifdef USE_GTK
95 #include "gtkutil.h"
96 #endif
97
98 #ifdef USE_LUCID
99 #include "../lwlib/xlwmenu.h"
100 #endif
101
102 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
103 #if !defined(NO_EDITRES)
104 #define HACK_EDITRES
105 extern void _XEditResCheckMessages ();
106 #endif /* not NO_EDITRES */
107
108 /* Include toolkit specific headers for the scroll bar widget. */
109
110 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
111 #if defined USE_MOTIF
112 #include <Xm/Xm.h> /* for LESSTIF_VERSION */
113 #include <Xm/ScrollBar.h>
114 #else /* !USE_MOTIF i.e. use Xaw */
115
116 #ifdef HAVE_XAW3D
117 #include <X11/Xaw3d/Simple.h>
118 #include <X11/Xaw3d/Scrollbar.h>
119 #include <X11/Xaw3d/ThreeD.h>
120 #else /* !HAVE_XAW3D */
121 #include <X11/Xaw/Simple.h>
122 #include <X11/Xaw/Scrollbar.h>
123 #endif /* !HAVE_XAW3D */
124 #ifndef XtNpickTop
125 #define XtNpickTop "pickTop"
126 #endif /* !XtNpickTop */
127 #endif /* !USE_MOTIF */
128 #endif /* USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
129
130 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
131
132 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
133 #include "widget.h"
134 #ifndef XtNinitialState
135 #define XtNinitialState "initialState"
136 #endif
137 #endif
138
139 /* Default to using XIM if available. */
140 #ifdef USE_XIM
141 int use_xim = 1;
142 #else
143 int use_xim = 0; /* configure --without-xim */
144 #endif
145
146 \f
147
148 /* Non-zero means that a HELP_EVENT has been generated since Emacs
149 start. */
150
151 static int any_help_event_p;
152
153 /* Last window where we saw the mouse. Used by mouse-autoselect-window. */
154 static Lisp_Object last_window;
155
156 /* This is a chain of structures for all the X displays currently in
157 use. */
158
159 struct x_display_info *x_display_list;
160
161 /* This is a list of cons cells, each of the form (NAME
162 . FONT-LIST-CACHE), one for each element of x_display_list and in
163 the same order. NAME is the name of the frame. FONT-LIST-CACHE
164 records previous values returned by x-list-fonts. */
165
166 Lisp_Object x_display_name_list;
167
168 /* Frame being updated by update_frame. This is declared in term.c.
169 This is set by update_begin and looked at by all the XT functions.
170 It is zero while not inside an update. In that case, the XT
171 functions assume that `selected_frame' is the frame to apply to. */
172
173 extern struct frame *updating_frame;
174
175 /* This is a frame waiting to be auto-raised, within XTread_socket. */
176
177 static struct frame *pending_autoraise_frame;
178
179 /* This is a frame waiting for an event matching mask, within XTread_socket. */
180
181 static struct {
182 struct frame *f;
183 int eventtype;
184 } pending_event_wait;
185
186 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
187 /* The application context for Xt use. */
188 XtAppContext Xt_app_con;
189 static String Xt_default_resources[] = {0};
190 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
191
192 /* Non-zero means user is interacting with a toolkit scroll bar. */
193
194 static int toolkit_scroll_bar_interaction;
195
196 /* Non-zero timeout value means ignore next mouse click if it arrives
197 before that timeout elapses (i.e. as part of the same sequence of
198 events resulting from clicking on a frame to select it). */
199
200 static unsigned long ignore_next_mouse_click_timeout;
201
202 /* Mouse movement.
203
204 Formerly, we used PointerMotionHintMask (in standard_event_mask)
205 so that we would have to call XQueryPointer after each MotionNotify
206 event to ask for another such event. However, this made mouse tracking
207 slow, and there was a bug that made it eventually stop.
208
209 Simply asking for MotionNotify all the time seems to work better.
210
211 In order to avoid asking for motion events and then throwing most
212 of them away or busy-polling the server for mouse positions, we ask
213 the server for pointer motion hints. This means that we get only
214 one event per group of mouse movements. "Groups" are delimited by
215 other kinds of events (focus changes and button clicks, for
216 example), or by XQueryPointer calls; when one of these happens, we
217 get another MotionNotify event the next time the mouse moves. This
218 is at least as efficient as getting motion events when mouse
219 tracking is on, and I suspect only negligibly worse when tracking
220 is off. */
221
222 /* Where the mouse was last time we reported a mouse event. */
223
224 static XRectangle last_mouse_glyph;
225 static FRAME_PTR last_mouse_glyph_frame;
226 static Lisp_Object last_mouse_press_frame;
227
228 /* The scroll bar in which the last X motion event occurred.
229
230 If the last X motion event occurred in a scroll bar, we set this so
231 XTmouse_position can know whether to report a scroll bar motion or
232 an ordinary motion.
233
234 If the last X motion event didn't occur in a scroll bar, we set
235 this to Qnil, to tell XTmouse_position to return an ordinary motion
236 event. */
237
238 static Lisp_Object last_mouse_scroll_bar;
239
240 /* This is a hack. We would really prefer that XTmouse_position would
241 return the time associated with the position it returns, but there
242 doesn't seem to be any way to wrest the time-stamp from the server
243 along with the position query. So, we just keep track of the time
244 of the last movement we received, and return that in hopes that
245 it's somewhat accurate. */
246
247 static Time last_mouse_movement_time;
248
249 /* Time for last user interaction as returned in X events. */
250
251 static Time last_user_time;
252
253 /* Incremented by XTread_socket whenever it really tries to read
254 events. */
255
256 #ifdef __STDC__
257 static int volatile input_signal_count;
258 #else
259 static int input_signal_count;
260 #endif
261
262 /* Used locally within XTread_socket. */
263
264 static int x_noop_count;
265
266 static Lisp_Object Qalt, Qhyper, Qmeta, Qsuper, Qmodifier_value;
267
268 static Lisp_Object Qvendor_specific_keysyms;
269 static Lisp_Object Qlatin_1;
270
271 #ifdef USE_GTK
272 /* The name of the Emacs icon file. */
273 static Lisp_Object xg_default_icon_file;
274
275 /* Used in gtkutil.c. */
276 Lisp_Object Qx_gtk_map_stock;
277 #endif
278
279 /* Some functions take this as char *, not const char *. */
280 static char emacs_class[] = EMACS_CLASS;
281
282 /* XEmbed implementation. */
283
284 #define XEMBED_VERSION 0
285
286 enum xembed_info
287 {
288 XEMBED_MAPPED = 1 << 0
289 };
290
291 enum xembed_message
292 {
293 XEMBED_EMBEDDED_NOTIFY = 0,
294 XEMBED_WINDOW_ACTIVATE = 1,
295 XEMBED_WINDOW_DEACTIVATE = 2,
296 XEMBED_REQUEST_FOCUS = 3,
297 XEMBED_FOCUS_IN = 4,
298 XEMBED_FOCUS_OUT = 5,
299 XEMBED_FOCUS_NEXT = 6,
300 XEMBED_FOCUS_PREV = 7,
301
302 XEMBED_MODALITY_ON = 10,
303 XEMBED_MODALITY_OFF = 11,
304 XEMBED_REGISTER_ACCELERATOR = 12,
305 XEMBED_UNREGISTER_ACCELERATOR = 13,
306 XEMBED_ACTIVATE_ACCELERATOR = 14
307 };
308
309 /* Used in x_flush. */
310
311 static int x_alloc_nearest_color_1 (Display *, Colormap, XColor *);
312 static void x_set_window_size_1 (struct frame *, int, int, int);
313 static const XColor *x_color_cells (Display *, int *);
314 static void x_update_window_end (struct window *, int, int);
315
316 static int x_io_error_quitter (Display *);
317 static struct terminal *x_create_terminal (struct x_display_info *);
318 void x_delete_terminal (struct terminal *);
319 static void x_update_end (struct frame *);
320 static void XTframe_up_to_date (struct frame *);
321 static void XTset_terminal_modes (struct terminal *);
322 static void XTreset_terminal_modes (struct terminal *);
323 static void x_clear_frame (struct frame *);
324 static void frame_highlight (struct frame *);
325 static void frame_unhighlight (struct frame *);
326 static void x_new_focus_frame (struct x_display_info *, struct frame *);
327 static void x_focus_changed (int, int, struct x_display_info *,
328 struct frame *, struct input_event *);
329 static void x_detect_focus_change (struct x_display_info *,
330 XEvent *, struct input_event *);
331 static void XTframe_rehighlight (struct frame *);
332 static void x_frame_rehighlight (struct x_display_info *);
333 static void x_draw_hollow_cursor (struct window *, struct glyph_row *);
334 static void x_draw_bar_cursor (struct window *, struct glyph_row *, int,
335 enum text_cursor_kinds);
336
337 static void x_clip_to_row (struct window *, struct glyph_row *, int, GC);
338 static void x_flush (struct frame *f);
339 static void x_update_begin (struct frame *);
340 static void x_update_window_begin (struct window *);
341 static void x_after_update_window_line (struct glyph_row *);
342 static struct scroll_bar *x_window_to_scroll_bar (Display *, Window);
343 static void x_scroll_bar_report_motion (struct frame **, Lisp_Object *,
344 enum scroll_bar_part *,
345 Lisp_Object *, Lisp_Object *,
346 unsigned long *);
347 static void x_handle_net_wm_state (struct frame *, XPropertyEvent *);
348 static void x_check_fullscreen (struct frame *);
349 static void x_check_expected_move (struct frame *, int, int);
350 static void x_sync_with_move (struct frame *, int, int, int);
351 static int handle_one_xevent (struct x_display_info *, XEvent *,
352 int *, struct input_event *);
353 /* Don't declare this NO_RETURN because we want no
354 interference with debugging failing X calls. */
355 static SIGTYPE x_connection_closed (Display *, const char *);
356
357
358 /* Flush display of frame F, or of all frames if F is null. */
359
360 static void
361 x_flush (struct frame *f)
362 {
363 /* Don't call XFlush when it is not safe to redisplay; the X
364 connection may be broken. */
365 if (!NILP (Vinhibit_redisplay))
366 return;
367
368 BLOCK_INPUT;
369 if (f == NULL)
370 {
371 Lisp_Object rest, frame;
372 FOR_EACH_FRAME (rest, frame)
373 if (FRAME_X_P (XFRAME (frame)))
374 x_flush (XFRAME (frame));
375 }
376 else if (FRAME_X_P (f))
377 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
378 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
379 }
380
381
382 /* Remove calls to XFlush by defining XFlush to an empty replacement.
383 Calls to XFlush should be unnecessary because the X output buffer
384 is flushed automatically as needed by calls to XPending,
385 XNextEvent, or XWindowEvent according to the XFlush man page.
386 XTread_socket calls XPending. Removing XFlush improves
387 performance. */
388
389 #define XFlush(DISPLAY) (void) 0
390
391 \f
392 /***********************************************************************
393 Debugging
394 ***********************************************************************/
395
396 #if 0
397
398 /* This is a function useful for recording debugging information about
399 the sequence of occurrences in this file. */
400
401 struct record
402 {
403 char *locus;
404 int type;
405 };
406
407 struct record event_record[100];
408
409 int event_record_index;
410
411 void
412 record_event (char *locus, int type)
413 {
414 if (event_record_index == sizeof (event_record) / sizeof (struct record))
415 event_record_index = 0;
416
417 event_record[event_record_index].locus = locus;
418 event_record[event_record_index].type = type;
419 event_record_index++;
420 }
421
422 #endif /* 0 */
423
424
425 \f
426 /* Return the struct x_display_info corresponding to DPY. */
427
428 struct x_display_info *
429 x_display_info_for_display (Display *dpy)
430 {
431 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
432
433 for (dpyinfo = x_display_list; dpyinfo; dpyinfo = dpyinfo->next)
434 if (dpyinfo->display == dpy)
435 return dpyinfo;
436
437 return 0;
438 }
439
440 #define OPAQUE 0xffffffff
441
442 void
443 x_set_frame_alpha (struct frame *f)
444 {
445 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
446 Display *dpy = FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f);
447 Window win = FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f);
448 double alpha = 1.0;
449 double alpha_min = 1.0;
450 unsigned long opac;
451
452 if (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->root_window != FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->parent_desc)
453 /* Since the WM decoration lies under the FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW,
454 we must treat the former instead of the latter. */
455 win = FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->parent_desc;
456
457 if (dpyinfo->x_highlight_frame == f)
458 alpha = f->alpha[0];
459 else
460 alpha = f->alpha[1];
461
462 if (FLOATP (Vframe_alpha_lower_limit))
463 alpha_min = XFLOAT_DATA (Vframe_alpha_lower_limit);
464 else if (INTEGERP (Vframe_alpha_lower_limit))
465 alpha_min = (XINT (Vframe_alpha_lower_limit)) / 100.0;
466
467 if (alpha < 0.0)
468 return;
469 else if (alpha > 1.0)
470 alpha = 1.0;
471 else if (0.0 <= alpha && alpha < alpha_min && alpha_min <= 1.0)
472 alpha = alpha_min;
473
474 opac = alpha * OPAQUE;
475
476 /* return unless necessary */
477 {
478 unsigned char *data;
479 Atom actual;
480 int rc, format;
481 unsigned long n, left;
482
483 x_catch_errors (dpy);
484 rc = XGetWindowProperty (dpy, win, dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_window_opacity,
485 0L, 1L, False, XA_CARDINAL,
486 &actual, &format, &n, &left,
487 &data);
488
489 if (rc == Success && actual != None)
490 {
491 XFree ((void *) data);
492 if (*(unsigned long *)data == opac)
493 {
494 x_uncatch_errors ();
495 return;
496 }
497 }
498 x_uncatch_errors ();
499 }
500
501 x_catch_errors (dpy);
502 XChangeProperty (dpy, win, dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_window_opacity,
503 XA_CARDINAL, 32, PropModeReplace,
504 (unsigned char *) &opac, 1L);
505 x_uncatch_errors ();
506 }
507
508 int
509 x_display_pixel_height (struct x_display_info *dpyinfo)
510 {
511 return HeightOfScreen (dpyinfo->screen);
512 }
513
514 int
515 x_display_pixel_width (struct x_display_info *dpyinfo)
516 {
517 return WidthOfScreen (dpyinfo->screen);
518 }
519
520 \f
521 /***********************************************************************
522 Starting and ending an update
523 ***********************************************************************/
524
525 /* Start an update of frame F. This function is installed as a hook
526 for update_begin, i.e. it is called when update_begin is called.
527 This function is called prior to calls to x_update_window_begin for
528 each window being updated. Currently, there is nothing to do here
529 because all interesting stuff is done on a window basis. */
530
531 static void
532 x_update_begin (struct frame *f)
533 {
534 /* Nothing to do. */
535 }
536
537
538 /* Start update of window W. Set the global variable updated_window
539 to the window being updated and set output_cursor to the cursor
540 position of W. */
541
542 static void
543 x_update_window_begin (struct window *w)
544 {
545 struct frame *f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (w));
546 Mouse_HLInfo *hlinfo = MOUSE_HL_INFO (f);
547
548 updated_window = w;
549 set_output_cursor (&w->cursor);
550
551 BLOCK_INPUT;
552
553 if (f == hlinfo->mouse_face_mouse_frame)
554 {
555 /* Don't do highlighting for mouse motion during the update. */
556 hlinfo->mouse_face_defer = 1;
557
558 /* If F needs to be redrawn, simply forget about any prior mouse
559 highlighting. */
560 if (FRAME_GARBAGED_P (f))
561 hlinfo->mouse_face_window = Qnil;
562 }
563
564 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
565 }
566
567
568 /* Draw a vertical window border from (x,y0) to (x,y1) */
569
570 static void
571 x_draw_vertical_window_border (struct window *w, int x, int y0, int y1)
572 {
573 struct frame *f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (w));
574 struct face *face;
575
576 face = FACE_FROM_ID (f, VERTICAL_BORDER_FACE_ID);
577 if (face)
578 XSetForeground (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), f->output_data.x->normal_gc,
579 face->foreground);
580
581 XDrawLine (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
582 f->output_data.x->normal_gc, x, y0, x, y1);
583 }
584
585 /* End update of window W (which is equal to updated_window).
586
587 Draw vertical borders between horizontally adjacent windows, and
588 display W's cursor if CURSOR_ON_P is non-zero.
589
590 MOUSE_FACE_OVERWRITTEN_P non-zero means that some row containing
591 glyphs in mouse-face were overwritten. In that case we have to
592 make sure that the mouse-highlight is properly redrawn.
593
594 W may be a menu bar pseudo-window in case we don't have X toolkit
595 support. Such windows don't have a cursor, so don't display it
596 here. */
597
598 static void
599 x_update_window_end (struct window *w, int cursor_on_p, int mouse_face_overwritten_p)
600 {
601 Mouse_HLInfo *hlinfo = MOUSE_HL_INFO (XFRAME (w->frame));
602
603 if (!w->pseudo_window_p)
604 {
605 BLOCK_INPUT;
606
607 if (cursor_on_p)
608 display_and_set_cursor (w, 1, output_cursor.hpos,
609 output_cursor.vpos,
610 output_cursor.x, output_cursor.y);
611
612 if (draw_window_fringes (w, 1))
613 x_draw_vertical_border (w);
614
615 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
616 }
617
618 /* If a row with mouse-face was overwritten, arrange for
619 XTframe_up_to_date to redisplay the mouse highlight. */
620 if (mouse_face_overwritten_p)
621 {
622 hlinfo->mouse_face_beg_row = hlinfo->mouse_face_beg_col = -1;
623 hlinfo->mouse_face_end_row = hlinfo->mouse_face_end_col = -1;
624 hlinfo->mouse_face_window = Qnil;
625 }
626
627 updated_window = NULL;
628 }
629
630
631 /* End update of frame F. This function is installed as a hook in
632 update_end. */
633
634 static void
635 x_update_end (struct frame *f)
636 {
637 /* Mouse highlight may be displayed again. */
638 MOUSE_HL_INFO (f)->mouse_face_defer = 0;
639
640 #ifndef XFlush
641 BLOCK_INPUT;
642 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
643 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
644 #endif
645 }
646
647
648 /* This function is called from various places in xdisp.c whenever a
649 complete update has been performed. The global variable
650 updated_window is not available here. */
651
652 static void
653 XTframe_up_to_date (struct frame *f)
654 {
655 if (FRAME_X_P (f))
656 {
657 Mouse_HLInfo *hlinfo = MOUSE_HL_INFO (f);
658
659 if (hlinfo->mouse_face_deferred_gc
660 || f == hlinfo->mouse_face_mouse_frame)
661 {
662 BLOCK_INPUT;
663 if (hlinfo->mouse_face_mouse_frame)
664 note_mouse_highlight (hlinfo->mouse_face_mouse_frame,
665 hlinfo->mouse_face_mouse_x,
666 hlinfo->mouse_face_mouse_y);
667 hlinfo->mouse_face_deferred_gc = 0;
668 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
669 }
670 }
671 }
672
673
674 /* Draw truncation mark bitmaps, continuation mark bitmaps, overlay
675 arrow bitmaps, or clear the fringes if no bitmaps are required
676 before DESIRED_ROW is made current. The window being updated is
677 found in updated_window. This function It is called from
678 update_window_line only if it is known that there are differences
679 between bitmaps to be drawn between current row and DESIRED_ROW. */
680
681 static void
682 x_after_update_window_line (struct glyph_row *desired_row)
683 {
684 struct window *w = updated_window;
685 struct frame *f;
686 int width, height;
687
688 xassert (w);
689
690 if (!desired_row->mode_line_p && !w->pseudo_window_p)
691 desired_row->redraw_fringe_bitmaps_p = 1;
692
693 /* When a window has disappeared, make sure that no rest of
694 full-width rows stays visible in the internal border. Could
695 check here if updated_window is the leftmost/rightmost window,
696 but I guess it's not worth doing since vertically split windows
697 are almost never used, internal border is rarely set, and the
698 overhead is very small. */
699 if (windows_or_buffers_changed
700 && desired_row->full_width_p
701 && (f = XFRAME (w->frame),
702 width = FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f),
703 width != 0)
704 && (height = desired_row->visible_height,
705 height > 0))
706 {
707 int y = WINDOW_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_Y (w, max (0, desired_row->y));
708
709 BLOCK_INPUT;
710 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
711 0, y, width, height, False);
712 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
713 FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f) - width,
714 y, width, height, False);
715 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
716 }
717 }
718
719 static void
720 x_draw_fringe_bitmap (struct window *w, struct glyph_row *row, struct draw_fringe_bitmap_params *p)
721 {
722 struct frame *f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (w));
723 Display *display = FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f);
724 Window window = FRAME_X_WINDOW (f);
725 GC gc = f->output_data.x->normal_gc;
726 struct face *face = p->face;
727
728 /* Must clip because of partially visible lines. */
729 x_clip_to_row (w, row, -1, gc);
730
731 if (!p->overlay_p)
732 {
733 int bx = p->bx, by = p->by, nx = p->nx, ny = p->ny;
734
735 /* In case the same realized face is used for fringes and
736 for something displayed in the text (e.g. face `region' on
737 mono-displays, the fill style may have been changed to
738 FillSolid in x_draw_glyph_string_background. */
739 if (face->stipple)
740 XSetFillStyle (display, face->gc, FillOpaqueStippled);
741 else
742 XSetForeground (display, face->gc, face->background);
743
744 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
745 /* If the fringe is adjacent to the left (right) scroll bar of a
746 leftmost (rightmost, respectively) window, then extend its
747 background to the gap between the fringe and the bar. */
748 if ((WINDOW_LEFTMOST_P (w)
749 && WINDOW_HAS_VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_ON_LEFT (w))
750 || (WINDOW_RIGHTMOST_P (w)
751 && WINDOW_HAS_VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_ON_RIGHT (w)))
752 {
753 int sb_width = WINDOW_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH (w);
754
755 if (sb_width > 0)
756 {
757 int left = WINDOW_SCROLL_BAR_AREA_X (w);
758 int width = (WINDOW_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_COLS (w)
759 * FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (f));
760
761 if (bx < 0)
762 {
763 /* Bitmap fills the fringe. */
764 if (left + width == p->x)
765 bx = left + sb_width;
766 else if (p->x + p->wd == left)
767 bx = left;
768 if (bx >= 0)
769 {
770 int header_line_height = WINDOW_HEADER_LINE_HEIGHT (w);
771
772 nx = width - sb_width;
773 by = WINDOW_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_Y (w, max (header_line_height,
774 row->y));
775 ny = row->visible_height;
776 }
777 }
778 else
779 {
780 if (left + width == bx)
781 {
782 bx = left + sb_width;
783 nx += width - sb_width;
784 }
785 else if (bx + nx == left)
786 nx += width - sb_width;
787 }
788 }
789 }
790 #endif
791 if (bx >= 0 && nx > 0)
792 XFillRectangle (display, window, face->gc, bx, by, nx, ny);
793
794 if (!face->stipple)
795 XSetForeground (display, face->gc, face->foreground);
796 }
797
798 if (p->which)
799 {
800 unsigned char *bits;
801 Pixmap pixmap, clipmask = (Pixmap) 0;
802 int depth = DefaultDepthOfScreen (FRAME_X_SCREEN (f));
803 XGCValues gcv;
804
805 if (p->wd > 8)
806 bits = (unsigned char *)(p->bits + p->dh);
807 else
808 bits = (unsigned char *)p->bits + p->dh;
809
810 /* Draw the bitmap. I believe these small pixmaps can be cached
811 by the server. */
812 pixmap = XCreatePixmapFromBitmapData (display, window, bits, p->wd, p->h,
813 (p->cursor_p
814 ? (p->overlay_p ? face->background
815 : f->output_data.x->cursor_pixel)
816 : face->foreground),
817 face->background, depth);
818
819 if (p->overlay_p)
820 {
821 clipmask = XCreatePixmapFromBitmapData (display,
822 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->root_window,
823 bits, p->wd, p->h,
824 1, 0, 1);
825 gcv.clip_mask = clipmask;
826 gcv.clip_x_origin = p->x;
827 gcv.clip_y_origin = p->y;
828 XChangeGC (display, gc, GCClipMask | GCClipXOrigin | GCClipYOrigin, &gcv);
829 }
830
831 XCopyArea (display, pixmap, window, gc, 0, 0,
832 p->wd, p->h, p->x, p->y);
833 XFreePixmap (display, pixmap);
834
835 if (p->overlay_p)
836 {
837 gcv.clip_mask = (Pixmap) 0;
838 XChangeGC (display, gc, GCClipMask, &gcv);
839 XFreePixmap (display, clipmask);
840 }
841 }
842
843 XSetClipMask (display, gc, None);
844 }
845
846 \f
847
848 /* This is called when starting Emacs and when restarting after
849 suspend. When starting Emacs, no X window is mapped. And nothing
850 must be done to Emacs's own window if it is suspended (though that
851 rarely happens). */
852
853 static void
854 XTset_terminal_modes (struct terminal *terminal)
855 {
856 }
857
858 /* This is called when exiting or suspending Emacs. Exiting will make
859 the X-windows go away, and suspending requires no action. */
860
861 static void
862 XTreset_terminal_modes (struct terminal *terminal)
863 {
864 }
865
866 \f
867 /***********************************************************************
868 Glyph display
869 ***********************************************************************/
870
871
872
873 static void x_set_glyph_string_clipping (struct glyph_string *);
874 static void x_set_glyph_string_gc (struct glyph_string *);
875 static void x_draw_glyph_string_background (struct glyph_string *,
876 int);
877 static void x_draw_glyph_string_foreground (struct glyph_string *);
878 static void x_draw_composite_glyph_string_foreground (struct glyph_string *);
879 static void x_draw_glyph_string_box (struct glyph_string *);
880 static void x_draw_glyph_string (struct glyph_string *);
881 static void x_compute_glyph_string_overhangs (struct glyph_string *);
882 static void x_set_cursor_gc (struct glyph_string *);
883 static void x_set_mode_line_face_gc (struct glyph_string *);
884 static void x_set_mouse_face_gc (struct glyph_string *);
885 static int x_alloc_lighter_color (struct frame *, Display *, Colormap,
886 unsigned long *, double, int);
887 static void x_setup_relief_color (struct frame *, struct relief *,
888 double, int, unsigned long);
889 static void x_setup_relief_colors (struct glyph_string *);
890 static void x_draw_image_glyph_string (struct glyph_string *);
891 static void x_draw_image_relief (struct glyph_string *);
892 static void x_draw_image_foreground (struct glyph_string *);
893 static void x_draw_image_foreground_1 (struct glyph_string *, Pixmap);
894 static void x_clear_glyph_string_rect (struct glyph_string *, int,
895 int, int, int);
896 static void x_draw_relief_rect (struct frame *, int, int, int, int,
897 int, int, int, int, int, int,
898 XRectangle *);
899 static void x_draw_box_rect (struct glyph_string *, int, int, int, int,
900 int, int, int, XRectangle *);
901 static void x_scroll_bar_clear (struct frame *);
902
903 #if GLYPH_DEBUG
904 static void x_check_font (struct frame *, struct font *);
905 #endif
906
907
908 /* Set S->gc to a suitable GC for drawing glyph string S in cursor
909 face. */
910
911 static void
912 x_set_cursor_gc (struct glyph_string *s)
913 {
914 if (s->font == FRAME_FONT (s->f)
915 && s->face->background == FRAME_BACKGROUND_PIXEL (s->f)
916 && s->face->foreground == FRAME_FOREGROUND_PIXEL (s->f)
917 && !s->cmp)
918 s->gc = s->f->output_data.x->cursor_gc;
919 else
920 {
921 /* Cursor on non-default face: must merge. */
922 XGCValues xgcv;
923 unsigned long mask;
924
925 xgcv.background = s->f->output_data.x->cursor_pixel;
926 xgcv.foreground = s->face->background;
927
928 /* If the glyph would be invisible, try a different foreground. */
929 if (xgcv.foreground == xgcv.background)
930 xgcv.foreground = s->face->foreground;
931 if (xgcv.foreground == xgcv.background)
932 xgcv.foreground = s->f->output_data.x->cursor_foreground_pixel;
933 if (xgcv.foreground == xgcv.background)
934 xgcv.foreground = s->face->foreground;
935
936 /* Make sure the cursor is distinct from text in this face. */
937 if (xgcv.background == s->face->background
938 && xgcv.foreground == s->face->foreground)
939 {
940 xgcv.background = s->face->foreground;
941 xgcv.foreground = s->face->background;
942 }
943
944 IF_DEBUG (x_check_font (s->f, s->font));
945 xgcv.graphics_exposures = False;
946 mask = GCForeground | GCBackground | GCGraphicsExposures;
947
948 if (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (s->f)->scratch_cursor_gc)
949 XChangeGC (s->display, FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (s->f)->scratch_cursor_gc,
950 mask, &xgcv);
951 else
952 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (s->f)->scratch_cursor_gc
953 = XCreateGC (s->display, s->window, mask, &xgcv);
954
955 s->gc = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (s->f)->scratch_cursor_gc;
956 }
957 }
958
959
960 /* Set up S->gc of glyph string S for drawing text in mouse face. */
961
962 static void
963 x_set_mouse_face_gc (struct glyph_string *s)
964 {
965 int face_id;
966 struct face *face;
967
968 /* What face has to be used last for the mouse face? */
969 face_id = MOUSE_HL_INFO (s->f)->mouse_face_face_id;
970 face = FACE_FROM_ID (s->f, face_id);
971 if (face == NULL)
972 face = FACE_FROM_ID (s->f, MOUSE_FACE_ID);
973
974 if (s->first_glyph->type == CHAR_GLYPH)
975 face_id = FACE_FOR_CHAR (s->f, face, s->first_glyph->u.ch, -1, Qnil);
976 else
977 face_id = FACE_FOR_CHAR (s->f, face, 0, -1, Qnil);
978 s->face = FACE_FROM_ID (s->f, face_id);
979 PREPARE_FACE_FOR_DISPLAY (s->f, s->face);
980
981 if (s->font == s->face->font)
982 s->gc = s->face->gc;
983 else
984 {
985 /* Otherwise construct scratch_cursor_gc with values from FACE
986 except for FONT. */
987 XGCValues xgcv;
988 unsigned long mask;
989
990 xgcv.background = s->face->background;
991 xgcv.foreground = s->face->foreground;
992 xgcv.graphics_exposures = False;
993 mask = GCForeground | GCBackground | GCGraphicsExposures;
994
995 if (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (s->f)->scratch_cursor_gc)
996 XChangeGC (s->display, FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (s->f)->scratch_cursor_gc,
997 mask, &xgcv);
998 else
999 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (s->f)->scratch_cursor_gc
1000 = XCreateGC (s->display, s->window, mask, &xgcv);
1001
1002 s->gc = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (s->f)->scratch_cursor_gc;
1003
1004 }
1005 xassert (s->gc != 0);
1006 }
1007
1008
1009 /* Set S->gc of glyph string S to a GC suitable for drawing a mode line.
1010 Faces to use in the mode line have already been computed when the
1011 matrix was built, so there isn't much to do, here. */
1012
1013 static INLINE void
1014 x_set_mode_line_face_gc (struct glyph_string *s)
1015 {
1016 s->gc = s->face->gc;
1017 }
1018
1019
1020 /* Set S->gc of glyph string S for drawing that glyph string. Set
1021 S->stippled_p to a non-zero value if the face of S has a stipple
1022 pattern. */
1023
1024 static INLINE void
1025 x_set_glyph_string_gc (struct glyph_string *s)
1026 {
1027 PREPARE_FACE_FOR_DISPLAY (s->f, s->face);
1028
1029 if (s->hl == DRAW_NORMAL_TEXT)
1030 {
1031 s->gc = s->face->gc;
1032 s->stippled_p = s->face->stipple != 0;
1033 }
1034 else if (s->hl == DRAW_INVERSE_VIDEO)
1035 {
1036 x_set_mode_line_face_gc (s);
1037 s->stippled_p = s->face->stipple != 0;
1038 }
1039 else if (s->hl == DRAW_CURSOR)
1040 {
1041 x_set_cursor_gc (s);
1042 s->stippled_p = 0;
1043 }
1044 else if (s->hl == DRAW_MOUSE_FACE)
1045 {
1046 x_set_mouse_face_gc (s);
1047 s->stippled_p = s->face->stipple != 0;
1048 }
1049 else if (s->hl == DRAW_IMAGE_RAISED
1050 || s->hl == DRAW_IMAGE_SUNKEN)
1051 {
1052 s->gc = s->face->gc;
1053 s->stippled_p = s->face->stipple != 0;
1054 }
1055 else
1056 {
1057 s->gc = s->face->gc;
1058 s->stippled_p = s->face->stipple != 0;
1059 }
1060
1061 /* GC must have been set. */
1062 xassert (s->gc != 0);
1063 }
1064
1065
1066 /* Set clipping for output of glyph string S. S may be part of a mode
1067 line or menu if we don't have X toolkit support. */
1068
1069 static INLINE void
1070 x_set_glyph_string_clipping (struct glyph_string *s)
1071 {
1072 XRectangle *r = s->clip;
1073 int n = get_glyph_string_clip_rects (s, r, 2);
1074
1075 if (n > 0)
1076 XSetClipRectangles (s->display, s->gc, 0, 0, r, n, Unsorted);
1077 s->num_clips = n;
1078 }
1079
1080
1081 /* Set SRC's clipping for output of glyph string DST. This is called
1082 when we are drawing DST's left_overhang or right_overhang only in
1083 the area of SRC. */
1084
1085 static void
1086 x_set_glyph_string_clipping_exactly (struct glyph_string *src, struct glyph_string *dst)
1087 {
1088 XRectangle r;
1089
1090 r.x = src->x;
1091 r.width = src->width;
1092 r.y = src->y;
1093 r.height = src->height;
1094 dst->clip[0] = r;
1095 dst->num_clips = 1;
1096 XSetClipRectangles (dst->display, dst->gc, 0, 0, &r, 1, Unsorted);
1097 }
1098
1099
1100 /* RIF:
1101 Compute left and right overhang of glyph string S. */
1102
1103 static void
1104 x_compute_glyph_string_overhangs (struct glyph_string *s)
1105 {
1106 if (s->cmp == NULL
1107 && (s->first_glyph->type == CHAR_GLYPH
1108 || s->first_glyph->type == COMPOSITE_GLYPH))
1109 {
1110 struct font_metrics metrics;
1111
1112 if (s->first_glyph->type == CHAR_GLYPH)
1113 {
1114 unsigned *code = alloca (sizeof (unsigned) * s->nchars);
1115 struct font *font = s->font;
1116 int i;
1117
1118 for (i = 0; i < s->nchars; i++)
1119 code[i] = (s->char2b[i].byte1 << 8) | s->char2b[i].byte2;
1120 font->driver->text_extents (font, code, s->nchars, &metrics);
1121 }
1122 else
1123 {
1124 Lisp_Object gstring = composition_gstring_from_id (s->cmp_id);
1125
1126 composition_gstring_width (gstring, s->cmp_from, s->cmp_to, &metrics);
1127 }
1128 s->right_overhang = (metrics.rbearing > metrics.width
1129 ? metrics.rbearing - metrics.width : 0);
1130 s->left_overhang = metrics.lbearing < 0 ? - metrics.lbearing : 0;
1131 }
1132 else if (s->cmp)
1133 {
1134 s->right_overhang = s->cmp->rbearing - s->cmp->pixel_width;
1135 s->left_overhang = - s->cmp->lbearing;
1136 }
1137 }
1138
1139
1140 /* Fill rectangle X, Y, W, H with background color of glyph string S. */
1141
1142 static INLINE void
1143 x_clear_glyph_string_rect (struct glyph_string *s, int x, int y, int w, int h)
1144 {
1145 XGCValues xgcv;
1146 XGetGCValues (s->display, s->gc, GCForeground | GCBackground, &xgcv);
1147 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, xgcv.background);
1148 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc, x, y, w, h);
1149 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, xgcv.foreground);
1150 }
1151
1152
1153 /* Draw the background of glyph_string S. If S->background_filled_p
1154 is non-zero don't draw it. FORCE_P non-zero means draw the
1155 background even if it wouldn't be drawn normally. This is used
1156 when a string preceding S draws into the background of S, or S
1157 contains the first component of a composition. */
1158
1159 static void
1160 x_draw_glyph_string_background (struct glyph_string *s, int force_p)
1161 {
1162 /* Nothing to do if background has already been drawn or if it
1163 shouldn't be drawn in the first place. */
1164 if (!s->background_filled_p)
1165 {
1166 int box_line_width = max (s->face->box_line_width, 0);
1167
1168 if (s->stippled_p)
1169 {
1170 /* Fill background with a stipple pattern. */
1171 XSetFillStyle (s->display, s->gc, FillOpaqueStippled);
1172 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc, s->x,
1173 s->y + box_line_width,
1174 s->background_width,
1175 s->height - 2 * box_line_width);
1176 XSetFillStyle (s->display, s->gc, FillSolid);
1177 s->background_filled_p = 1;
1178 }
1179 else if (FONT_HEIGHT (s->font) < s->height - 2 * box_line_width
1180 || s->font_not_found_p
1181 || s->extends_to_end_of_line_p
1182 || force_p)
1183 {
1184 x_clear_glyph_string_rect (s, s->x, s->y + box_line_width,
1185 s->background_width,
1186 s->height - 2 * box_line_width);
1187 s->background_filled_p = 1;
1188 }
1189 }
1190 }
1191
1192
1193 /* Draw the foreground of glyph string S. */
1194
1195 static void
1196 x_draw_glyph_string_foreground (struct glyph_string *s)
1197 {
1198 int i, x;
1199
1200 /* If first glyph of S has a left box line, start drawing the text
1201 of S to the right of that box line. */
1202 if (s->face->box != FACE_NO_BOX
1203 && s->first_glyph->left_box_line_p)
1204 x = s->x + eabs (s->face->box_line_width);
1205 else
1206 x = s->x;
1207
1208 /* Draw characters of S as rectangles if S's font could not be
1209 loaded. */
1210 if (s->font_not_found_p)
1211 {
1212 for (i = 0; i < s->nchars; ++i)
1213 {
1214 struct glyph *g = s->first_glyph + i;
1215 XDrawRectangle (s->display, s->window,
1216 s->gc, x, s->y, g->pixel_width - 1,
1217 s->height - 1);
1218 x += g->pixel_width;
1219 }
1220 }
1221 else
1222 {
1223 struct font *font = s->font;
1224 int boff = font->baseline_offset;
1225 int y;
1226
1227 if (font->vertical_centering)
1228 boff = VCENTER_BASELINE_OFFSET (font, s->f) - boff;
1229
1230 y = s->ybase - boff;
1231 if (s->for_overlaps
1232 || (s->background_filled_p && s->hl != DRAW_CURSOR))
1233 font->driver->draw (s, 0, s->nchars, x, y, 0);
1234 else
1235 font->driver->draw (s, 0, s->nchars, x, y, 1);
1236 if (s->face->overstrike)
1237 font->driver->draw (s, 0, s->nchars, x + 1, y, 0);
1238 }
1239 }
1240
1241 /* Draw the foreground of composite glyph string S. */
1242
1243 static void
1244 x_draw_composite_glyph_string_foreground (struct glyph_string *s)
1245 {
1246 int i, j, x;
1247 struct font *font = s->font;
1248
1249 /* If first glyph of S has a left box line, start drawing the text
1250 of S to the right of that box line. */
1251 if (s->face && s->face->box != FACE_NO_BOX
1252 && s->first_glyph->left_box_line_p)
1253 x = s->x + eabs (s->face->box_line_width);
1254 else
1255 x = s->x;
1256
1257 /* S is a glyph string for a composition. S->cmp_from is the index
1258 of the first character drawn for glyphs of this composition.
1259 S->cmp_from == 0 means we are drawing the very first character of
1260 this composition. */
1261
1262 /* Draw a rectangle for the composition if the font for the very
1263 first character of the composition could not be loaded. */
1264 if (s->font_not_found_p)
1265 {
1266 if (s->cmp_from == 0)
1267 XDrawRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc, x, s->y,
1268 s->width - 1, s->height - 1);
1269 }
1270 else if (! s->first_glyph->u.cmp.automatic)
1271 {
1272 int y = s->ybase;
1273
1274 for (i = 0, j = s->cmp_from; i < s->nchars; i++, j++)
1275 if (COMPOSITION_GLYPH (s->cmp, j) != '\t')
1276 {
1277 int xx = x + s->cmp->offsets[j * 2];
1278 int yy = y - s->cmp->offsets[j * 2 + 1];
1279
1280 font->driver->draw (s, j, j + 1, xx, yy, 0);
1281 if (s->face->overstrike)
1282 font->driver->draw (s, j, j + 1, xx + 1, yy, 0);
1283 }
1284 }
1285 else
1286 {
1287 Lisp_Object gstring = composition_gstring_from_id (s->cmp_id);
1288 Lisp_Object glyph;
1289 int y = s->ybase;
1290 int width = 0;
1291
1292 for (i = j = s->cmp_from; i < s->cmp_to; i++)
1293 {
1294 glyph = LGSTRING_GLYPH (gstring, i);
1295 if (NILP (LGLYPH_ADJUSTMENT (glyph)))
1296 width += LGLYPH_WIDTH (glyph);
1297 else
1298 {
1299 int xoff, yoff, wadjust;
1300
1301 if (j < i)
1302 {
1303 font->driver->draw (s, j, i, x, y, 0);
1304 if (s->face->overstrike)
1305 font->driver->draw (s, j, i, x + 1, y, 0);
1306 x += width;
1307 }
1308 xoff = LGLYPH_XOFF (glyph);
1309 yoff = LGLYPH_YOFF (glyph);
1310 wadjust = LGLYPH_WADJUST (glyph);
1311 font->driver->draw (s, i, i + 1, x + xoff, y + yoff, 0);
1312 if (s->face->overstrike)
1313 font->driver->draw (s, i, i + 1, x + xoff + 1, y + yoff, 0);
1314 x += wadjust;
1315 j = i + 1;
1316 width = 0;
1317 }
1318 }
1319 if (j < i)
1320 {
1321 font->driver->draw (s, j, i, x, y, 0);
1322 if (s->face->overstrike)
1323 font->driver->draw (s, j, i, x + 1, y, 0);
1324 }
1325 }
1326 }
1327
1328
1329 /* Draw the foreground of glyph string S for glyphless characters. */
1330
1331 static void
1332 x_draw_glyphless_glyph_string_foreground (struct glyph_string *s)
1333 {
1334 struct glyph *glyph = s->first_glyph;
1335 XChar2b char2b[8];
1336 int x, i, j;
1337
1338 /* If first glyph of S has a left box line, start drawing the text
1339 of S to the right of that box line. */
1340 if (s->face && s->face->box != FACE_NO_BOX
1341 && s->first_glyph->left_box_line_p)
1342 x = s->x + eabs (s->face->box_line_width);
1343 else
1344 x = s->x;
1345
1346 s->char2b = char2b;
1347
1348 for (i = 0; i < s->nchars; i++, glyph++)
1349 {
1350 char buf[7], *str = NULL;
1351 int len = glyph->u.glyphless.len;
1352
1353 if (glyph->u.glyphless.method == GLYPHLESS_DISPLAY_ACRONYM)
1354 {
1355 if (len > 0
1356 && CHAR_TABLE_P (Vglyphless_char_display)
1357 && (CHAR_TABLE_EXTRA_SLOTS (XCHAR_TABLE (Vglyphless_char_display))
1358 >= 1))
1359 {
1360 Lisp_Object acronym
1361 = (! glyph->u.glyphless.for_no_font
1362 ? CHAR_TABLE_REF (Vglyphless_char_display,
1363 glyph->u.glyphless.ch)
1364 : XCHAR_TABLE (Vglyphless_char_display)->extras[0]);
1365 if (STRINGP (acronym))
1366 str = SSDATA (acronym);
1367 }
1368 }
1369 else if (glyph->u.glyphless.method == GLYPHLESS_DISPLAY_HEX_CODE)
1370 {
1371 sprintf ((char *) buf, "%0*X",
1372 glyph->u.glyphless.ch < 0x10000 ? 4 : 6,
1373 glyph->u.glyphless.ch);
1374 str = buf;
1375 }
1376
1377 if (str)
1378 {
1379 int upper_len = (len + 1) / 2;
1380 unsigned code;
1381
1382 /* It is assured that all LEN characters in STR is ASCII. */
1383 for (j = 0; j < len; j++)
1384 {
1385 code = s->font->driver->encode_char (s->font, str[j]);
1386 STORE_XCHAR2B (char2b + j, code >> 8, code & 0xFF);
1387 }
1388 s->font->driver->draw (s, 0, upper_len,
1389 x + glyph->slice.glyphless.upper_xoff,
1390 s->ybase + glyph->slice.glyphless.upper_yoff,
1391 0);
1392 s->font->driver->draw (s, upper_len, len,
1393 x + glyph->slice.glyphless.lower_xoff,
1394 s->ybase + glyph->slice.glyphless.lower_yoff,
1395 0);
1396 }
1397 if (glyph->u.glyphless.method != GLYPHLESS_DISPLAY_THIN_SPACE)
1398 XDrawRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc,
1399 x, s->ybase - glyph->ascent,
1400 glyph->pixel_width - 1,
1401 glyph->ascent + glyph->descent - 1);
1402 x += glyph->pixel_width;
1403 }
1404 }
1405
1406 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
1407
1408 static struct frame *x_frame_of_widget (Widget);
1409 static Boolean cvt_string_to_pixel (Display *, XrmValue *, Cardinal *,
1410 XrmValue *, XrmValue *, XtPointer *);
1411 static void cvt_pixel_dtor (XtAppContext, XrmValue *, XtPointer,
1412 XrmValue *, Cardinal *);
1413
1414
1415 /* Return the frame on which widget WIDGET is used.. Abort if frame
1416 cannot be determined. */
1417
1418 static struct frame *
1419 x_frame_of_widget (Widget widget)
1420 {
1421 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
1422 Lisp_Object tail;
1423 struct frame *f;
1424
1425 dpyinfo = x_display_info_for_display (XtDisplay (widget));
1426
1427 /* Find the top-level shell of the widget. Note that this function
1428 can be called when the widget is not yet realized, so XtWindow
1429 (widget) == 0. That's the reason we can't simply use
1430 x_any_window_to_frame. */
1431 while (!XtIsTopLevelShell (widget))
1432 widget = XtParent (widget);
1433
1434 /* Look for a frame with that top-level widget. Allocate the color
1435 on that frame to get the right gamma correction value. */
1436 for (tail = Vframe_list; CONSP (tail); tail = XCDR (tail))
1437 if (FRAMEP (XCAR (tail))
1438 && (f = XFRAME (XCAR (tail)),
1439 (FRAME_X_P (f)
1440 && f->output_data.nothing != 1
1441 && FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f) == dpyinfo))
1442 && f->output_data.x->widget == widget)
1443 return f;
1444
1445 abort ();
1446 }
1447
1448
1449 /* Allocate the color COLOR->pixel on the screen and display of
1450 widget WIDGET in colormap CMAP. If an exact match cannot be
1451 allocated, try the nearest color available. Value is non-zero
1452 if successful. This is called from lwlib. */
1453
1454 int
1455 x_alloc_nearest_color_for_widget (Widget widget, Colormap cmap, XColor *color)
1456 {
1457 struct frame *f = x_frame_of_widget (widget);
1458 return x_alloc_nearest_color (f, cmap, color);
1459 }
1460
1461
1462 /* Allocate a color which is lighter or darker than *PIXEL by FACTOR
1463 or DELTA. Try a color with RGB values multiplied by FACTOR first.
1464 If this produces the same color as PIXEL, try a color where all RGB
1465 values have DELTA added. Return the allocated color in *PIXEL.
1466 DISPLAY is the X display, CMAP is the colormap to operate on.
1467 Value is non-zero if successful. */
1468
1469 int
1470 x_alloc_lighter_color_for_widget (Widget widget, Display *display, Colormap cmap,
1471 unsigned long *pixel, double factor, int delta)
1472 {
1473 struct frame *f = x_frame_of_widget (widget);
1474 return x_alloc_lighter_color (f, display, cmap, pixel, factor, delta);
1475 }
1476
1477
1478 /* Structure specifying which arguments should be passed by Xt to
1479 cvt_string_to_pixel. We want the widget's screen and colormap. */
1480
1481 static XtConvertArgRec cvt_string_to_pixel_args[] =
1482 {
1483 {XtWidgetBaseOffset, (XtPointer) XtOffset (Widget, core.screen),
1484 sizeof (Screen *)},
1485 {XtWidgetBaseOffset, (XtPointer) XtOffset (Widget, core.colormap),
1486 sizeof (Colormap)}
1487 };
1488
1489
1490 /* The address of this variable is returned by
1491 cvt_string_to_pixel. */
1492
1493 static Pixel cvt_string_to_pixel_value;
1494
1495
1496 /* Convert a color name to a pixel color.
1497
1498 DPY is the display we are working on.
1499
1500 ARGS is an array of *NARGS XrmValue structures holding additional
1501 information about the widget for which the conversion takes place.
1502 The contents of this array are determined by the specification
1503 in cvt_string_to_pixel_args.
1504
1505 FROM is a pointer to an XrmValue which points to the color name to
1506 convert. TO is an XrmValue in which to return the pixel color.
1507
1508 CLOSURE_RET is a pointer to user-data, in which we record if
1509 we allocated the color or not.
1510
1511 Value is True if successful, False otherwise. */
1512
1513 static Boolean
1514 cvt_string_to_pixel (Display *dpy, XrmValue *args, Cardinal *nargs,
1515 XrmValue *from, XrmValue *to,
1516 XtPointer *closure_ret)
1517 {
1518 Screen *screen;
1519 Colormap cmap;
1520 Pixel pixel;
1521 String color_name;
1522 XColor color;
1523
1524 if (*nargs != 2)
1525 {
1526 XtAppWarningMsg (XtDisplayToApplicationContext (dpy),
1527 "wrongParameters", "cvt_string_to_pixel",
1528 "XtToolkitError",
1529 "Screen and colormap args required", NULL, NULL);
1530 return False;
1531 }
1532
1533 screen = *(Screen **) args[0].addr;
1534 cmap = *(Colormap *) args[1].addr;
1535 color_name = (String) from->addr;
1536
1537 if (strcmp (color_name, XtDefaultBackground) == 0)
1538 {
1539 *closure_ret = (XtPointer) False;
1540 pixel = WhitePixelOfScreen (screen);
1541 }
1542 else if (strcmp (color_name, XtDefaultForeground) == 0)
1543 {
1544 *closure_ret = (XtPointer) False;
1545 pixel = BlackPixelOfScreen (screen);
1546 }
1547 else if (XParseColor (dpy, cmap, color_name, &color)
1548 && x_alloc_nearest_color_1 (dpy, cmap, &color))
1549 {
1550 pixel = color.pixel;
1551 *closure_ret = (XtPointer) True;
1552 }
1553 else
1554 {
1555 String params[1];
1556 Cardinal nparams = 1;
1557
1558 params[0] = color_name;
1559 XtAppWarningMsg (XtDisplayToApplicationContext (dpy),
1560 "badValue", "cvt_string_to_pixel",
1561 "XtToolkitError", "Invalid color `%s'",
1562 params, &nparams);
1563 return False;
1564 }
1565
1566 if (to->addr != NULL)
1567 {
1568 if (to->size < sizeof (Pixel))
1569 {
1570 to->size = sizeof (Pixel);
1571 return False;
1572 }
1573
1574 *(Pixel *) to->addr = pixel;
1575 }
1576 else
1577 {
1578 cvt_string_to_pixel_value = pixel;
1579 to->addr = (XtPointer) &cvt_string_to_pixel_value;
1580 }
1581
1582 to->size = sizeof (Pixel);
1583 return True;
1584 }
1585
1586
1587 /* Free a pixel color which was previously allocated via
1588 cvt_string_to_pixel. This is registered as the destructor
1589 for this type of resource via XtSetTypeConverter.
1590
1591 APP is the application context in which we work.
1592
1593 TO is a pointer to an XrmValue holding the color to free.
1594 CLOSURE is the value we stored in CLOSURE_RET for this color
1595 in cvt_string_to_pixel.
1596
1597 ARGS and NARGS are like for cvt_string_to_pixel. */
1598
1599 static void
1600 cvt_pixel_dtor (XtAppContext app, XrmValuePtr to, XtPointer closure, XrmValuePtr args,
1601 Cardinal *nargs)
1602 {
1603 if (*nargs != 2)
1604 {
1605 XtAppWarningMsg (app, "wrongParameters", "cvt_pixel_dtor",
1606 "XtToolkitError",
1607 "Screen and colormap arguments required",
1608 NULL, NULL);
1609 }
1610 else if (closure != NULL)
1611 {
1612 /* We did allocate the pixel, so free it. */
1613 Screen *screen = *(Screen **) args[0].addr;
1614 Colormap cmap = *(Colormap *) args[1].addr;
1615 x_free_dpy_colors (DisplayOfScreen (screen), screen, cmap,
1616 (Pixel *) to->addr, 1);
1617 }
1618 }
1619
1620
1621 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
1622
1623
1624 /* Value is an array of XColor structures for the contents of the
1625 color map of display DPY. Set *NCELLS to the size of the array.
1626 Note that this probably shouldn't be called for large color maps,
1627 say a 24-bit TrueColor map. */
1628
1629 static const XColor *
1630 x_color_cells (Display *dpy, int *ncells)
1631 {
1632 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = x_display_info_for_display (dpy);
1633
1634 if (dpyinfo->color_cells == NULL)
1635 {
1636 Screen *screen = dpyinfo->screen;
1637 int i;
1638
1639 dpyinfo->ncolor_cells
1640 = XDisplayCells (dpy, XScreenNumberOfScreen (screen));
1641 dpyinfo->color_cells
1642 = (XColor *) xmalloc (dpyinfo->ncolor_cells
1643 * sizeof *dpyinfo->color_cells);
1644
1645 for (i = 0; i < dpyinfo->ncolor_cells; ++i)
1646 dpyinfo->color_cells[i].pixel = i;
1647
1648 XQueryColors (dpy, dpyinfo->cmap,
1649 dpyinfo->color_cells, dpyinfo->ncolor_cells);
1650 }
1651
1652 *ncells = dpyinfo->ncolor_cells;
1653 return dpyinfo->color_cells;
1654 }
1655
1656
1657 /* On frame F, translate pixel colors to RGB values for the NCOLORS
1658 colors in COLORS. Use cached information, if available. */
1659
1660 void
1661 x_query_colors (struct frame *f, XColor *colors, int ncolors)
1662 {
1663 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
1664
1665 if (dpyinfo->color_cells)
1666 {
1667 int i;
1668 for (i = 0; i < ncolors; ++i)
1669 {
1670 unsigned long pixel = colors[i].pixel;
1671 xassert (pixel < dpyinfo->ncolor_cells);
1672 xassert (dpyinfo->color_cells[pixel].pixel == pixel);
1673 colors[i] = dpyinfo->color_cells[pixel];
1674 }
1675 }
1676 else
1677 XQueryColors (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_COLORMAP (f), colors, ncolors);
1678 }
1679
1680
1681 /* On frame F, translate pixel color to RGB values for the color in
1682 COLOR. Use cached information, if available. */
1683
1684 void
1685 x_query_color (struct frame *f, XColor *color)
1686 {
1687 x_query_colors (f, color, 1);
1688 }
1689
1690
1691 /* Allocate the color COLOR->pixel on DISPLAY, colormap CMAP. If an
1692 exact match can't be allocated, try the nearest color available.
1693 Value is non-zero if successful. Set *COLOR to the color
1694 allocated. */
1695
1696 static int
1697 x_alloc_nearest_color_1 (Display *dpy, Colormap cmap, XColor *color)
1698 {
1699 int rc;
1700
1701 rc = XAllocColor (dpy, cmap, color);
1702 if (rc == 0)
1703 {
1704 /* If we got to this point, the colormap is full, so we're going
1705 to try to get the next closest color. The algorithm used is
1706 a least-squares matching, which is what X uses for closest
1707 color matching with StaticColor visuals. */
1708 int nearest, i;
1709 unsigned long nearest_delta = ~0;
1710 int ncells;
1711 const XColor *cells = x_color_cells (dpy, &ncells);
1712
1713 for (nearest = i = 0; i < ncells; ++i)
1714 {
1715 long dred = (color->red >> 8) - (cells[i].red >> 8);
1716 long dgreen = (color->green >> 8) - (cells[i].green >> 8);
1717 long dblue = (color->blue >> 8) - (cells[i].blue >> 8);
1718 unsigned long delta = dred * dred + dgreen * dgreen + dblue * dblue;
1719
1720 if (delta < nearest_delta)
1721 {
1722 nearest = i;
1723 nearest_delta = delta;
1724 }
1725 }
1726
1727 color->red = cells[nearest].red;
1728 color->green = cells[nearest].green;
1729 color->blue = cells[nearest].blue;
1730 rc = XAllocColor (dpy, cmap, color);
1731 }
1732 else
1733 {
1734 /* If allocation succeeded, and the allocated pixel color is not
1735 equal to a cached pixel color recorded earlier, there was a
1736 change in the colormap, so clear the color cache. */
1737 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = x_display_info_for_display (dpy);
1738 XColor *cached_color;
1739
1740 if (dpyinfo->color_cells
1741 && (cached_color = &dpyinfo->color_cells[color->pixel],
1742 (cached_color->red != color->red
1743 || cached_color->blue != color->blue
1744 || cached_color->green != color->green)))
1745 {
1746 xfree (dpyinfo->color_cells);
1747 dpyinfo->color_cells = NULL;
1748 dpyinfo->ncolor_cells = 0;
1749 }
1750 }
1751
1752 #ifdef DEBUG_X_COLORS
1753 if (rc)
1754 register_color (color->pixel);
1755 #endif /* DEBUG_X_COLORS */
1756
1757 return rc;
1758 }
1759
1760
1761 /* Allocate the color COLOR->pixel on frame F, colormap CMAP. If an
1762 exact match can't be allocated, try the nearest color available.
1763 Value is non-zero if successful. Set *COLOR to the color
1764 allocated. */
1765
1766 int
1767 x_alloc_nearest_color (struct frame *f, Colormap cmap, XColor *color)
1768 {
1769 gamma_correct (f, color);
1770 return x_alloc_nearest_color_1 (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), cmap, color);
1771 }
1772
1773
1774 /* Allocate color PIXEL on frame F. PIXEL must already be allocated.
1775 It's necessary to do this instead of just using PIXEL directly to
1776 get color reference counts right. */
1777
1778 unsigned long
1779 x_copy_color (struct frame *f, long unsigned int pixel)
1780 {
1781 XColor color;
1782
1783 color.pixel = pixel;
1784 BLOCK_INPUT;
1785 x_query_color (f, &color);
1786 XAllocColor (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_COLORMAP (f), &color);
1787 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
1788 #ifdef DEBUG_X_COLORS
1789 register_color (pixel);
1790 #endif
1791 return color.pixel;
1792 }
1793
1794
1795 /* Allocate color PIXEL on display DPY. PIXEL must already be allocated.
1796 It's necessary to do this instead of just using PIXEL directly to
1797 get color reference counts right. */
1798
1799 unsigned long
1800 x_copy_dpy_color (Display *dpy, Colormap cmap, long unsigned int pixel)
1801 {
1802 XColor color;
1803
1804 color.pixel = pixel;
1805 BLOCK_INPUT;
1806 XQueryColor (dpy, cmap, &color);
1807 XAllocColor (dpy, cmap, &color);
1808 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
1809 #ifdef DEBUG_X_COLORS
1810 register_color (pixel);
1811 #endif
1812 return color.pixel;
1813 }
1814
1815
1816 /* Brightness beyond which a color won't have its highlight brightness
1817 boosted.
1818
1819 Nominally, highlight colors for `3d' faces are calculated by
1820 brightening an object's color by a constant scale factor, but this
1821 doesn't yield good results for dark colors, so for colors who's
1822 brightness is less than this value (on a scale of 0-65535) have an
1823 use an additional additive factor.
1824
1825 The value here is set so that the default menu-bar/mode-line color
1826 (grey75) will not have its highlights changed at all. */
1827 #define HIGHLIGHT_COLOR_DARK_BOOST_LIMIT 48000
1828
1829
1830 /* Allocate a color which is lighter or darker than *PIXEL by FACTOR
1831 or DELTA. Try a color with RGB values multiplied by FACTOR first.
1832 If this produces the same color as PIXEL, try a color where all RGB
1833 values have DELTA added. Return the allocated color in *PIXEL.
1834 DISPLAY is the X display, CMAP is the colormap to operate on.
1835 Value is non-zero if successful. */
1836
1837 static int
1838 x_alloc_lighter_color (struct frame *f, Display *display, Colormap cmap, long unsigned int *pixel, double factor, int delta)
1839 {
1840 XColor color, new;
1841 long bright;
1842 int success_p;
1843
1844 /* Get RGB color values. */
1845 color.pixel = *pixel;
1846 x_query_color (f, &color);
1847
1848 /* Change RGB values by specified FACTOR. Avoid overflow! */
1849 xassert (factor >= 0);
1850 new.red = min (0xffff, factor * color.red);
1851 new.green = min (0xffff, factor * color.green);
1852 new.blue = min (0xffff, factor * color.blue);
1853
1854 /* Calculate brightness of COLOR. */
1855 bright = (2 * color.red + 3 * color.green + color.blue) / 6;
1856
1857 /* We only boost colors that are darker than
1858 HIGHLIGHT_COLOR_DARK_BOOST_LIMIT. */
1859 if (bright < HIGHLIGHT_COLOR_DARK_BOOST_LIMIT)
1860 /* Make an additive adjustment to NEW, because it's dark enough so
1861 that scaling by FACTOR alone isn't enough. */
1862 {
1863 /* How far below the limit this color is (0 - 1, 1 being darker). */
1864 double dimness = 1 - (double)bright / HIGHLIGHT_COLOR_DARK_BOOST_LIMIT;
1865 /* The additive adjustment. */
1866 int min_delta = delta * dimness * factor / 2;
1867
1868 if (factor < 1)
1869 {
1870 new.red = max (0, new.red - min_delta);
1871 new.green = max (0, new.green - min_delta);
1872 new.blue = max (0, new.blue - min_delta);
1873 }
1874 else
1875 {
1876 new.red = min (0xffff, min_delta + new.red);
1877 new.green = min (0xffff, min_delta + new.green);
1878 new.blue = min (0xffff, min_delta + new.blue);
1879 }
1880 }
1881
1882 /* Try to allocate the color. */
1883 success_p = x_alloc_nearest_color (f, cmap, &new);
1884 if (success_p)
1885 {
1886 if (new.pixel == *pixel)
1887 {
1888 /* If we end up with the same color as before, try adding
1889 delta to the RGB values. */
1890 x_free_colors (f, &new.pixel, 1);
1891
1892 new.red = min (0xffff, delta + color.red);
1893 new.green = min (0xffff, delta + color.green);
1894 new.blue = min (0xffff, delta + color.blue);
1895 success_p = x_alloc_nearest_color (f, cmap, &new);
1896 }
1897 else
1898 success_p = 1;
1899 *pixel = new.pixel;
1900 }
1901
1902 return success_p;
1903 }
1904
1905
1906 /* Set up the foreground color for drawing relief lines of glyph
1907 string S. RELIEF is a pointer to a struct relief containing the GC
1908 with which lines will be drawn. Use a color that is FACTOR or
1909 DELTA lighter or darker than the relief's background which is found
1910 in S->f->output_data.x->relief_background. If such a color cannot
1911 be allocated, use DEFAULT_PIXEL, instead. */
1912
1913 static void
1914 x_setup_relief_color (struct frame *f, struct relief *relief, double factor, int delta, long unsigned int default_pixel)
1915 {
1916 XGCValues xgcv;
1917 struct x_output *di = f->output_data.x;
1918 unsigned long mask = GCForeground | GCLineWidth | GCGraphicsExposures;
1919 unsigned long pixel;
1920 unsigned long background = di->relief_background;
1921 Colormap cmap = FRAME_X_COLORMAP (f);
1922 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
1923 Display *dpy = FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f);
1924
1925 xgcv.graphics_exposures = False;
1926 xgcv.line_width = 1;
1927
1928 /* Free previously allocated color. The color cell will be reused
1929 when it has been freed as many times as it was allocated, so this
1930 doesn't affect faces using the same colors. */
1931 if (relief->gc
1932 && relief->allocated_p)
1933 {
1934 x_free_colors (f, &relief->pixel, 1);
1935 relief->allocated_p = 0;
1936 }
1937
1938 /* Allocate new color. */
1939 xgcv.foreground = default_pixel;
1940 pixel = background;
1941 if (dpyinfo->n_planes != 1
1942 && x_alloc_lighter_color (f, dpy, cmap, &pixel, factor, delta))
1943 {
1944 relief->allocated_p = 1;
1945 xgcv.foreground = relief->pixel = pixel;
1946 }
1947
1948 if (relief->gc == 0)
1949 {
1950 xgcv.stipple = dpyinfo->gray;
1951 mask |= GCStipple;
1952 relief->gc = XCreateGC (dpy, FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), mask, &xgcv);
1953 }
1954 else
1955 XChangeGC (dpy, relief->gc, mask, &xgcv);
1956 }
1957
1958
1959 /* Set up colors for the relief lines around glyph string S. */
1960
1961 static void
1962 x_setup_relief_colors (struct glyph_string *s)
1963 {
1964 struct x_output *di = s->f->output_data.x;
1965 unsigned long color;
1966
1967 if (s->face->use_box_color_for_shadows_p)
1968 color = s->face->box_color;
1969 else if (s->first_glyph->type == IMAGE_GLYPH
1970 && s->img->pixmap
1971 && !IMAGE_BACKGROUND_TRANSPARENT (s->img, s->f, 0))
1972 color = IMAGE_BACKGROUND (s->img, s->f, 0);
1973 else
1974 {
1975 XGCValues xgcv;
1976
1977 /* Get the background color of the face. */
1978 XGetGCValues (s->display, s->gc, GCBackground, &xgcv);
1979 color = xgcv.background;
1980 }
1981
1982 if (di->white_relief.gc == 0
1983 || color != di->relief_background)
1984 {
1985 di->relief_background = color;
1986 x_setup_relief_color (s->f, &di->white_relief, 1.2, 0x8000,
1987 WHITE_PIX_DEFAULT (s->f));
1988 x_setup_relief_color (s->f, &di->black_relief, 0.6, 0x4000,
1989 BLACK_PIX_DEFAULT (s->f));
1990 }
1991 }
1992
1993
1994 /* Draw a relief on frame F inside the rectangle given by LEFT_X,
1995 TOP_Y, RIGHT_X, and BOTTOM_Y. WIDTH is the thickness of the relief
1996 to draw, it must be >= 0. RAISED_P non-zero means draw a raised
1997 relief. LEFT_P non-zero means draw a relief on the left side of
1998 the rectangle. RIGHT_P non-zero means draw a relief on the right
1999 side of the rectangle. CLIP_RECT is the clipping rectangle to use
2000 when drawing. */
2001
2002 static void
2003 x_draw_relief_rect (struct frame *f,
2004 int left_x, int top_y, int right_x, int bottom_y, int width,
2005 int raised_p, int top_p, int bot_p, int left_p, int right_p,
2006 XRectangle *clip_rect)
2007 {
2008 Display *dpy = FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f);
2009 Window window = FRAME_X_WINDOW (f);
2010 int i;
2011 GC gc;
2012
2013 if (raised_p)
2014 gc = f->output_data.x->white_relief.gc;
2015 else
2016 gc = f->output_data.x->black_relief.gc;
2017 XSetClipRectangles (dpy, gc, 0, 0, clip_rect, 1, Unsorted);
2018
2019 /* This code is more complicated than it has to be, because of two
2020 minor hacks to make the boxes look nicer: (i) if width > 1, draw
2021 the outermost line using the black relief. (ii) Omit the four
2022 corner pixels. */
2023
2024 /* Top. */
2025 if (top_p)
2026 {
2027 if (width == 1)
2028 XDrawLine (dpy, window, gc,
2029 left_x + (left_p ? 1 : 0), top_y,
2030 right_x + (right_p ? 0 : 1), top_y);
2031
2032 for (i = 1; i < width; ++i)
2033 XDrawLine (dpy, window, gc,
2034 left_x + i * left_p, top_y + i,
2035 right_x + 1 - i * right_p, top_y + i);
2036 }
2037
2038 /* Left. */
2039 if (left_p)
2040 {
2041 if (width == 1)
2042 XDrawLine (dpy, window, gc, left_x, top_y + 1, left_x, bottom_y);
2043
2044 XClearArea (dpy, window, left_x, top_y, 1, 1, False);
2045 XClearArea (dpy, window, left_x, bottom_y, 1, 1, False);
2046
2047 for (i = (width > 1 ? 1 : 0); i < width; ++i)
2048 XDrawLine (dpy, window, gc,
2049 left_x + i, top_y + i, left_x + i, bottom_y - i + 1);
2050 }
2051
2052 XSetClipMask (dpy, gc, None);
2053 if (raised_p)
2054 gc = f->output_data.x->black_relief.gc;
2055 else
2056 gc = f->output_data.x->white_relief.gc;
2057 XSetClipRectangles (dpy, gc, 0, 0, clip_rect, 1, Unsorted);
2058
2059 if (width > 1)
2060 {
2061 /* Outermost top line. */
2062 if (top_p)
2063 XDrawLine (dpy, window, gc,
2064 left_x + (left_p ? 1 : 0), top_y,
2065 right_x + (right_p ? 0 : 1), top_y);
2066
2067 /* Outermost left line. */
2068 if (left_p)
2069 XDrawLine (dpy, window, gc, left_x, top_y + 1, left_x, bottom_y);
2070 }
2071
2072 /* Bottom. */
2073 if (bot_p)
2074 {
2075 XDrawLine (dpy, window, gc,
2076 left_x + (left_p ? 1 : 0), bottom_y,
2077 right_x + (right_p ? 0 : 1), bottom_y);
2078 for (i = 1; i < width; ++i)
2079 XDrawLine (dpy, window, gc,
2080 left_x + i * left_p, bottom_y - i,
2081 right_x + 1 - i * right_p, bottom_y - i);
2082 }
2083
2084 /* Right. */
2085 if (right_p)
2086 {
2087 XClearArea (dpy, window, right_x, top_y, 1, 1, False);
2088 XClearArea (dpy, window, right_x, bottom_y, 1, 1, False);
2089 for (i = 0; i < width; ++i)
2090 XDrawLine (dpy, window, gc,
2091 right_x - i, top_y + i + 1, right_x - i, bottom_y - i);
2092 }
2093
2094 XSetClipMask (dpy, gc, None);
2095 }
2096
2097
2098 /* Draw a box on frame F inside the rectangle given by LEFT_X, TOP_Y,
2099 RIGHT_X, and BOTTOM_Y. WIDTH is the thickness of the lines to
2100 draw, it must be >= 0. LEFT_P non-zero means draw a line on the
2101 left side of the rectangle. RIGHT_P non-zero means draw a line
2102 on the right side of the rectangle. CLIP_RECT is the clipping
2103 rectangle to use when drawing. */
2104
2105 static void
2106 x_draw_box_rect (struct glyph_string *s,
2107 int left_x, int top_y, int right_x, int bottom_y, int width,
2108 int left_p, int right_p, XRectangle *clip_rect)
2109 {
2110 XGCValues xgcv;
2111
2112 XGetGCValues (s->display, s->gc, GCForeground, &xgcv);
2113 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, s->face->box_color);
2114 XSetClipRectangles (s->display, s->gc, 0, 0, clip_rect, 1, Unsorted);
2115
2116 /* Top. */
2117 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc,
2118 left_x, top_y, right_x - left_x + 1, width);
2119
2120 /* Left. */
2121 if (left_p)
2122 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc,
2123 left_x, top_y, width, bottom_y - top_y + 1);
2124
2125 /* Bottom. */
2126 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc,
2127 left_x, bottom_y - width + 1, right_x - left_x + 1, width);
2128
2129 /* Right. */
2130 if (right_p)
2131 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc,
2132 right_x - width + 1, top_y, width, bottom_y - top_y + 1);
2133
2134 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, xgcv.foreground);
2135 XSetClipMask (s->display, s->gc, None);
2136 }
2137
2138
2139 /* Draw a box around glyph string S. */
2140
2141 static void
2142 x_draw_glyph_string_box (struct glyph_string *s)
2143 {
2144 int width, left_x, right_x, top_y, bottom_y, last_x, raised_p;
2145 int left_p, right_p;
2146 struct glyph *last_glyph;
2147 XRectangle clip_rect;
2148
2149 last_x = ((s->row->full_width_p && !s->w->pseudo_window_p)
2150 ? WINDOW_RIGHT_EDGE_X (s->w)
2151 : window_box_right (s->w, s->area));
2152
2153 /* The glyph that may have a right box line. */
2154 last_glyph = (s->cmp || s->img
2155 ? s->first_glyph
2156 : s->first_glyph + s->nchars - 1);
2157
2158 width = eabs (s->face->box_line_width);
2159 raised_p = s->face->box == FACE_RAISED_BOX;
2160 left_x = s->x;
2161 right_x = (s->row->full_width_p && s->extends_to_end_of_line_p
2162 ? last_x - 1
2163 : min (last_x, s->x + s->background_width) - 1);
2164 top_y = s->y;
2165 bottom_y = top_y + s->height - 1;
2166
2167 left_p = (s->first_glyph->left_box_line_p
2168 || (s->hl == DRAW_MOUSE_FACE
2169 && (s->prev == NULL
2170 || s->prev->hl != s->hl)));
2171 right_p = (last_glyph->right_box_line_p
2172 || (s->hl == DRAW_MOUSE_FACE
2173 && (s->next == NULL
2174 || s->next->hl != s->hl)));
2175
2176 get_glyph_string_clip_rect (s, &clip_rect);
2177
2178 if (s->face->box == FACE_SIMPLE_BOX)
2179 x_draw_box_rect (s, left_x, top_y, right_x, bottom_y, width,
2180 left_p, right_p, &clip_rect);
2181 else
2182 {
2183 x_setup_relief_colors (s);
2184 x_draw_relief_rect (s->f, left_x, top_y, right_x, bottom_y,
2185 width, raised_p, 1, 1, left_p, right_p, &clip_rect);
2186 }
2187 }
2188
2189
2190 /* Draw foreground of image glyph string S. */
2191
2192 static void
2193 x_draw_image_foreground (struct glyph_string *s)
2194 {
2195 int x = s->x;
2196 int y = s->ybase - image_ascent (s->img, s->face, &s->slice);
2197
2198 /* If first glyph of S has a left box line, start drawing it to the
2199 right of that line. */
2200 if (s->face->box != FACE_NO_BOX
2201 && s->first_glyph->left_box_line_p
2202 && s->slice.x == 0)
2203 x += eabs (s->face->box_line_width);
2204
2205 /* If there is a margin around the image, adjust x- and y-position
2206 by that margin. */
2207 if (s->slice.x == 0)
2208 x += s->img->hmargin;
2209 if (s->slice.y == 0)
2210 y += s->img->vmargin;
2211
2212 if (s->img->pixmap)
2213 {
2214 if (s->img->mask)
2215 {
2216 /* We can't set both a clip mask and use XSetClipRectangles
2217 because the latter also sets a clip mask. We also can't
2218 trust on the shape extension to be available
2219 (XShapeCombineRegion). So, compute the rectangle to draw
2220 manually. */
2221 unsigned long mask = (GCClipMask | GCClipXOrigin | GCClipYOrigin
2222 | GCFunction);
2223 XGCValues xgcv;
2224 XRectangle clip_rect, image_rect, r;
2225
2226 xgcv.clip_mask = s->img->mask;
2227 xgcv.clip_x_origin = x;
2228 xgcv.clip_y_origin = y;
2229 xgcv.function = GXcopy;
2230 XChangeGC (s->display, s->gc, mask, &xgcv);
2231
2232 get_glyph_string_clip_rect (s, &clip_rect);
2233 image_rect.x = x;
2234 image_rect.y = y;
2235 image_rect.width = s->slice.width;
2236 image_rect.height = s->slice.height;
2237 if (x_intersect_rectangles (&clip_rect, &image_rect, &r))
2238 XCopyArea (s->display, s->img->pixmap, s->window, s->gc,
2239 s->slice.x + r.x - x, s->slice.y + r.y - y,
2240 r.width, r.height, r.x, r.y);
2241 }
2242 else
2243 {
2244 XRectangle clip_rect, image_rect, r;
2245
2246 get_glyph_string_clip_rect (s, &clip_rect);
2247 image_rect.x = x;
2248 image_rect.y = y;
2249 image_rect.width = s->slice.width;
2250 image_rect.height = s->slice.height;
2251 if (x_intersect_rectangles (&clip_rect, &image_rect, &r))
2252 XCopyArea (s->display, s->img->pixmap, s->window, s->gc,
2253 s->slice.x + r.x - x, s->slice.y + r.y - y,
2254 r.width, r.height, r.x, r.y);
2255
2256 /* When the image has a mask, we can expect that at
2257 least part of a mouse highlight or a block cursor will
2258 be visible. If the image doesn't have a mask, make
2259 a block cursor visible by drawing a rectangle around
2260 the image. I believe it's looking better if we do
2261 nothing here for mouse-face. */
2262 if (s->hl == DRAW_CURSOR)
2263 {
2264 int r = s->img->relief;
2265 if (r < 0) r = -r;
2266 XDrawRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc,
2267 x - r, y - r,
2268 s->slice.width + r*2 - 1,
2269 s->slice.height + r*2 - 1);
2270 }
2271 }
2272 }
2273 else
2274 /* Draw a rectangle if image could not be loaded. */
2275 XDrawRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc, x, y,
2276 s->slice.width - 1, s->slice.height - 1);
2277 }
2278
2279
2280 /* Draw a relief around the image glyph string S. */
2281
2282 static void
2283 x_draw_image_relief (struct glyph_string *s)
2284 {
2285 int x0, y0, x1, y1, thick, raised_p, extra;
2286 XRectangle r;
2287 int x = s->x;
2288 int y = s->ybase - image_ascent (s->img, s->face, &s->slice);
2289
2290 /* If first glyph of S has a left box line, start drawing it to the
2291 right of that line. */
2292 if (s->face->box != FACE_NO_BOX
2293 && s->first_glyph->left_box_line_p
2294 && s->slice.x == 0)
2295 x += eabs (s->face->box_line_width);
2296
2297 /* If there is a margin around the image, adjust x- and y-position
2298 by that margin. */
2299 if (s->slice.x == 0)
2300 x += s->img->hmargin;
2301 if (s->slice.y == 0)
2302 y += s->img->vmargin;
2303
2304 if (s->hl == DRAW_IMAGE_SUNKEN
2305 || s->hl == DRAW_IMAGE_RAISED)
2306 {
2307 thick = tool_bar_button_relief >= 0 ? tool_bar_button_relief : DEFAULT_TOOL_BAR_BUTTON_RELIEF;
2308 raised_p = s->hl == DRAW_IMAGE_RAISED;
2309 }
2310 else
2311 {
2312 thick = eabs (s->img->relief);
2313 raised_p = s->img->relief > 0;
2314 }
2315
2316 extra = s->face->id == TOOL_BAR_FACE_ID
2317 ? XINT (Vtool_bar_button_margin) : 0;
2318
2319 x0 = x - thick - extra;
2320 y0 = y - thick - extra;
2321 x1 = x + s->slice.width + thick - 1 + extra;
2322 y1 = y + s->slice.height + thick - 1 + extra;
2323
2324 x_setup_relief_colors (s);
2325 get_glyph_string_clip_rect (s, &r);
2326 x_draw_relief_rect (s->f, x0, y0, x1, y1, thick, raised_p,
2327 s->slice.y == 0,
2328 s->slice.y + s->slice.height == s->img->height,
2329 s->slice.x == 0,
2330 s->slice.x + s->slice.width == s->img->width,
2331 &r);
2332 }
2333
2334
2335 /* Draw the foreground of image glyph string S to PIXMAP. */
2336
2337 static void
2338 x_draw_image_foreground_1 (struct glyph_string *s, Pixmap pixmap)
2339 {
2340 int x = 0;
2341 int y = s->ybase - s->y - image_ascent (s->img, s->face, &s->slice);
2342
2343 /* If first glyph of S has a left box line, start drawing it to the
2344 right of that line. */
2345 if (s->face->box != FACE_NO_BOX
2346 && s->first_glyph->left_box_line_p
2347 && s->slice.x == 0)
2348 x += eabs (s->face->box_line_width);
2349
2350 /* If there is a margin around the image, adjust x- and y-position
2351 by that margin. */
2352 if (s->slice.x == 0)
2353 x += s->img->hmargin;
2354 if (s->slice.y == 0)
2355 y += s->img->vmargin;
2356
2357 if (s->img->pixmap)
2358 {
2359 if (s->img->mask)
2360 {
2361 /* We can't set both a clip mask and use XSetClipRectangles
2362 because the latter also sets a clip mask. We also can't
2363 trust on the shape extension to be available
2364 (XShapeCombineRegion). So, compute the rectangle to draw
2365 manually. */
2366 unsigned long mask = (GCClipMask | GCClipXOrigin | GCClipYOrigin
2367 | GCFunction);
2368 XGCValues xgcv;
2369
2370 xgcv.clip_mask = s->img->mask;
2371 xgcv.clip_x_origin = x - s->slice.x;
2372 xgcv.clip_y_origin = y - s->slice.y;
2373 xgcv.function = GXcopy;
2374 XChangeGC (s->display, s->gc, mask, &xgcv);
2375
2376 XCopyArea (s->display, s->img->pixmap, pixmap, s->gc,
2377 s->slice.x, s->slice.y,
2378 s->slice.width, s->slice.height, x, y);
2379 XSetClipMask (s->display, s->gc, None);
2380 }
2381 else
2382 {
2383 XCopyArea (s->display, s->img->pixmap, pixmap, s->gc,
2384 s->slice.x, s->slice.y,
2385 s->slice.width, s->slice.height, x, y);
2386
2387 /* When the image has a mask, we can expect that at
2388 least part of a mouse highlight or a block cursor will
2389 be visible. If the image doesn't have a mask, make
2390 a block cursor visible by drawing a rectangle around
2391 the image. I believe it's looking better if we do
2392 nothing here for mouse-face. */
2393 if (s->hl == DRAW_CURSOR)
2394 {
2395 int r = s->img->relief;
2396 if (r < 0) r = -r;
2397 XDrawRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc, x - r, y - r,
2398 s->slice.width + r*2 - 1,
2399 s->slice.height + r*2 - 1);
2400 }
2401 }
2402 }
2403 else
2404 /* Draw a rectangle if image could not be loaded. */
2405 XDrawRectangle (s->display, pixmap, s->gc, x, y,
2406 s->slice.width - 1, s->slice.height - 1);
2407 }
2408
2409
2410 /* Draw part of the background of glyph string S. X, Y, W, and H
2411 give the rectangle to draw. */
2412
2413 static void
2414 x_draw_glyph_string_bg_rect (struct glyph_string *s, int x, int y, int w, int h)
2415 {
2416 if (s->stippled_p)
2417 {
2418 /* Fill background with a stipple pattern. */
2419 XSetFillStyle (s->display, s->gc, FillOpaqueStippled);
2420 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc, x, y, w, h);
2421 XSetFillStyle (s->display, s->gc, FillSolid);
2422 }
2423 else
2424 x_clear_glyph_string_rect (s, x, y, w, h);
2425 }
2426
2427
2428 /* Draw image glyph string S.
2429
2430 s->y
2431 s->x +-------------------------
2432 | s->face->box
2433 |
2434 | +-------------------------
2435 | | s->img->margin
2436 | |
2437 | | +-------------------
2438 | | | the image
2439
2440 */
2441
2442 static void
2443 x_draw_image_glyph_string (struct glyph_string *s)
2444 {
2445 int box_line_hwidth = eabs (s->face->box_line_width);
2446 int box_line_vwidth = max (s->face->box_line_width, 0);
2447 int height;
2448 Pixmap pixmap = None;
2449
2450 height = s->height;
2451 if (s->slice.y == 0)
2452 height -= box_line_vwidth;
2453 if (s->slice.y + s->slice.height >= s->img->height)
2454 height -= box_line_vwidth;
2455
2456 /* Fill background with face under the image. Do it only if row is
2457 taller than image or if image has a clip mask to reduce
2458 flickering. */
2459 s->stippled_p = s->face->stipple != 0;
2460 if (height > s->slice.height
2461 || s->img->hmargin
2462 || s->img->vmargin
2463 || s->img->mask
2464 || s->img->pixmap == 0
2465 || s->width != s->background_width)
2466 {
2467 if (s->img->mask)
2468 {
2469 /* Create a pixmap as large as the glyph string. Fill it
2470 with the background color. Copy the image to it, using
2471 its mask. Copy the temporary pixmap to the display. */
2472 Screen *screen = FRAME_X_SCREEN (s->f);
2473 int depth = DefaultDepthOfScreen (screen);
2474
2475 /* Create a pixmap as large as the glyph string. */
2476 pixmap = XCreatePixmap (s->display, s->window,
2477 s->background_width,
2478 s->height, depth);
2479
2480 /* Don't clip in the following because we're working on the
2481 pixmap. */
2482 XSetClipMask (s->display, s->gc, None);
2483
2484 /* Fill the pixmap with the background color/stipple. */
2485 if (s->stippled_p)
2486 {
2487 /* Fill background with a stipple pattern. */
2488 XSetFillStyle (s->display, s->gc, FillOpaqueStippled);
2489 XSetTSOrigin (s->display, s->gc, - s->x, - s->y);
2490 XFillRectangle (s->display, pixmap, s->gc,
2491 0, 0, s->background_width, s->height);
2492 XSetFillStyle (s->display, s->gc, FillSolid);
2493 XSetTSOrigin (s->display, s->gc, 0, 0);
2494 }
2495 else
2496 {
2497 XGCValues xgcv;
2498 XGetGCValues (s->display, s->gc, GCForeground | GCBackground,
2499 &xgcv);
2500 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, xgcv.background);
2501 XFillRectangle (s->display, pixmap, s->gc,
2502 0, 0, s->background_width, s->height);
2503 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, xgcv.foreground);
2504 }
2505 }
2506 else
2507 {
2508 int x = s->x;
2509 int y = s->y;
2510
2511 if (s->first_glyph->left_box_line_p
2512 && s->slice.x == 0)
2513 x += box_line_hwidth;
2514
2515 if (s->slice.y == 0)
2516 y += box_line_vwidth;
2517
2518 x_draw_glyph_string_bg_rect (s, x, y, s->background_width, height);
2519 }
2520
2521 s->background_filled_p = 1;
2522 }
2523
2524 /* Draw the foreground. */
2525 if (pixmap != None)
2526 {
2527 x_draw_image_foreground_1 (s, pixmap);
2528 x_set_glyph_string_clipping (s);
2529 XCopyArea (s->display, pixmap, s->window, s->gc,
2530 0, 0, s->background_width, s->height, s->x, s->y);
2531 XFreePixmap (s->display, pixmap);
2532 }
2533 else
2534 x_draw_image_foreground (s);
2535
2536 /* If we must draw a relief around the image, do it. */
2537 if (s->img->relief
2538 || s->hl == DRAW_IMAGE_RAISED
2539 || s->hl == DRAW_IMAGE_SUNKEN)
2540 x_draw_image_relief (s);
2541 }
2542
2543
2544 /* Draw stretch glyph string S. */
2545
2546 static void
2547 x_draw_stretch_glyph_string (struct glyph_string *s)
2548 {
2549 xassert (s->first_glyph->type == STRETCH_GLYPH);
2550
2551 if (s->hl == DRAW_CURSOR
2552 && !x_stretch_cursor_p)
2553 {
2554 /* If `x-stretch-cursor' is nil, don't draw a block cursor as
2555 wide as the stretch glyph. */
2556 int width, background_width = s->background_width;
2557 int x = s->x;
2558
2559 if (!s->row->reversed_p)
2560 {
2561 int left_x = window_box_left_offset (s->w, TEXT_AREA);
2562
2563 if (x < left_x)
2564 {
2565 background_width -= left_x - x;
2566 x = left_x;
2567 }
2568 }
2569 else
2570 {
2571 /* In R2L rows, draw the cursor on the right edge of the
2572 stretch glyph. */
2573 int right_x = window_box_right_offset (s->w, TEXT_AREA);
2574
2575 if (x + background_width > right_x)
2576 background_width -= x - right_x;
2577 x += background_width;
2578 }
2579 width = min (FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (s->f), background_width);
2580 if (s->row->reversed_p)
2581 x -= width;
2582
2583 /* Draw cursor. */
2584 x_draw_glyph_string_bg_rect (s, x, s->y, width, s->height);
2585
2586 /* Clear rest using the GC of the original non-cursor face. */
2587 if (width < background_width)
2588 {
2589 int y = s->y;
2590 int w = background_width - width, h = s->height;
2591 XRectangle r;
2592 GC gc;
2593
2594 if (!s->row->reversed_p)
2595 x += width;
2596 else
2597 x = s->x;
2598 if (s->row->mouse_face_p
2599 && cursor_in_mouse_face_p (s->w))
2600 {
2601 x_set_mouse_face_gc (s);
2602 gc = s->gc;
2603 }
2604 else
2605 gc = s->face->gc;
2606
2607 get_glyph_string_clip_rect (s, &r);
2608 XSetClipRectangles (s->display, gc, 0, 0, &r, 1, Unsorted);
2609
2610 if (s->face->stipple)
2611 {
2612 /* Fill background with a stipple pattern. */
2613 XSetFillStyle (s->display, gc, FillOpaqueStippled);
2614 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, gc, x, y, w, h);
2615 XSetFillStyle (s->display, gc, FillSolid);
2616 }
2617 else
2618 {
2619 XGCValues xgcv;
2620 XGetGCValues (s->display, gc, GCForeground | GCBackground, &xgcv);
2621 XSetForeground (s->display, gc, xgcv.background);
2622 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, gc, x, y, w, h);
2623 XSetForeground (s->display, gc, xgcv.foreground);
2624 }
2625 }
2626 }
2627 else if (!s->background_filled_p)
2628 {
2629 int background_width = s->background_width;
2630 int x = s->x, left_x = window_box_left_offset (s->w, TEXT_AREA);
2631
2632 /* Don't draw into left margin, fringe or scrollbar area
2633 except for header line and mode line. */
2634 if (x < left_x && !s->row->mode_line_p)
2635 {
2636 background_width -= left_x - x;
2637 x = left_x;
2638 }
2639 if (background_width > 0)
2640 x_draw_glyph_string_bg_rect (s, x, s->y, background_width, s->height);
2641 }
2642
2643 s->background_filled_p = 1;
2644 }
2645
2646
2647 /* Draw glyph string S. */
2648
2649 static void
2650 x_draw_glyph_string (struct glyph_string *s)
2651 {
2652 int relief_drawn_p = 0;
2653
2654 /* If S draws into the background of its successors, draw the
2655 background of the successors first so that S can draw into it.
2656 This makes S->next use XDrawString instead of XDrawImageString. */
2657 if (s->next && s->right_overhang && !s->for_overlaps)
2658 {
2659 int width;
2660 struct glyph_string *next;
2661
2662 for (width = 0, next = s->next;
2663 next && width < s->right_overhang;
2664 width += next->width, next = next->next)
2665 if (next->first_glyph->type != IMAGE_GLYPH)
2666 {
2667 x_set_glyph_string_gc (next);
2668 x_set_glyph_string_clipping (next);
2669 if (next->first_glyph->type == STRETCH_GLYPH)
2670 x_draw_stretch_glyph_string (next);
2671 else
2672 x_draw_glyph_string_background (next, 1);
2673 next->num_clips = 0;
2674 }
2675 }
2676
2677 /* Set up S->gc, set clipping and draw S. */
2678 x_set_glyph_string_gc (s);
2679
2680 /* Draw relief (if any) in advance for char/composition so that the
2681 glyph string can be drawn over it. */
2682 if (!s->for_overlaps
2683 && s->face->box != FACE_NO_BOX
2684 && (s->first_glyph->type == CHAR_GLYPH
2685 || s->first_glyph->type == COMPOSITE_GLYPH))
2686
2687 {
2688 x_set_glyph_string_clipping (s);
2689 x_draw_glyph_string_background (s, 1);
2690 x_draw_glyph_string_box (s);
2691 x_set_glyph_string_clipping (s);
2692 relief_drawn_p = 1;
2693 }
2694 else if (!s->clip_head /* draw_glyphs didn't specify a clip mask. */
2695 && !s->clip_tail
2696 && ((s->prev && s->prev->hl != s->hl && s->left_overhang)
2697 || (s->next && s->next->hl != s->hl && s->right_overhang)))
2698 /* We must clip just this glyph. left_overhang part has already
2699 drawn when s->prev was drawn, and right_overhang part will be
2700 drawn later when s->next is drawn. */
2701 x_set_glyph_string_clipping_exactly (s, s);
2702 else
2703 x_set_glyph_string_clipping (s);
2704
2705 switch (s->first_glyph->type)
2706 {
2707 case IMAGE_GLYPH:
2708 x_draw_image_glyph_string (s);
2709 break;
2710
2711 case STRETCH_GLYPH:
2712 x_draw_stretch_glyph_string (s);
2713 break;
2714
2715 case CHAR_GLYPH:
2716 if (s->for_overlaps)
2717 s->background_filled_p = 1;
2718 else
2719 x_draw_glyph_string_background (s, 0);
2720 x_draw_glyph_string_foreground (s);
2721 break;
2722
2723 case COMPOSITE_GLYPH:
2724 if (s->for_overlaps || (s->cmp_from > 0
2725 && ! s->first_glyph->u.cmp.automatic))
2726 s->background_filled_p = 1;
2727 else
2728 x_draw_glyph_string_background (s, 1);
2729 x_draw_composite_glyph_string_foreground (s);
2730 break;
2731
2732 case GLYPHLESS_GLYPH:
2733 if (s->for_overlaps)
2734 s->background_filled_p = 1;
2735 else
2736 x_draw_glyph_string_background (s, 1);
2737 x_draw_glyphless_glyph_string_foreground (s);
2738 break;
2739
2740 default:
2741 abort ();
2742 }
2743
2744 if (!s->for_overlaps)
2745 {
2746 /* Draw underline. */
2747 if (s->face->underline_p)
2748 {
2749 unsigned long thickness, position;
2750 int y;
2751
2752 if (s->prev && s->prev->face->underline_p)
2753 {
2754 /* We use the same underline style as the previous one. */
2755 thickness = s->prev->underline_thickness;
2756 position = s->prev->underline_position;
2757 }
2758 else
2759 {
2760 /* Get the underline thickness. Default is 1 pixel. */
2761 if (s->font && s->font->underline_thickness > 0)
2762 thickness = s->font->underline_thickness;
2763 else
2764 thickness = 1;
2765 if (x_underline_at_descent_line)
2766 position = (s->height - thickness) - (s->ybase - s->y);
2767 else
2768 {
2769 /* Get the underline position. This is the recommended
2770 vertical offset in pixels from the baseline to the top of
2771 the underline. This is a signed value according to the
2772 specs, and its default is
2773
2774 ROUND ((maximum descent) / 2), with
2775 ROUND(x) = floor (x + 0.5) */
2776
2777 if (x_use_underline_position_properties
2778 && s->font && s->font->underline_position >= 0)
2779 position = s->font->underline_position;
2780 else if (s->font)
2781 position = (s->font->descent + 1) / 2;
2782 else
2783 position = underline_minimum_offset;
2784 }
2785 position = max (position, underline_minimum_offset);
2786 }
2787 /* Check the sanity of thickness and position. We should
2788 avoid drawing underline out of the current line area. */
2789 if (s->y + s->height <= s->ybase + position)
2790 position = (s->height - 1) - (s->ybase - s->y);
2791 if (s->y + s->height < s->ybase + position + thickness)
2792 thickness = (s->y + s->height) - (s->ybase + position);
2793 s->underline_thickness = thickness;
2794 s->underline_position = position;
2795 y = s->ybase + position;
2796 if (s->face->underline_defaulted_p)
2797 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc,
2798 s->x, y, s->width, thickness);
2799 else
2800 {
2801 XGCValues xgcv;
2802 XGetGCValues (s->display, s->gc, GCForeground, &xgcv);
2803 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, s->face->underline_color);
2804 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc,
2805 s->x, y, s->width, thickness);
2806 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, xgcv.foreground);
2807 }
2808 }
2809
2810 /* Draw overline. */
2811 if (s->face->overline_p)
2812 {
2813 unsigned long dy = 0, h = 1;
2814
2815 if (s->face->overline_color_defaulted_p)
2816 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc, s->x, s->y + dy,
2817 s->width, h);
2818 else
2819 {
2820 XGCValues xgcv;
2821 XGetGCValues (s->display, s->gc, GCForeground, &xgcv);
2822 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, s->face->overline_color);
2823 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc, s->x, s->y + dy,
2824 s->width, h);
2825 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, xgcv.foreground);
2826 }
2827 }
2828
2829 /* Draw strike-through. */
2830 if (s->face->strike_through_p)
2831 {
2832 unsigned long h = 1;
2833 unsigned long dy = (s->height - h) / 2;
2834
2835 if (s->face->strike_through_color_defaulted_p)
2836 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc, s->x, s->y + dy,
2837 s->width, h);
2838 else
2839 {
2840 XGCValues xgcv;
2841 XGetGCValues (s->display, s->gc, GCForeground, &xgcv);
2842 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, s->face->strike_through_color);
2843 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc, s->x, s->y + dy,
2844 s->width, h);
2845 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, xgcv.foreground);
2846 }
2847 }
2848
2849 /* Draw relief if not yet drawn. */
2850 if (!relief_drawn_p && s->face->box != FACE_NO_BOX)
2851 x_draw_glyph_string_box (s);
2852
2853 if (s->prev)
2854 {
2855 struct glyph_string *prev;
2856
2857 for (prev = s->prev; prev; prev = prev->prev)
2858 if (prev->hl != s->hl
2859 && prev->x + prev->width + prev->right_overhang > s->x)
2860 {
2861 /* As prev was drawn while clipped to its own area, we
2862 must draw the right_overhang part using s->hl now. */
2863 enum draw_glyphs_face save = prev->hl;
2864
2865 prev->hl = s->hl;
2866 x_set_glyph_string_gc (prev);
2867 x_set_glyph_string_clipping_exactly (s, prev);
2868 if (prev->first_glyph->type == CHAR_GLYPH)
2869 x_draw_glyph_string_foreground (prev);
2870 else
2871 x_draw_composite_glyph_string_foreground (prev);
2872 XSetClipMask (prev->display, prev->gc, None);
2873 prev->hl = save;
2874 prev->num_clips = 0;
2875 }
2876 }
2877
2878 if (s->next)
2879 {
2880 struct glyph_string *next;
2881
2882 for (next = s->next; next; next = next->next)
2883 if (next->hl != s->hl
2884 && next->x - next->left_overhang < s->x + s->width)
2885 {
2886 /* As next will be drawn while clipped to its own area,
2887 we must draw the left_overhang part using s->hl now. */
2888 enum draw_glyphs_face save = next->hl;
2889
2890 next->hl = s->hl;
2891 x_set_glyph_string_gc (next);
2892 x_set_glyph_string_clipping_exactly (s, next);
2893 if (next->first_glyph->type == CHAR_GLYPH)
2894 x_draw_glyph_string_foreground (next);
2895 else
2896 x_draw_composite_glyph_string_foreground (next);
2897 XSetClipMask (next->display, next->gc, None);
2898 next->hl = save;
2899 next->num_clips = 0;
2900 }
2901 }
2902 }
2903
2904 /* Reset clipping. */
2905 XSetClipMask (s->display, s->gc, None);
2906 s->num_clips = 0;
2907 }
2908
2909 /* Shift display to make room for inserted glyphs. */
2910
2911 void
2912 x_shift_glyphs_for_insert (struct frame *f, int x, int y, int width, int height, int shift_by)
2913 {
2914 XCopyArea (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
2915 f->output_data.x->normal_gc,
2916 x, y, width, height,
2917 x + shift_by, y);
2918 }
2919
2920 /* Delete N glyphs at the nominal cursor position. Not implemented
2921 for X frames. */
2922
2923 static void
2924 x_delete_glyphs (struct frame *f, register int n)
2925 {
2926 abort ();
2927 }
2928
2929
2930 /* Like XClearArea, but check that WIDTH and HEIGHT are reasonable.
2931 If they are <= 0, this is probably an error. */
2932
2933 void
2934 x_clear_area (Display *dpy, Window window, int x, int y, int width, int height, int exposures)
2935 {
2936 xassert (width > 0 && height > 0);
2937 XClearArea (dpy, window, x, y, width, height, exposures);
2938 }
2939
2940
2941 /* Clear an entire frame. */
2942
2943 static void
2944 x_clear_frame (struct frame *f)
2945 {
2946 /* Clearing the frame will erase any cursor, so mark them all as no
2947 longer visible. */
2948 mark_window_cursors_off (XWINDOW (FRAME_ROOT_WINDOW (f)));
2949 output_cursor.hpos = output_cursor.vpos = 0;
2950 output_cursor.x = -1;
2951
2952 /* We don't set the output cursor here because there will always
2953 follow an explicit cursor_to. */
2954 BLOCK_INPUT;
2955 XClearWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f));
2956
2957 /* We have to clear the scroll bars, too. If we have changed
2958 colors or something like that, then they should be notified. */
2959 x_scroll_bar_clear (f);
2960
2961 #if defined (USE_GTK) && defined (USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS)
2962 /* Make sure scroll bars are redrawn. As they aren't redrawn by
2963 redisplay, do it here. */
2964 if (FRAME_GTK_WIDGET (f))
2965 gtk_widget_queue_draw (FRAME_GTK_WIDGET (f));
2966 #endif
2967
2968 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
2969
2970 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
2971 }
2972
2973
2974 \f
2975 /* Invert the middle quarter of the frame for .15 sec. */
2976
2977 /* We use the select system call to do the waiting, so we have to make
2978 sure it's available. If it isn't, we just won't do visual bells. */
2979
2980 #if defined (HAVE_TIMEVAL) && defined (HAVE_SELECT)
2981
2982
2983 /* Subtract the `struct timeval' values X and Y, storing the result in
2984 *RESULT. Return 1 if the difference is negative, otherwise 0. */
2985
2986 static int
2987 timeval_subtract (struct timeval *result, struct timeval x, struct timeval y)
2988 {
2989 /* Perform the carry for the later subtraction by updating y. This
2990 is safer because on some systems the tv_sec member is unsigned. */
2991 if (x.tv_usec < y.tv_usec)
2992 {
2993 int nsec = (y.tv_usec - x.tv_usec) / 1000000 + 1;
2994 y.tv_usec -= 1000000 * nsec;
2995 y.tv_sec += nsec;
2996 }
2997
2998 if (x.tv_usec - y.tv_usec > 1000000)
2999 {
3000 int nsec = (y.tv_usec - x.tv_usec) / 1000000;
3001 y.tv_usec += 1000000 * nsec;
3002 y.tv_sec -= nsec;
3003 }
3004
3005 /* Compute the time remaining to wait. tv_usec is certainly
3006 positive. */
3007 result->tv_sec = x.tv_sec - y.tv_sec;
3008 result->tv_usec = x.tv_usec - y.tv_usec;
3009
3010 /* Return indication of whether the result should be considered
3011 negative. */
3012 return x.tv_sec < y.tv_sec;
3013 }
3014
3015 void
3016 XTflash (struct frame *f)
3017 {
3018 BLOCK_INPUT;
3019
3020 {
3021 #ifdef USE_GTK
3022 /* Use Gdk routines to draw. This way, we won't draw over scroll bars
3023 when the scroll bars and the edit widget share the same X window. */
3024 GdkWindow *window = gtk_widget_get_window (FRAME_GTK_WIDGET (f));
3025 GdkGCValues vals;
3026 GdkGC *gc;
3027 vals.foreground.pixel = (FRAME_FOREGROUND_PIXEL (f)
3028 ^ FRAME_BACKGROUND_PIXEL (f));
3029 vals.function = GDK_XOR;
3030 gc = gdk_gc_new_with_values (window,
3031 &vals, GDK_GC_FUNCTION | GDK_GC_FOREGROUND);
3032 #define XFillRectangle(d, win, gc, x, y, w, h) \
3033 gdk_draw_rectangle (window, gc, TRUE, x, y, w, h)
3034 #else
3035 GC gc;
3036
3037 /* Create a GC that will use the GXxor function to flip foreground
3038 pixels into background pixels. */
3039 {
3040 XGCValues values;
3041
3042 values.function = GXxor;
3043 values.foreground = (FRAME_FOREGROUND_PIXEL (f)
3044 ^ FRAME_BACKGROUND_PIXEL (f));
3045
3046 gc = XCreateGC (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
3047 GCFunction | GCForeground, &values);
3048 }
3049 #endif
3050 {
3051 /* Get the height not including a menu bar widget. */
3052 int height = FRAME_TEXT_LINES_TO_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f, FRAME_LINES (f));
3053 /* Height of each line to flash. */
3054 int flash_height = FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (f);
3055 /* These will be the left and right margins of the rectangles. */
3056 int flash_left = FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f);
3057 int flash_right = FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f) - FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f);
3058
3059 int width;
3060
3061 /* Don't flash the area between a scroll bar and the frame
3062 edge it is next to. */
3063 switch (FRAME_VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_TYPE (f))
3064 {
3065 case vertical_scroll_bar_left:
3066 flash_left += VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM;
3067 break;
3068
3069 case vertical_scroll_bar_right:
3070 flash_right -= VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM;
3071 break;
3072
3073 default:
3074 break;
3075 }
3076
3077 width = flash_right - flash_left;
3078
3079 /* If window is tall, flash top and bottom line. */
3080 if (height > 3 * FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (f))
3081 {
3082 XFillRectangle (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), gc,
3083 flash_left,
3084 (FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f)
3085 + FRAME_TOP_MARGIN_HEIGHT (f)),
3086 width, flash_height);
3087 XFillRectangle (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), gc,
3088 flash_left,
3089 (height - flash_height
3090 - FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f)),
3091 width, flash_height);
3092
3093 }
3094 else
3095 /* If it is short, flash it all. */
3096 XFillRectangle (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), gc,
3097 flash_left, FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f),
3098 width, height - 2 * FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f));
3099
3100 x_flush (f);
3101
3102 {
3103 struct timeval wakeup;
3104
3105 EMACS_GET_TIME (wakeup);
3106
3107 /* Compute time to wait until, propagating carry from usecs. */
3108 wakeup.tv_usec += 150000;
3109 wakeup.tv_sec += (wakeup.tv_usec / 1000000);
3110 wakeup.tv_usec %= 1000000;
3111
3112 /* Keep waiting until past the time wakeup or any input gets
3113 available. */
3114 while (! detect_input_pending ())
3115 {
3116 struct timeval current;
3117 struct timeval timeout;
3118
3119 EMACS_GET_TIME (current);
3120
3121 /* Break if result would be negative. */
3122 if (timeval_subtract (&current, wakeup, current))
3123 break;
3124
3125 /* How long `select' should wait. */
3126 timeout.tv_sec = 0;
3127 timeout.tv_usec = 10000;
3128
3129 /* Try to wait that long--but we might wake up sooner. */
3130 select (0, NULL, NULL, NULL, &timeout);
3131 }
3132 }
3133
3134 /* If window is tall, flash top and bottom line. */
3135 if (height > 3 * FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (f))
3136 {
3137 XFillRectangle (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), gc,
3138 flash_left,
3139 (FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f)
3140 + FRAME_TOP_MARGIN_HEIGHT (f)),
3141 width, flash_height);
3142 XFillRectangle (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), gc,
3143 flash_left,
3144 (height - flash_height
3145 - FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f)),
3146 width, flash_height);
3147 }
3148 else
3149 /* If it is short, flash it all. */
3150 XFillRectangle (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), gc,
3151 flash_left, FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f),
3152 width, height - 2 * FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f));
3153
3154 #ifdef USE_GTK
3155 g_object_unref (G_OBJECT (gc));
3156 #undef XFillRectangle
3157 #else
3158 XFreeGC (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), gc);
3159 #endif
3160 x_flush (f);
3161 }
3162 }
3163
3164 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
3165 }
3166
3167 #endif /* defined (HAVE_TIMEVAL) && defined (HAVE_SELECT) */
3168
3169
3170 static void
3171 XTtoggle_invisible_pointer (FRAME_PTR f, int invisible)
3172 {
3173 BLOCK_INPUT;
3174 if (invisible)
3175 {
3176 if (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->invisible_cursor != 0)
3177 XDefineCursor (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
3178 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->invisible_cursor);
3179 }
3180 else
3181 XDefineCursor (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
3182 f->output_data.x->current_cursor);
3183 f->pointer_invisible = invisible;
3184 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
3185 }
3186
3187
3188 /* Make audible bell. */
3189
3190 void
3191 XTring_bell (struct frame *f)
3192 {
3193 if (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f))
3194 {
3195 #if defined (HAVE_TIMEVAL) && defined (HAVE_SELECT)
3196 if (visible_bell)
3197 XTflash (f);
3198 else
3199 #endif
3200 {
3201 BLOCK_INPUT;
3202 XBell (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), 0);
3203 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
3204 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
3205 }
3206 }
3207 }
3208
3209 \f
3210 /* Specify how many text lines, from the top of the window,
3211 should be affected by insert-lines and delete-lines operations.
3212 This, and those operations, are used only within an update
3213 that is bounded by calls to x_update_begin and x_update_end. */
3214
3215 static void
3216 XTset_terminal_window (struct frame *f, int n)
3217 {
3218 /* This function intentionally left blank. */
3219 }
3220
3221
3222 \f
3223 /***********************************************************************
3224 Line Dance
3225 ***********************************************************************/
3226
3227 /* Perform an insert-lines or delete-lines operation, inserting N
3228 lines or deleting -N lines at vertical position VPOS. */
3229
3230 static void
3231 x_ins_del_lines (struct frame *f, int vpos, int n)
3232 {
3233 abort ();
3234 }
3235
3236
3237 /* Scroll part of the display as described by RUN. */
3238
3239 static void
3240 x_scroll_run (struct window *w, struct run *run)
3241 {
3242 struct frame *f = XFRAME (w->frame);
3243 int x, y, width, height, from_y, to_y, bottom_y;
3244
3245 /* Get frame-relative bounding box of the text display area of W,
3246 without mode lines. Include in this box the left and right
3247 fringe of W. */
3248 window_box (w, -1, &x, &y, &width, &height);
3249
3250 from_y = WINDOW_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_Y (w, run->current_y);
3251 to_y = WINDOW_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_Y (w, run->desired_y);
3252 bottom_y = y + height;
3253
3254 if (to_y < from_y)
3255 {
3256 /* Scrolling up. Make sure we don't copy part of the mode
3257 line at the bottom. */
3258 if (from_y + run->height > bottom_y)
3259 height = bottom_y - from_y;
3260 else
3261 height = run->height;
3262 }
3263 else
3264 {
3265 /* Scolling down. Make sure we don't copy over the mode line.
3266 at the bottom. */
3267 if (to_y + run->height > bottom_y)
3268 height = bottom_y - to_y;
3269 else
3270 height = run->height;
3271 }
3272
3273 BLOCK_INPUT;
3274
3275 /* Cursor off. Will be switched on again in x_update_window_end. */
3276 updated_window = w;
3277 x_clear_cursor (w);
3278
3279 XCopyArea (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f),
3280 FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
3281 f->output_data.x->normal_gc,
3282 x, from_y,
3283 width, height,
3284 x, to_y);
3285
3286 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
3287 }
3288
3289
3290 \f
3291 /***********************************************************************
3292 Exposure Events
3293 ***********************************************************************/
3294
3295 \f
3296 static void
3297 frame_highlight (struct frame *f)
3298 {
3299 /* We used to only do this if Vx_no_window_manager was non-nil, but
3300 the ICCCM (section 4.1.6) says that the window's border pixmap
3301 and border pixel are window attributes which are "private to the
3302 client", so we can always change it to whatever we want. */
3303 BLOCK_INPUT;
3304 XSetWindowBorder (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
3305 f->output_data.x->border_pixel);
3306 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
3307 x_update_cursor (f, 1);
3308 x_set_frame_alpha (f);
3309 }
3310
3311 static void
3312 frame_unhighlight (struct frame *f)
3313 {
3314 /* We used to only do this if Vx_no_window_manager was non-nil, but
3315 the ICCCM (section 4.1.6) says that the window's border pixmap
3316 and border pixel are window attributes which are "private to the
3317 client", so we can always change it to whatever we want. */
3318 BLOCK_INPUT;
3319 XSetWindowBorderPixmap (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
3320 f->output_data.x->border_tile);
3321 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
3322 x_update_cursor (f, 1);
3323 x_set_frame_alpha (f);
3324 }
3325
3326 /* The focus has changed. Update the frames as necessary to reflect
3327 the new situation. Note that we can't change the selected frame
3328 here, because the Lisp code we are interrupting might become confused.
3329 Each event gets marked with the frame in which it occurred, so the
3330 Lisp code can tell when the switch took place by examining the events. */
3331
3332 static void
3333 x_new_focus_frame (struct x_display_info *dpyinfo, struct frame *frame)
3334 {
3335 struct frame *old_focus = dpyinfo->x_focus_frame;
3336
3337 if (frame != dpyinfo->x_focus_frame)
3338 {
3339 /* Set this before calling other routines, so that they see
3340 the correct value of x_focus_frame. */
3341 dpyinfo->x_focus_frame = frame;
3342
3343 if (old_focus && old_focus->auto_lower)
3344 x_lower_frame (old_focus);
3345
3346 if (dpyinfo->x_focus_frame && dpyinfo->x_focus_frame->auto_raise)
3347 pending_autoraise_frame = dpyinfo->x_focus_frame;
3348 else
3349 pending_autoraise_frame = 0;
3350 }
3351
3352 x_frame_rehighlight (dpyinfo);
3353 }
3354
3355 /* Handle FocusIn and FocusOut state changes for FRAME.
3356 If FRAME has focus and there exists more than one frame, puts
3357 a FOCUS_IN_EVENT into *BUFP. */
3358
3359 static void
3360 x_focus_changed (int type, int state, struct x_display_info *dpyinfo, struct frame *frame, struct input_event *bufp)
3361 {
3362 if (type == FocusIn)
3363 {
3364 if (dpyinfo->x_focus_event_frame != frame)
3365 {
3366 x_new_focus_frame (dpyinfo, frame);
3367 dpyinfo->x_focus_event_frame = frame;
3368
3369 /* Don't stop displaying the initial startup message
3370 for a switch-frame event we don't need. */
3371 if (NILP (Vterminal_frame)
3372 && CONSP (Vframe_list)
3373 && !NILP (XCDR (Vframe_list)))
3374 {
3375 bufp->kind = FOCUS_IN_EVENT;
3376 XSETFRAME (bufp->frame_or_window, frame);
3377 }
3378 }
3379
3380 frame->output_data.x->focus_state |= state;
3381
3382 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
3383 if (FRAME_XIC (frame))
3384 XSetICFocus (FRAME_XIC (frame));
3385 #endif
3386 }
3387 else if (type == FocusOut)
3388 {
3389 frame->output_data.x->focus_state &= ~state;
3390
3391 if (dpyinfo->x_focus_event_frame == frame)
3392 {
3393 dpyinfo->x_focus_event_frame = 0;
3394 x_new_focus_frame (dpyinfo, 0);
3395 }
3396
3397 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
3398 if (FRAME_XIC (frame))
3399 XUnsetICFocus (FRAME_XIC (frame));
3400 #endif
3401 if (frame->pointer_invisible)
3402 XTtoggle_invisible_pointer (frame, 0);
3403 }
3404 }
3405
3406 /* The focus may have changed. Figure out if it is a real focus change,
3407 by checking both FocusIn/Out and Enter/LeaveNotify events.
3408
3409 Returns FOCUS_IN_EVENT event in *BUFP. */
3410
3411 static void
3412 x_detect_focus_change (struct x_display_info *dpyinfo, XEvent *event, struct input_event *bufp)
3413 {
3414 struct frame *frame;
3415
3416 frame = x_any_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event->xany.window);
3417 if (! frame)
3418 return;
3419
3420 switch (event->type)
3421 {
3422 case EnterNotify:
3423 case LeaveNotify:
3424 {
3425 struct frame *focus_frame = dpyinfo->x_focus_event_frame;
3426 int focus_state
3427 = focus_frame ? focus_frame->output_data.x->focus_state : 0;
3428
3429 if (event->xcrossing.detail != NotifyInferior
3430 && event->xcrossing.focus
3431 && ! (focus_state & FOCUS_EXPLICIT))
3432 x_focus_changed ((event->type == EnterNotify ? FocusIn : FocusOut),
3433 FOCUS_IMPLICIT,
3434 dpyinfo, frame, bufp);
3435 }
3436 break;
3437
3438 case FocusIn:
3439 case FocusOut:
3440 x_focus_changed (event->type,
3441 (event->xfocus.detail == NotifyPointer ?
3442 FOCUS_IMPLICIT : FOCUS_EXPLICIT),
3443 dpyinfo, frame, bufp);
3444 break;
3445
3446 case ClientMessage:
3447 if (event->xclient.message_type == dpyinfo->Xatom_XEMBED)
3448 {
3449 enum xembed_message msg = event->xclient.data.l[1];
3450 x_focus_changed ((msg == XEMBED_FOCUS_IN ? FocusIn : FocusOut),
3451 FOCUS_EXPLICIT, dpyinfo, frame, bufp);
3452 }
3453 break;
3454 }
3455 }
3456
3457
3458 /* Handle an event saying the mouse has moved out of an Emacs frame. */
3459
3460 void
3461 x_mouse_leave (struct x_display_info *dpyinfo)
3462 {
3463 x_new_focus_frame (dpyinfo, dpyinfo->x_focus_event_frame);
3464 }
3465
3466 /* The focus has changed, or we have redirected a frame's focus to
3467 another frame (this happens when a frame uses a surrogate
3468 mini-buffer frame). Shift the highlight as appropriate.
3469
3470 The FRAME argument doesn't necessarily have anything to do with which
3471 frame is being highlighted or un-highlighted; we only use it to find
3472 the appropriate X display info. */
3473
3474 static void
3475 XTframe_rehighlight (struct frame *frame)
3476 {
3477 x_frame_rehighlight (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (frame));
3478 }
3479
3480 static void
3481 x_frame_rehighlight (struct x_display_info *dpyinfo)
3482 {
3483 struct frame *old_highlight = dpyinfo->x_highlight_frame;
3484
3485 if (dpyinfo->x_focus_frame)
3486 {
3487 dpyinfo->x_highlight_frame
3488 = ((FRAMEP (FRAME_FOCUS_FRAME (dpyinfo->x_focus_frame)))
3489 ? XFRAME (FRAME_FOCUS_FRAME (dpyinfo->x_focus_frame))
3490 : dpyinfo->x_focus_frame);
3491 if (! FRAME_LIVE_P (dpyinfo->x_highlight_frame))
3492 {
3493 FRAME_FOCUS_FRAME (dpyinfo->x_focus_frame) = Qnil;
3494 dpyinfo->x_highlight_frame = dpyinfo->x_focus_frame;
3495 }
3496 }
3497 else
3498 dpyinfo->x_highlight_frame = 0;
3499
3500 if (dpyinfo->x_highlight_frame != old_highlight)
3501 {
3502 if (old_highlight)
3503 frame_unhighlight (old_highlight);
3504 if (dpyinfo->x_highlight_frame)
3505 frame_highlight (dpyinfo->x_highlight_frame);
3506 }
3507 }
3508
3509
3510 \f
3511 /* Keyboard processing - modifier keys, vendor-specific keysyms, etc. */
3512
3513 /* Initialize mode_switch_bit and modifier_meaning. */
3514 static void
3515 x_find_modifier_meanings (struct x_display_info *dpyinfo)
3516 {
3517 int min_code, max_code;
3518 KeySym *syms;
3519 int syms_per_code;
3520 XModifierKeymap *mods;
3521
3522 dpyinfo->meta_mod_mask = 0;
3523 dpyinfo->shift_lock_mask = 0;
3524 dpyinfo->alt_mod_mask = 0;
3525 dpyinfo->super_mod_mask = 0;
3526 dpyinfo->hyper_mod_mask = 0;
3527
3528 XDisplayKeycodes (dpyinfo->display, &min_code, &max_code);
3529
3530 syms = XGetKeyboardMapping (dpyinfo->display,
3531 min_code, max_code - min_code + 1,
3532 &syms_per_code);
3533 mods = XGetModifierMapping (dpyinfo->display);
3534
3535 /* Scan the modifier table to see which modifier bits the Meta and
3536 Alt keysyms are on. */
3537 {
3538 int row, col; /* The row and column in the modifier table. */
3539 int found_alt_or_meta;
3540
3541 for (row = 3; row < 8; row++)
3542 {
3543 found_alt_or_meta = 0;
3544 for (col = 0; col < mods->max_keypermod; col++)
3545 {
3546 KeyCode code = mods->modifiermap[(row * mods->max_keypermod) + col];
3547
3548 /* Zeroes are used for filler. Skip them. */
3549 if (code == 0)
3550 continue;
3551
3552 /* Are any of this keycode's keysyms a meta key? */
3553 {
3554 int code_col;
3555
3556 for (code_col = 0; code_col < syms_per_code; code_col++)
3557 {
3558 int sym = syms[((code - min_code) * syms_per_code) + code_col];
3559
3560 switch (sym)
3561 {
3562 case XK_Meta_L:
3563 case XK_Meta_R:
3564 found_alt_or_meta = 1;
3565 dpyinfo->meta_mod_mask |= (1 << row);
3566 break;
3567
3568 case XK_Alt_L:
3569 case XK_Alt_R:
3570 found_alt_or_meta = 1;
3571 dpyinfo->alt_mod_mask |= (1 << row);
3572 break;
3573
3574 case XK_Hyper_L:
3575 case XK_Hyper_R:
3576 if (!found_alt_or_meta)
3577 dpyinfo->hyper_mod_mask |= (1 << row);
3578 code_col = syms_per_code;
3579 col = mods->max_keypermod;
3580 break;
3581
3582 case XK_Super_L:
3583 case XK_Super_R:
3584 if (!found_alt_or_meta)
3585 dpyinfo->super_mod_mask |= (1 << row);
3586 code_col = syms_per_code;
3587 col = mods->max_keypermod;
3588 break;
3589
3590 case XK_Shift_Lock:
3591 /* Ignore this if it's not on the lock modifier. */
3592 if (!found_alt_or_meta && ((1 << row) == LockMask))
3593 dpyinfo->shift_lock_mask = LockMask;
3594 code_col = syms_per_code;
3595 col = mods->max_keypermod;
3596 break;
3597 }
3598 }
3599 }
3600 }
3601 }
3602 }
3603
3604 /* If we couldn't find any meta keys, accept any alt keys as meta keys. */
3605 if (! dpyinfo->meta_mod_mask)
3606 {
3607 dpyinfo->meta_mod_mask = dpyinfo->alt_mod_mask;
3608 dpyinfo->alt_mod_mask = 0;
3609 }
3610
3611 /* If some keys are both alt and meta,
3612 make them just meta, not alt. */
3613 if (dpyinfo->alt_mod_mask & dpyinfo->meta_mod_mask)
3614 {
3615 dpyinfo->alt_mod_mask &= ~dpyinfo->meta_mod_mask;
3616 }
3617
3618 XFree ((char *) syms);
3619 XFreeModifiermap (mods);
3620 }
3621
3622 /* Convert between the modifier bits X uses and the modifier bits
3623 Emacs uses. */
3624
3625 unsigned int
3626 x_x_to_emacs_modifiers (struct x_display_info *dpyinfo, unsigned int state)
3627 {
3628 EMACS_UINT mod_meta = meta_modifier;
3629 EMACS_UINT mod_alt = alt_modifier;
3630 EMACS_UINT mod_hyper = hyper_modifier;
3631 EMACS_UINT mod_super = super_modifier;
3632 Lisp_Object tem;
3633
3634 tem = Fget (Vx_alt_keysym, Qmodifier_value);
3635 if (! EQ (tem, Qnil)) mod_alt = XUINT (tem);
3636 tem = Fget (Vx_meta_keysym, Qmodifier_value);
3637 if (! EQ (tem, Qnil)) mod_meta = XUINT (tem);
3638 tem = Fget (Vx_hyper_keysym, Qmodifier_value);
3639 if (! EQ (tem, Qnil)) mod_hyper = XUINT (tem);
3640 tem = Fget (Vx_super_keysym, Qmodifier_value);
3641 if (! EQ (tem, Qnil)) mod_super = XUINT (tem);
3642
3643
3644 return ( ((state & (ShiftMask | dpyinfo->shift_lock_mask)) ? shift_modifier : 0)
3645 | ((state & ControlMask) ? ctrl_modifier : 0)
3646 | ((state & dpyinfo->meta_mod_mask) ? mod_meta : 0)
3647 | ((state & dpyinfo->alt_mod_mask) ? mod_alt : 0)
3648 | ((state & dpyinfo->super_mod_mask) ? mod_super : 0)
3649 | ((state & dpyinfo->hyper_mod_mask) ? mod_hyper : 0));
3650 }
3651
3652 static unsigned int
3653 x_emacs_to_x_modifiers (struct x_display_info *dpyinfo, unsigned int state)
3654 {
3655 EMACS_UINT mod_meta = meta_modifier;
3656 EMACS_UINT mod_alt = alt_modifier;
3657 EMACS_UINT mod_hyper = hyper_modifier;
3658 EMACS_UINT mod_super = super_modifier;
3659
3660 Lisp_Object tem;
3661
3662 tem = Fget (Vx_alt_keysym, Qmodifier_value);
3663 if (! EQ (tem, Qnil)) mod_alt = XUINT (tem);
3664 tem = Fget (Vx_meta_keysym, Qmodifier_value);
3665 if (! EQ (tem, Qnil)) mod_meta = XUINT (tem);
3666 tem = Fget (Vx_hyper_keysym, Qmodifier_value);
3667 if (! EQ (tem, Qnil)) mod_hyper = XUINT (tem);
3668 tem = Fget (Vx_super_keysym, Qmodifier_value);
3669 if (! EQ (tem, Qnil)) mod_super = XUINT (tem);
3670
3671
3672 return ( ((state & mod_alt) ? dpyinfo->alt_mod_mask : 0)
3673 | ((state & mod_super) ? dpyinfo->super_mod_mask : 0)
3674 | ((state & mod_hyper) ? dpyinfo->hyper_mod_mask : 0)
3675 | ((state & shift_modifier) ? ShiftMask : 0)
3676 | ((state & ctrl_modifier) ? ControlMask : 0)
3677 | ((state & mod_meta) ? dpyinfo->meta_mod_mask : 0));
3678 }
3679
3680 /* Convert a keysym to its name. */
3681
3682 char *
3683 x_get_keysym_name (int keysym)
3684 {
3685 char *value;
3686
3687 BLOCK_INPUT;
3688 value = XKeysymToString (keysym);
3689 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
3690
3691 return value;
3692 }
3693
3694
3695 \f
3696 /* Mouse clicks and mouse movement. Rah. */
3697
3698 /* Prepare a mouse-event in *RESULT for placement in the input queue.
3699
3700 If the event is a button press, then note that we have grabbed
3701 the mouse. */
3702
3703 static Lisp_Object
3704 construct_mouse_click (struct input_event *result, XButtonEvent *event, struct frame *f)
3705 {
3706 /* Make the event type NO_EVENT; we'll change that when we decide
3707 otherwise. */
3708 result->kind = MOUSE_CLICK_EVENT;
3709 result->code = event->button - Button1;
3710 result->timestamp = event->time;
3711 result->modifiers = (x_x_to_emacs_modifiers (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f),
3712 event->state)
3713 | (event->type == ButtonRelease
3714 ? up_modifier
3715 : down_modifier));
3716
3717 XSETINT (result->x, event->x);
3718 XSETINT (result->y, event->y);
3719 XSETFRAME (result->frame_or_window, f);
3720 result->arg = Qnil;
3721 return Qnil;
3722 }
3723
3724 \f
3725 /* Function to report a mouse movement to the mainstream Emacs code.
3726 The input handler calls this.
3727
3728 We have received a mouse movement event, which is given in *event.
3729 If the mouse is over a different glyph than it was last time, tell
3730 the mainstream emacs code by setting mouse_moved. If not, ask for
3731 another motion event, so we can check again the next time it moves. */
3732
3733 static XMotionEvent last_mouse_motion_event;
3734 static Lisp_Object last_mouse_motion_frame;
3735
3736 static int
3737 note_mouse_movement (FRAME_PTR frame, XMotionEvent *event)
3738 {
3739 last_mouse_movement_time = event->time;
3740 last_mouse_motion_event = *event;
3741 XSETFRAME (last_mouse_motion_frame, frame);
3742
3743 if (!FRAME_X_OUTPUT (frame))
3744 return 0;
3745
3746 if (event->window != FRAME_X_WINDOW (frame))
3747 {
3748 frame->mouse_moved = 1;
3749 last_mouse_scroll_bar = Qnil;
3750 note_mouse_highlight (frame, -1, -1);
3751 last_mouse_glyph_frame = 0;
3752 return 1;
3753 }
3754
3755
3756 /* Has the mouse moved off the glyph it was on at the last sighting? */
3757 if (frame != last_mouse_glyph_frame
3758 || event->x < last_mouse_glyph.x
3759 || event->x >= last_mouse_glyph.x + last_mouse_glyph.width
3760 || event->y < last_mouse_glyph.y
3761 || event->y >= last_mouse_glyph.y + last_mouse_glyph.height)
3762 {
3763 frame->mouse_moved = 1;
3764 last_mouse_scroll_bar = Qnil;
3765 note_mouse_highlight (frame, event->x, event->y);
3766 /* Remember which glyph we're now on. */
3767 remember_mouse_glyph (frame, event->x, event->y, &last_mouse_glyph);
3768 last_mouse_glyph_frame = frame;
3769 return 1;
3770 }
3771
3772 return 0;
3773 }
3774
3775 \f
3776 /************************************************************************
3777 Mouse Face
3778 ************************************************************************/
3779
3780 static void
3781 redo_mouse_highlight (void)
3782 {
3783 if (!NILP (last_mouse_motion_frame)
3784 && FRAME_LIVE_P (XFRAME (last_mouse_motion_frame)))
3785 note_mouse_highlight (XFRAME (last_mouse_motion_frame),
3786 last_mouse_motion_event.x,
3787 last_mouse_motion_event.y);
3788 }
3789
3790
3791
3792 /* Return the current position of the mouse.
3793 *FP should be a frame which indicates which display to ask about.
3794
3795 If the mouse movement started in a scroll bar, set *FP, *BAR_WINDOW,
3796 and *PART to the frame, window, and scroll bar part that the mouse
3797 is over. Set *X and *Y to the portion and whole of the mouse's
3798 position on the scroll bar.
3799
3800 If the mouse movement started elsewhere, set *FP to the frame the
3801 mouse is on, *BAR_WINDOW to nil, and *X and *Y to the character cell
3802 the mouse is over.
3803
3804 Set *TIME to the server time-stamp for the time at which the mouse
3805 was at this position.
3806
3807 Don't store anything if we don't have a valid set of values to report.
3808
3809 This clears the mouse_moved flag, so we can wait for the next mouse
3810 movement. */
3811
3812 static void
3813 XTmouse_position (FRAME_PTR *fp, int insist, Lisp_Object *bar_window, enum scroll_bar_part *part, Lisp_Object *x, Lisp_Object *y, long unsigned int *time)
3814 {
3815 FRAME_PTR f1;
3816
3817 BLOCK_INPUT;
3818
3819 if (! NILP (last_mouse_scroll_bar) && insist == 0)
3820 x_scroll_bar_report_motion (fp, bar_window, part, x, y, time);
3821 else
3822 {
3823 Window root;
3824 int root_x, root_y;
3825
3826 Window dummy_window;
3827 int dummy;
3828
3829 Lisp_Object frame, tail;
3830
3831 /* Clear the mouse-moved flag for every frame on this display. */
3832 FOR_EACH_FRAME (tail, frame)
3833 if (FRAME_X_P (XFRAME (frame))
3834 && FRAME_X_DISPLAY (XFRAME (frame)) == FRAME_X_DISPLAY (*fp))
3835 XFRAME (frame)->mouse_moved = 0;
3836
3837 last_mouse_scroll_bar = Qnil;
3838
3839 /* Figure out which root window we're on. */
3840 XQueryPointer (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (*fp),
3841 DefaultRootWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (*fp)),
3842
3843 /* The root window which contains the pointer. */
3844 &root,
3845
3846 /* Trash which we can't trust if the pointer is on
3847 a different screen. */
3848 &dummy_window,
3849
3850 /* The position on that root window. */
3851 &root_x, &root_y,
3852
3853 /* More trash we can't trust. */
3854 &dummy, &dummy,
3855
3856 /* Modifier keys and pointer buttons, about which
3857 we don't care. */
3858 (unsigned int *) &dummy);
3859
3860 /* Now we have a position on the root; find the innermost window
3861 containing the pointer. */
3862 {
3863 Window win, child;
3864 int win_x, win_y;
3865 int parent_x = 0, parent_y = 0;
3866
3867 win = root;
3868
3869 /* XTranslateCoordinates can get errors if the window
3870 structure is changing at the same time this function
3871 is running. So at least we must not crash from them. */
3872
3873 x_catch_errors (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (*fp));
3874
3875 if (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (*fp)->grabbed && last_mouse_frame
3876 && FRAME_LIVE_P (last_mouse_frame))
3877 {
3878 /* If mouse was grabbed on a frame, give coords for that frame
3879 even if the mouse is now outside it. */
3880 XTranslateCoordinates (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (*fp),
3881
3882 /* From-window, to-window. */
3883 root, FRAME_X_WINDOW (last_mouse_frame),
3884
3885 /* From-position, to-position. */
3886 root_x, root_y, &win_x, &win_y,
3887
3888 /* Child of win. */
3889 &child);
3890 f1 = last_mouse_frame;
3891 }
3892 else
3893 {
3894 while (1)
3895 {
3896 XTranslateCoordinates (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (*fp),
3897
3898 /* From-window, to-window. */
3899 root, win,
3900
3901 /* From-position, to-position. */
3902 root_x, root_y, &win_x, &win_y,
3903
3904 /* Child of win. */
3905 &child);
3906
3907 if (child == None || child == win)
3908 break;
3909 #ifdef USE_GTK
3910 /* We don't wan't to know the innermost window. We
3911 want the edit window. For non-Gtk+ the innermost
3912 window is the edit window. For Gtk+ it might not
3913 be. It might be the tool bar for example. */
3914 if (x_window_to_frame (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (*fp), win))
3915 break;
3916 #endif
3917 win = child;
3918 parent_x = win_x;
3919 parent_y = win_y;
3920 }
3921
3922 /* Now we know that:
3923 win is the innermost window containing the pointer
3924 (XTC says it has no child containing the pointer),
3925 win_x and win_y are the pointer's position in it
3926 (XTC did this the last time through), and
3927 parent_x and parent_y are the pointer's position in win's parent.
3928 (They are what win_x and win_y were when win was child.
3929 If win is the root window, it has no parent, and
3930 parent_{x,y} are invalid, but that's okay, because we'll
3931 never use them in that case.) */
3932
3933 #ifdef USE_GTK
3934 /* We don't wan't to know the innermost window. We
3935 want the edit window. */
3936 f1 = x_window_to_frame (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (*fp), win);
3937 #else
3938 /* Is win one of our frames? */
3939 f1 = x_any_window_to_frame (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (*fp), win);
3940 #endif
3941
3942 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
3943 /* If we end up with the menu bar window, say it's not
3944 on the frame. */
3945 if (f1 != NULL
3946 && f1->output_data.x->menubar_widget
3947 && win == XtWindow (f1->output_data.x->menubar_widget))
3948 f1 = NULL;
3949 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
3950 }
3951
3952 if (x_had_errors_p (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (*fp)))
3953 f1 = 0;
3954
3955 x_uncatch_errors ();
3956
3957 /* If not, is it one of our scroll bars? */
3958 if (! f1)
3959 {
3960 struct scroll_bar *bar;
3961
3962 bar = x_window_to_scroll_bar (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (*fp), win);
3963
3964 if (bar)
3965 {
3966 f1 = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (XWINDOW (bar->window)));
3967 win_x = parent_x;
3968 win_y = parent_y;
3969 }
3970 }
3971
3972 if (f1 == 0 && insist > 0)
3973 f1 = SELECTED_FRAME ();
3974
3975 if (f1)
3976 {
3977 /* Ok, we found a frame. Store all the values.
3978 last_mouse_glyph is a rectangle used to reduce the
3979 generation of mouse events. To not miss any motion
3980 events, we must divide the frame into rectangles of the
3981 size of the smallest character that could be displayed
3982 on it, i.e. into the same rectangles that matrices on
3983 the frame are divided into. */
3984
3985 remember_mouse_glyph (f1, win_x, win_y, &last_mouse_glyph);
3986 last_mouse_glyph_frame = f1;
3987
3988 *bar_window = Qnil;
3989 *part = 0;
3990 *fp = f1;
3991 XSETINT (*x, win_x);
3992 XSETINT (*y, win_y);
3993 *time = last_mouse_movement_time;
3994 }
3995 }
3996 }
3997
3998 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
3999 }
4000
4001
4002 \f
4003 /***********************************************************************
4004 Scroll bars
4005 ***********************************************************************/
4006
4007 /* Scroll bar support. */
4008
4009 /* Given an X window ID and a DISPLAY, find the struct scroll_bar which
4010 manages it.
4011 This can be called in GC, so we have to make sure to strip off mark
4012 bits. */
4013
4014 static struct scroll_bar *
4015 x_window_to_scroll_bar (Display *display, Window window_id)
4016 {
4017 Lisp_Object tail;
4018
4019 #if defined (USE_GTK) && defined (USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS)
4020 window_id = (Window) xg_get_scroll_id_for_window (display, window_id);
4021 #endif /* USE_GTK && USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
4022
4023 for (tail = Vframe_list; CONSP (tail); tail = XCDR (tail))
4024 {
4025 Lisp_Object frame, bar, condemned;
4026
4027 frame = XCAR (tail);
4028 /* All elements of Vframe_list should be frames. */
4029 if (! FRAMEP (frame))
4030 abort ();
4031
4032 if (! FRAME_X_P (XFRAME (frame)))
4033 continue;
4034
4035 /* Scan this frame's scroll bar list for a scroll bar with the
4036 right window ID. */
4037 condemned = FRAME_CONDEMNED_SCROLL_BARS (XFRAME (frame));
4038 for (bar = FRAME_SCROLL_BARS (XFRAME (frame));
4039 /* This trick allows us to search both the ordinary and
4040 condemned scroll bar lists with one loop. */
4041 ! NILP (bar) || (bar = condemned,
4042 condemned = Qnil,
4043 ! NILP (bar));
4044 bar = XSCROLL_BAR (bar)->next)
4045 if (XSCROLL_BAR (bar)->x_window == window_id &&
4046 FRAME_X_DISPLAY (XFRAME (frame)) == display)
4047 return XSCROLL_BAR (bar);
4048 }
4049
4050 return 0;
4051 }
4052
4053
4054 #if defined USE_LUCID
4055
4056 /* Return the Lucid menu bar WINDOW is part of. Return null
4057 if WINDOW is not part of a menu bar. */
4058
4059 static Widget
4060 x_window_to_menu_bar (Window window)
4061 {
4062 Lisp_Object tail;
4063
4064 for (tail = Vframe_list; CONSP (tail); tail = XCDR (tail))
4065 {
4066 if (FRAME_X_P (XFRAME (XCAR (tail))))
4067 {
4068 Lisp_Object frame = XCAR (tail);
4069 Widget menu_bar = XFRAME (frame)->output_data.x->menubar_widget;
4070
4071 if (menu_bar && xlwmenu_window_p (menu_bar, window))
4072 return menu_bar;
4073 }
4074 }
4075
4076 return NULL;
4077 }
4078
4079 #endif /* USE_LUCID */
4080
4081 \f
4082 /************************************************************************
4083 Toolkit scroll bars
4084 ************************************************************************/
4085
4086 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
4087
4088 static void x_scroll_bar_to_input_event (XEvent *, struct input_event *);
4089 static void x_send_scroll_bar_event (Lisp_Object, int, int, int);
4090 static void x_create_toolkit_scroll_bar (struct frame *,
4091 struct scroll_bar *);
4092 static void x_set_toolkit_scroll_bar_thumb (struct scroll_bar *,
4093 int, int, int);
4094
4095
4096 /* Lisp window being scrolled. Set when starting to interact with
4097 a toolkit scroll bar, reset to nil when ending the interaction. */
4098
4099 static Lisp_Object window_being_scrolled;
4100
4101 /* Last scroll bar part sent in xm_scroll_callback. */
4102
4103 static int last_scroll_bar_part;
4104
4105 /* Whether this is an Xaw with arrow-scrollbars. This should imply
4106 that movements of 1/20 of the screen size are mapped to up/down. */
4107
4108 #ifndef USE_GTK
4109 /* Id of action hook installed for scroll bars. */
4110
4111 static XtActionHookId action_hook_id;
4112
4113 static Boolean xaw3d_arrow_scroll;
4114
4115 /* Whether the drag scrolling maintains the mouse at the top of the
4116 thumb. If not, resizing the thumb needs to be done more carefully
4117 to avoid jerkyness. */
4118
4119 static Boolean xaw3d_pick_top;
4120
4121 /* Action hook installed via XtAppAddActionHook when toolkit scroll
4122 bars are used.. The hook is responsible for detecting when
4123 the user ends an interaction with the scroll bar, and generates
4124 a `end-scroll' SCROLL_BAR_CLICK_EVENT' event if so. */
4125
4126 static void
4127 xt_action_hook (Widget widget, XtPointer client_data, String action_name,
4128 XEvent *event, String *params, Cardinal *num_params)
4129 {
4130 int scroll_bar_p;
4131 const char *end_action;
4132
4133 #ifdef USE_MOTIF
4134 scroll_bar_p = XmIsScrollBar (widget);
4135 end_action = "Release";
4136 #else /* !USE_MOTIF i.e. use Xaw */
4137 scroll_bar_p = XtIsSubclass (widget, scrollbarWidgetClass);
4138 end_action = "EndScroll";
4139 #endif /* USE_MOTIF */
4140
4141 if (scroll_bar_p
4142 && strcmp (action_name, end_action) == 0
4143 && WINDOWP (window_being_scrolled))
4144 {
4145 struct window *w;
4146
4147 x_send_scroll_bar_event (window_being_scrolled,
4148 scroll_bar_end_scroll, 0, 0);
4149 w = XWINDOW (window_being_scrolled);
4150
4151 if (!NILP (XSCROLL_BAR (w->vertical_scroll_bar)->dragging))
4152 {
4153 XSCROLL_BAR (w->vertical_scroll_bar)->dragging = Qnil;
4154 /* The thumb size is incorrect while dragging: fix it. */
4155 set_vertical_scroll_bar (w);
4156 }
4157 window_being_scrolled = Qnil;
4158 last_scroll_bar_part = -1;
4159
4160 /* Xt timeouts no longer needed. */
4161 toolkit_scroll_bar_interaction = 0;
4162 }
4163 }
4164 #endif /* not USE_GTK */
4165
4166 /* A vector of windows used for communication between
4167 x_send_scroll_bar_event and x_scroll_bar_to_input_event. */
4168
4169 static struct window **scroll_bar_windows;
4170 static int scroll_bar_windows_size;
4171
4172
4173 /* Send a client message with message type Xatom_Scrollbar for a
4174 scroll action to the frame of WINDOW. PART is a value identifying
4175 the part of the scroll bar that was clicked on. PORTION is the
4176 amount to scroll of a whole of WHOLE. */
4177
4178 static void
4179 x_send_scroll_bar_event (Lisp_Object window, int part, int portion, int whole)
4180 {
4181 XEvent event;
4182 XClientMessageEvent *ev = (XClientMessageEvent *) &event;
4183 struct window *w = XWINDOW (window);
4184 struct frame *f = XFRAME (w->frame);
4185 int i;
4186
4187 BLOCK_INPUT;
4188
4189 /* Construct a ClientMessage event to send to the frame. */
4190 ev->type = ClientMessage;
4191 ev->message_type = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->Xatom_Scrollbar;
4192 ev->display = FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f);
4193 ev->window = FRAME_X_WINDOW (f);
4194 ev->format = 32;
4195
4196 /* We can only transfer 32 bits in the XClientMessageEvent, which is
4197 not enough to store a pointer or Lisp_Object on a 64 bit system.
4198 So, store the window in scroll_bar_windows and pass the index
4199 into that array in the event. */
4200 for (i = 0; i < scroll_bar_windows_size; ++i)
4201 if (scroll_bar_windows[i] == NULL)
4202 break;
4203
4204 if (i == scroll_bar_windows_size)
4205 {
4206 int new_size = max (10, 2 * scroll_bar_windows_size);
4207 size_t nbytes = new_size * sizeof *scroll_bar_windows;
4208 size_t old_nbytes = scroll_bar_windows_size * sizeof *scroll_bar_windows;
4209
4210 scroll_bar_windows = (struct window **) xrealloc (scroll_bar_windows,
4211 nbytes);
4212 memset (&scroll_bar_windows[i], 0, nbytes - old_nbytes);
4213 scroll_bar_windows_size = new_size;
4214 }
4215
4216 scroll_bar_windows[i] = w;
4217 ev->data.l[0] = (long) i;
4218 ev->data.l[1] = (long) part;
4219 ev->data.l[2] = (long) 0;
4220 ev->data.l[3] = (long) portion;
4221 ev->data.l[4] = (long) whole;
4222
4223 /* Make Xt timeouts work while the scroll bar is active. */
4224 toolkit_scroll_bar_interaction = 1;
4225 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
4226 x_activate_timeout_atimer ();
4227 #endif
4228
4229 /* Setting the event mask to zero means that the message will
4230 be sent to the client that created the window, and if that
4231 window no longer exists, no event will be sent. */
4232 XSendEvent (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), False, 0, &event);
4233 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
4234 }
4235
4236
4237 /* Transform a scroll bar ClientMessage EVENT to an Emacs input event
4238 in *IEVENT. */
4239
4240 static void
4241 x_scroll_bar_to_input_event (XEvent *event, struct input_event *ievent)
4242 {
4243 XClientMessageEvent *ev = (XClientMessageEvent *) event;
4244 Lisp_Object window;
4245 struct frame *f;
4246 struct window *w;
4247
4248 w = scroll_bar_windows[ev->data.l[0]];
4249 scroll_bar_windows[ev->data.l[0]] = NULL;
4250
4251 XSETWINDOW (window, w);
4252 f = XFRAME (w->frame);
4253
4254 ievent->kind = SCROLL_BAR_CLICK_EVENT;
4255 ievent->frame_or_window = window;
4256 ievent->arg = Qnil;
4257 #ifdef USE_GTK
4258 ievent->timestamp = CurrentTime;
4259 #else
4260 ievent->timestamp = XtLastTimestampProcessed (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
4261 #endif
4262 ievent->part = ev->data.l[1];
4263 ievent->code = ev->data.l[2];
4264 ievent->x = make_number ((int) ev->data.l[3]);
4265 ievent->y = make_number ((int) ev->data.l[4]);
4266 ievent->modifiers = 0;
4267 }
4268
4269
4270 #ifdef USE_MOTIF
4271
4272 /* Minimum and maximum values used for Motif scroll bars. */
4273
4274 #define XM_SB_MAX 10000000
4275
4276
4277 /* Scroll bar callback for Motif scroll bars. WIDGET is the scroll
4278 bar widget. CLIENT_DATA is a pointer to the scroll_bar structure.
4279 CALL_DATA is a pointer to a XmScrollBarCallbackStruct. */
4280
4281 static void
4282 xm_scroll_callback (Widget widget, XtPointer client_data, XtPointer call_data)
4283 {
4284 struct scroll_bar *bar = (struct scroll_bar *) client_data;
4285 XmScrollBarCallbackStruct *cs = (XmScrollBarCallbackStruct *) call_data;
4286 int part = -1, whole = 0, portion = 0;
4287
4288 switch (cs->reason)
4289 {
4290 case XmCR_DECREMENT:
4291 bar->dragging = Qnil;
4292 part = scroll_bar_up_arrow;
4293 break;
4294
4295 case XmCR_INCREMENT:
4296 bar->dragging = Qnil;
4297 part = scroll_bar_down_arrow;
4298 break;
4299
4300 case XmCR_PAGE_DECREMENT:
4301 bar->dragging = Qnil;
4302 part = scroll_bar_above_handle;
4303 break;
4304
4305 case XmCR_PAGE_INCREMENT:
4306 bar->dragging = Qnil;
4307 part = scroll_bar_below_handle;
4308 break;
4309
4310 case XmCR_TO_TOP:
4311 bar->dragging = Qnil;
4312 part = scroll_bar_to_top;
4313 break;
4314
4315 case XmCR_TO_BOTTOM:
4316 bar->dragging = Qnil;
4317 part = scroll_bar_to_bottom;
4318 break;
4319
4320 case XmCR_DRAG:
4321 {
4322 int slider_size;
4323
4324 /* Get the slider size. */
4325 BLOCK_INPUT;
4326 XtVaGetValues (widget, XmNsliderSize, &slider_size, NULL);
4327 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
4328
4329 whole = XM_SB_MAX - slider_size;
4330 portion = min (cs->value, whole);
4331 part = scroll_bar_handle;
4332 bar->dragging = make_number (cs->value);
4333 }
4334 break;
4335
4336 case XmCR_VALUE_CHANGED:
4337 break;
4338 };
4339
4340 if (part >= 0)
4341 {
4342 window_being_scrolled = bar->window;
4343 last_scroll_bar_part = part;
4344 x_send_scroll_bar_event (bar->window, part, portion, whole);
4345 }
4346 }
4347
4348 #elif defined USE_GTK
4349
4350 /* Scroll bar callback for GTK scroll bars. WIDGET is the scroll
4351 bar widget. DATA is a pointer to the scroll_bar structure. */
4352
4353 static gboolean
4354 xg_scroll_callback (GtkRange *range,
4355 GtkScrollType scroll,
4356 gdouble value,
4357 gpointer user_data)
4358 {
4359 struct scroll_bar *bar = (struct scroll_bar *) user_data;
4360 gdouble position;
4361 int part = -1, whole = 0, portion = 0;
4362 GtkAdjustment *adj = GTK_ADJUSTMENT (gtk_range_get_adjustment (range));
4363 FRAME_PTR f = (FRAME_PTR) g_object_get_data (G_OBJECT (range), XG_FRAME_DATA);
4364
4365 if (xg_ignore_gtk_scrollbar) return FALSE;
4366 position = gtk_adjustment_get_value (adj);
4367
4368
4369 switch (scroll)
4370 {
4371 case GTK_SCROLL_JUMP:
4372 /* Buttons 1 2 or 3 must be grabbed. */
4373 if (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->grabbed != 0
4374 && FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->grabbed < (1 << 4))
4375 {
4376 part = scroll_bar_handle;
4377 whole = gtk_adjustment_get_upper (adj) -
4378 gtk_adjustment_get_page_size (adj);
4379 portion = min ((int)position, whole);
4380 bar->dragging = make_number ((int)portion);
4381 }
4382 break;
4383 case GTK_SCROLL_STEP_BACKWARD:
4384 part = scroll_bar_up_arrow;
4385 bar->dragging = Qnil;
4386 break;
4387 case GTK_SCROLL_STEP_FORWARD:
4388 part = scroll_bar_down_arrow;
4389 bar->dragging = Qnil;
4390 break;
4391 case GTK_SCROLL_PAGE_BACKWARD:
4392 part = scroll_bar_above_handle;
4393 bar->dragging = Qnil;
4394 break;
4395 case GTK_SCROLL_PAGE_FORWARD:
4396 part = scroll_bar_below_handle;
4397 bar->dragging = Qnil;
4398 break;
4399 }
4400
4401 if (part >= 0)
4402 {
4403 window_being_scrolled = bar->window;
4404 last_scroll_bar_part = part;
4405 x_send_scroll_bar_event (bar->window, part, portion, whole);
4406 }
4407
4408 return FALSE;
4409 }
4410
4411 /* Callback for button release. Sets dragging to Qnil when dragging is done. */
4412
4413 static gboolean
4414 xg_end_scroll_callback (GtkWidget *widget,
4415 GdkEventButton *event,
4416 gpointer user_data)
4417 {
4418 struct scroll_bar *bar = (struct scroll_bar *) user_data;
4419 bar->dragging = Qnil;
4420 if (WINDOWP (window_being_scrolled))
4421 {
4422 x_send_scroll_bar_event (window_being_scrolled,
4423 scroll_bar_end_scroll, 0, 0);
4424 window_being_scrolled = Qnil;
4425 }
4426
4427 return FALSE;
4428 }
4429
4430
4431 #else /* not USE_GTK and not USE_MOTIF */
4432
4433 /* Xaw scroll bar callback. Invoked when the thumb is dragged.
4434 WIDGET is the scroll bar widget. CLIENT_DATA is a pointer to the
4435 scroll bar struct. CALL_DATA is a pointer to a float saying where
4436 the thumb is. */
4437
4438 static void
4439 xaw_jump_callback (Widget widget, XtPointer client_data, XtPointer call_data)
4440 {
4441 struct scroll_bar *bar = (struct scroll_bar *) client_data;
4442 float top = *(float *) call_data;
4443 float shown;
4444 int whole, portion, height;
4445 int part;
4446
4447 /* Get the size of the thumb, a value between 0 and 1. */
4448 BLOCK_INPUT;
4449 XtVaGetValues (widget, XtNshown, &shown, XtNheight, &height, NULL);
4450 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
4451
4452 whole = 10000000;
4453 portion = shown < 1 ? top * whole : 0;
4454
4455 if (shown < 1 && (eabs (top + shown - 1) < 1.0/height))
4456 /* Some derivatives of Xaw refuse to shrink the thumb when you reach
4457 the bottom, so we force the scrolling whenever we see that we're
4458 too close to the bottom (in x_set_toolkit_scroll_bar_thumb
4459 we try to ensure that we always stay two pixels away from the
4460 bottom). */
4461 part = scroll_bar_down_arrow;
4462 else
4463 part = scroll_bar_handle;
4464
4465 window_being_scrolled = bar->window;
4466 bar->dragging = make_number (portion);
4467 last_scroll_bar_part = part;
4468 x_send_scroll_bar_event (bar->window, part, portion, whole);
4469 }
4470
4471
4472 /* Xaw scroll bar callback. Invoked for incremental scrolling.,
4473 i.e. line or page up or down. WIDGET is the Xaw scroll bar
4474 widget. CLIENT_DATA is a pointer to the scroll_bar structure for
4475 the scroll bar. CALL_DATA is an integer specifying the action that
4476 has taken place. Its magnitude is in the range 0..height of the
4477 scroll bar. Negative values mean scroll towards buffer start.
4478 Values < height of scroll bar mean line-wise movement. */
4479
4480 static void
4481 xaw_scroll_callback (Widget widget, XtPointer client_data, XtPointer call_data)
4482 {
4483 struct scroll_bar *bar = (struct scroll_bar *) client_data;
4484 /* The position really is stored cast to a pointer. */
4485 int position = (long) call_data;
4486 Dimension height;
4487 int part;
4488
4489 /* Get the height of the scroll bar. */
4490 BLOCK_INPUT;
4491 XtVaGetValues (widget, XtNheight, &height, NULL);
4492 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
4493
4494 if (eabs (position) >= height)
4495 part = (position < 0) ? scroll_bar_above_handle : scroll_bar_below_handle;
4496
4497 /* If Xaw3d was compiled with ARROW_SCROLLBAR,
4498 it maps line-movement to call_data = max(5, height/20). */
4499 else if (xaw3d_arrow_scroll && eabs (position) <= max (5, height / 20))
4500 part = (position < 0) ? scroll_bar_up_arrow : scroll_bar_down_arrow;
4501 else
4502 part = scroll_bar_move_ratio;
4503
4504 window_being_scrolled = bar->window;
4505 bar->dragging = Qnil;
4506 last_scroll_bar_part = part;
4507 x_send_scroll_bar_event (bar->window, part, position, height);
4508 }
4509
4510 #endif /* not USE_GTK and not USE_MOTIF */
4511
4512 #define SCROLL_BAR_NAME "verticalScrollBar"
4513
4514 /* Create the widget for scroll bar BAR on frame F. Record the widget
4515 and X window of the scroll bar in BAR. */
4516
4517 #ifdef USE_GTK
4518 static void
4519 x_create_toolkit_scroll_bar (struct frame *f, struct scroll_bar *bar)
4520 {
4521 const char *scroll_bar_name = SCROLL_BAR_NAME;
4522
4523 BLOCK_INPUT;
4524 xg_create_scroll_bar (f, bar, G_CALLBACK (xg_scroll_callback),
4525 G_CALLBACK (xg_end_scroll_callback),
4526 scroll_bar_name);
4527 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
4528 }
4529
4530 #else /* not USE_GTK */
4531
4532 static void
4533 x_create_toolkit_scroll_bar (struct frame *f, struct scroll_bar *bar)
4534 {
4535 Window xwindow;
4536 Widget widget;
4537 Arg av[20];
4538 int ac = 0;
4539 char *scroll_bar_name = SCROLL_BAR_NAME;
4540 unsigned long pixel;
4541
4542 BLOCK_INPUT;
4543
4544 #ifdef USE_MOTIF
4545 /* Set resources. Create the widget. */
4546 XtSetArg (av[ac], XtNmappedWhenManaged, False); ++ac;
4547 XtSetArg (av[ac], XmNminimum, 0); ++ac;
4548 XtSetArg (av[ac], XmNmaximum, XM_SB_MAX); ++ac;
4549 XtSetArg (av[ac], XmNorientation, XmVERTICAL); ++ac;
4550 XtSetArg (av[ac], XmNprocessingDirection, XmMAX_ON_BOTTOM), ++ac;
4551 XtSetArg (av[ac], XmNincrement, 1); ++ac;
4552 XtSetArg (av[ac], XmNpageIncrement, 1); ++ac;
4553
4554 pixel = f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_foreground_pixel;
4555 if (pixel != -1)
4556 {
4557 XtSetArg (av[ac], XmNforeground, pixel);
4558 ++ac;
4559 }
4560
4561 pixel = f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_background_pixel;
4562 if (pixel != -1)
4563 {
4564 XtSetArg (av[ac], XmNbackground, pixel);
4565 ++ac;
4566 }
4567
4568 widget = XmCreateScrollBar (f->output_data.x->edit_widget,
4569 scroll_bar_name, av, ac);
4570
4571 /* Add one callback for everything that can happen. */
4572 XtAddCallback (widget, XmNdecrementCallback, xm_scroll_callback,
4573 (XtPointer) bar);
4574 XtAddCallback (widget, XmNdragCallback, xm_scroll_callback,
4575 (XtPointer) bar);
4576 XtAddCallback (widget, XmNincrementCallback, xm_scroll_callback,
4577 (XtPointer) bar);
4578 XtAddCallback (widget, XmNpageDecrementCallback, xm_scroll_callback,
4579 (XtPointer) bar);
4580 XtAddCallback (widget, XmNpageIncrementCallback, xm_scroll_callback,
4581 (XtPointer) bar);
4582 XtAddCallback (widget, XmNtoBottomCallback, xm_scroll_callback,
4583 (XtPointer) bar);
4584 XtAddCallback (widget, XmNtoTopCallback, xm_scroll_callback,
4585 (XtPointer) bar);
4586
4587 /* Realize the widget. Only after that is the X window created. */
4588 XtRealizeWidget (widget);
4589
4590 /* Set the cursor to an arrow. I didn't find a resource to do that.
4591 And I'm wondering why it hasn't an arrow cursor by default. */
4592 XDefineCursor (XtDisplay (widget), XtWindow (widget),
4593 f->output_data.x->nontext_cursor);
4594
4595 #else /* !USE_MOTIF i.e. use Xaw */
4596
4597 /* Set resources. Create the widget. The background of the
4598 Xaw3d scroll bar widget is a little bit light for my taste.
4599 We don't alter it here to let users change it according
4600 to their taste with `emacs*verticalScrollBar.background: xxx'. */
4601 XtSetArg (av[ac], XtNmappedWhenManaged, False); ++ac;
4602 XtSetArg (av[ac], XtNorientation, XtorientVertical); ++ac;
4603 /* For smoother scrolling with Xaw3d -sm */
4604 /* XtSetArg (av[ac], XtNpickTop, True); ++ac; */
4605
4606 pixel = f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_foreground_pixel;
4607 if (pixel != -1)
4608 {
4609 XtSetArg (av[ac], XtNforeground, pixel);
4610 ++ac;
4611 }
4612
4613 pixel = f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_background_pixel;
4614 if (pixel != -1)
4615 {
4616 XtSetArg (av[ac], XtNbackground, pixel);
4617 ++ac;
4618 }
4619
4620 /* Top/bottom shadow colors. */
4621
4622 /* Allocate them, if necessary. */
4623 if (f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_top_shadow_pixel == -1)
4624 {
4625 pixel = f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_background_pixel;
4626 if (pixel != -1)
4627 {
4628 if (!x_alloc_lighter_color (f, FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f),
4629 FRAME_X_COLORMAP (f),
4630 &pixel, 1.2, 0x8000))
4631 pixel = -1;
4632 f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_top_shadow_pixel = pixel;
4633 }
4634 }
4635 if (f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_bottom_shadow_pixel == -1)
4636 {
4637 pixel = f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_background_pixel;
4638 if (pixel != -1)
4639 {
4640 if (!x_alloc_lighter_color (f, FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f),
4641 FRAME_X_COLORMAP (f),
4642 &pixel, 0.6, 0x4000))
4643 pixel = -1;
4644 f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_bottom_shadow_pixel = pixel;
4645 }
4646 }
4647
4648 #ifdef XtNbeNiceToColormap
4649 /* Tell the toolkit about them. */
4650 if (f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_top_shadow_pixel == -1
4651 || f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_bottom_shadow_pixel == -1)
4652 /* We tried to allocate a color for the top/bottom shadow, and
4653 failed, so tell Xaw3d to use dithering instead. */
4654 /* But only if we have a small colormap. Xaw3d can allocate nice
4655 colors itself. */
4656 {
4657 XtSetArg (av[ac], XtNbeNiceToColormap,
4658 DefaultDepthOfScreen (FRAME_X_SCREEN (f)) < 16);
4659 ++ac;
4660 }
4661 else
4662 /* Tell what colors Xaw3d should use for the top/bottom shadow, to
4663 be more consistent with other emacs 3d colors, and since Xaw3d is
4664 not good at dealing with allocation failure. */
4665 {
4666 /* This tells Xaw3d to use real colors instead of dithering for
4667 the shadows. */
4668 XtSetArg (av[ac], XtNbeNiceToColormap, False);
4669 ++ac;
4670
4671 /* Specify the colors. */
4672 pixel = f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_top_shadow_pixel;
4673 if (pixel != -1)
4674 {
4675 XtSetArg (av[ac], XtNtopShadowPixel, pixel);
4676 ++ac;
4677 }
4678 pixel = f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_bottom_shadow_pixel;
4679 if (pixel != -1)
4680 {
4681 XtSetArg (av[ac], XtNbottomShadowPixel, pixel);
4682 ++ac;
4683 }
4684 }
4685 #endif
4686
4687 widget = XtCreateWidget (scroll_bar_name, scrollbarWidgetClass,
4688 f->output_data.x->edit_widget, av, ac);
4689
4690 {
4691 char *initial = "";
4692 char *val = initial;
4693 XtVaGetValues (widget, XtNscrollVCursor, (XtPointer) &val,
4694 #ifdef XtNarrowScrollbars
4695 XtNarrowScrollbars, (XtPointer) &xaw3d_arrow_scroll,
4696 #endif
4697 XtNpickTop, (XtPointer) &xaw3d_pick_top, NULL);
4698 if (xaw3d_arrow_scroll || val == initial)
4699 { /* ARROW_SCROLL */
4700 xaw3d_arrow_scroll = True;
4701 /* Isn't that just a personal preference ? --Stef */
4702 XtVaSetValues (widget, XtNcursorName, "top_left_arrow", NULL);
4703 }
4704 }
4705
4706 /* Define callbacks. */
4707 XtAddCallback (widget, XtNjumpProc, xaw_jump_callback, (XtPointer) bar);
4708 XtAddCallback (widget, XtNscrollProc, xaw_scroll_callback,
4709 (XtPointer) bar);
4710
4711 /* Realize the widget. Only after that is the X window created. */
4712 XtRealizeWidget (widget);
4713
4714 #endif /* !USE_MOTIF */
4715
4716 /* Install an action hook that lets us detect when the user
4717 finishes interacting with a scroll bar. */
4718 if (action_hook_id == 0)
4719 action_hook_id = XtAppAddActionHook (Xt_app_con, xt_action_hook, 0);
4720
4721 /* Remember X window and widget in the scroll bar vector. */
4722 SET_SCROLL_BAR_X_WIDGET (bar, widget);
4723 xwindow = XtWindow (widget);
4724 bar->x_window = xwindow;
4725
4726 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
4727 }
4728 #endif /* not USE_GTK */
4729
4730
4731 /* Set the thumb size and position of scroll bar BAR. We are currently
4732 displaying PORTION out of a whole WHOLE, and our position POSITION. */
4733
4734 #ifdef USE_GTK
4735 static void
4736 x_set_toolkit_scroll_bar_thumb (struct scroll_bar *bar, int portion, int position, int whole)
4737 {
4738 xg_set_toolkit_scroll_bar_thumb (bar, portion, position, whole);
4739 }
4740
4741 #else /* not USE_GTK */
4742 static void
4743 x_set_toolkit_scroll_bar_thumb (struct scroll_bar *bar, int portion, int position,
4744 int whole)
4745 {
4746 struct frame *f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (XWINDOW (bar->window)));
4747 Widget widget = SCROLL_BAR_X_WIDGET (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), bar);
4748 float top, shown;
4749
4750 BLOCK_INPUT;
4751
4752 #ifdef USE_MOTIF
4753
4754 /* We use an estimate of 30 chars per line rather than the real
4755 `portion' value. This has the disadvantage that the thumb size
4756 is not very representative, but it makes our life a lot easier.
4757 Otherwise, we have to constantly adjust the thumb size, which
4758 we can't always do quickly enough: while dragging, the size of
4759 the thumb might prevent the user from dragging the thumb all the
4760 way to the end. but Motif and some versions of Xaw3d don't allow
4761 updating the thumb size while dragging. Also, even if we can update
4762 its size, the update will often happen too late.
4763 If you don't believe it, check out revision 1.650 of xterm.c to see
4764 what hoops we were going through and the still poor behavior we got. */
4765 portion = WINDOW_TOTAL_LINES (XWINDOW (bar->window)) * 30;
4766 /* When the thumb is at the bottom, position == whole.
4767 So we need to increase `whole' to make space for the thumb. */
4768 whole += portion;
4769
4770 if (whole <= 0)
4771 top = 0, shown = 1;
4772 else
4773 {
4774 top = (float) position / whole;
4775 shown = (float) portion / whole;
4776 }
4777
4778 if (NILP (bar->dragging))
4779 {
4780 int size, value;
4781
4782 /* Slider size. Must be in the range [1 .. MAX - MIN] where MAX
4783 is the scroll bar's maximum and MIN is the scroll bar's minimum
4784 value. */
4785 size = shown * XM_SB_MAX;
4786 size = min (size, XM_SB_MAX);
4787 size = max (size, 1);
4788
4789 /* Position. Must be in the range [MIN .. MAX - SLIDER_SIZE]. */
4790 value = top * XM_SB_MAX;
4791 value = min (value, XM_SB_MAX - size);
4792
4793 XmScrollBarSetValues (widget, value, size, 0, 0, False);
4794 }
4795 #else /* !USE_MOTIF i.e. use Xaw */
4796
4797 if (whole == 0)
4798 top = 0, shown = 1;
4799 else
4800 {
4801 top = (float) position / whole;
4802 shown = (float) portion / whole;
4803 }
4804
4805 {
4806 float old_top, old_shown;
4807 Dimension height;
4808 XtVaGetValues (widget,
4809 XtNtopOfThumb, &old_top,
4810 XtNshown, &old_shown,
4811 XtNheight, &height,
4812 NULL);
4813
4814 /* Massage the top+shown values. */
4815 if (NILP (bar->dragging) || last_scroll_bar_part == scroll_bar_down_arrow)
4816 top = max (0, min (1, top));
4817 else
4818 top = old_top;
4819 /* Keep two pixels available for moving the thumb down. */
4820 shown = max (0, min (1 - top - (2.0 / height), shown));
4821
4822 /* If the call to XawScrollbarSetThumb below doesn't seem to work,
4823 check that your system's configuration file contains a define
4824 for `NARROWPROTO'. See s/freebsd.h for an example. */
4825 if (top != old_top || shown != old_shown)
4826 {
4827 if (NILP (bar->dragging))
4828 XawScrollbarSetThumb (widget, top, shown);
4829 else
4830 {
4831 /* Try to make the scrolling a tad smoother. */
4832 if (!xaw3d_pick_top)
4833 shown = min (shown, old_shown);
4834
4835 XawScrollbarSetThumb (widget, top, shown);
4836 }
4837 }
4838 }
4839 #endif /* !USE_MOTIF */
4840
4841 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
4842 }
4843 #endif /* not USE_GTK */
4844
4845 #endif /* USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
4846
4847
4848 \f
4849 /************************************************************************
4850 Scroll bars, general
4851 ************************************************************************/
4852
4853 /* Create a scroll bar and return the scroll bar vector for it. W is
4854 the Emacs window on which to create the scroll bar. TOP, LEFT,
4855 WIDTH and HEIGHT are the pixel coordinates and dimensions of the
4856 scroll bar. */
4857
4858 static struct scroll_bar *
4859 x_scroll_bar_create (struct window *w, int top, int left, int width, int height)
4860 {
4861 struct frame *f = XFRAME (w->frame);
4862 struct scroll_bar *bar
4863 = ALLOCATE_PSEUDOVECTOR (struct scroll_bar, x_window, PVEC_OTHER);
4864
4865 BLOCK_INPUT;
4866
4867 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
4868 x_create_toolkit_scroll_bar (f, bar);
4869 #else /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
4870 {
4871 XSetWindowAttributes a;
4872 unsigned long mask;
4873 Window window;
4874
4875 a.background_pixel = f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_background_pixel;
4876 if (a.background_pixel == -1)
4877 a.background_pixel = FRAME_BACKGROUND_PIXEL (f);
4878
4879 a.event_mask = (ButtonPressMask | ButtonReleaseMask
4880 | ButtonMotionMask | PointerMotionHintMask
4881 | ExposureMask);
4882 a.cursor = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->vertical_scroll_bar_cursor;
4883
4884 mask = (CWBackPixel | CWEventMask | CWCursor);
4885
4886 /* Clear the area of W that will serve as a scroll bar. This is
4887 for the case that a window has been split horizontally. In
4888 this case, no clear_frame is generated to reduce flickering. */
4889 if (width > 0 && height > 0)
4890 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
4891 left, top, width,
4892 window_box_height (w), False);
4893
4894 window = XCreateWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
4895 /* Position and size of scroll bar. */
4896 left + VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM,
4897 top,
4898 width - VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM * 2,
4899 height,
4900 /* Border width, depth, class, and visual. */
4901 0,
4902 CopyFromParent,
4903 CopyFromParent,
4904 CopyFromParent,
4905 /* Attributes. */
4906 mask, &a);
4907 bar->x_window = window;
4908 }
4909 #endif /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
4910
4911 XSETWINDOW (bar->window, w);
4912 bar->top = top;
4913 bar->left = left;
4914 bar->width = width;
4915 bar->height = height;
4916 bar->start = 0;
4917 bar->end = 0;
4918 bar->dragging = Qnil;
4919 bar->fringe_extended_p = 0;
4920
4921 /* Add bar to its frame's list of scroll bars. */
4922 bar->next = FRAME_SCROLL_BARS (f);
4923 bar->prev = Qnil;
4924 XSETVECTOR (FRAME_SCROLL_BARS (f), bar);
4925 if (!NILP (bar->next))
4926 XSETVECTOR (XSCROLL_BAR (bar->next)->prev, bar);
4927
4928 /* Map the window/widget. */
4929 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
4930 {
4931 #ifdef USE_GTK
4932 xg_update_scrollbar_pos (f,
4933 bar->x_window,
4934 top,
4935 left + VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM,
4936 width - VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM * 2,
4937 max (height, 1));
4938 #else /* not USE_GTK */
4939 Widget scroll_bar = SCROLL_BAR_X_WIDGET (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), bar);
4940 XtConfigureWidget (scroll_bar,
4941 left + VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM,
4942 top,
4943 width - VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM * 2,
4944 max (height, 1), 0);
4945 XtMapWidget (scroll_bar);
4946 #endif /* not USE_GTK */
4947 }
4948 #else /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
4949 XMapRaised (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), bar->x_window);
4950 #endif /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
4951
4952 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
4953 return bar;
4954 }
4955
4956
4957 #ifndef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
4958
4959 /* Draw BAR's handle in the proper position.
4960
4961 If the handle is already drawn from START to END, don't bother
4962 redrawing it, unless REBUILD is non-zero; in that case, always
4963 redraw it. (REBUILD is handy for drawing the handle after expose
4964 events.)
4965
4966 Normally, we want to constrain the start and end of the handle to
4967 fit inside its rectangle, but if the user is dragging the scroll
4968 bar handle, we want to let them drag it down all the way, so that
4969 the bar's top is as far down as it goes; otherwise, there's no way
4970 to move to the very end of the buffer. */
4971
4972 static void
4973 x_scroll_bar_set_handle (struct scroll_bar *bar, int start, int end, int rebuild)
4974 {
4975 int dragging = ! NILP (bar->dragging);
4976 Window w = bar->x_window;
4977 FRAME_PTR f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (XWINDOW (bar->window)));
4978 GC gc = f->output_data.x->normal_gc;
4979
4980 /* If the display is already accurate, do nothing. */
4981 if (! rebuild
4982 && start == bar->start
4983 && end == bar->end)
4984 return;
4985
4986 BLOCK_INPUT;
4987
4988 {
4989 int inside_width = VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_INSIDE_WIDTH (f, bar->width);
4990 int inside_height = VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_INSIDE_HEIGHT (f, bar->height);
4991 int top_range = VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_TOP_RANGE (f, bar->height);
4992
4993 /* Make sure the values are reasonable, and try to preserve
4994 the distance between start and end. */
4995 {
4996 int length = end - start;
4997
4998 if (start < 0)
4999 start = 0;
5000 else if (start > top_range)
5001 start = top_range;
5002 end = start + length;
5003
5004 if (end < start)
5005 end = start;
5006 else if (end > top_range && ! dragging)
5007 end = top_range;
5008 }
5009
5010 /* Store the adjusted setting in the scroll bar. */
5011 bar->start = start;
5012 bar->end = end;
5013
5014 /* Clip the end position, just for display. */
5015 if (end > top_range)
5016 end = top_range;
5017
5018 /* Draw bottom positions VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_MIN_HANDLE pixels
5019 below top positions, to make sure the handle is always at least
5020 that many pixels tall. */
5021 end += VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_MIN_HANDLE;
5022
5023 /* Draw the empty space above the handle. Note that we can't clear
5024 zero-height areas; that means "clear to end of window." */
5025 if (0 < start)
5026 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), w,
5027 /* x, y, width, height, and exposures. */
5028 VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_LEFT_BORDER,
5029 VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_TOP_BORDER,
5030 inside_width, start,
5031 False);
5032
5033 /* Change to proper foreground color if one is specified. */
5034 if (f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_foreground_pixel != -1)
5035 XSetForeground (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), gc,
5036 f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_foreground_pixel);
5037
5038 /* Draw the handle itself. */
5039 XFillRectangle (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), w, gc,
5040 /* x, y, width, height */
5041 VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_LEFT_BORDER,
5042 VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_TOP_BORDER + start,
5043 inside_width, end - start);
5044
5045 /* Restore the foreground color of the GC if we changed it above. */
5046 if (f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_foreground_pixel != -1)
5047 XSetForeground (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), gc,
5048 FRAME_FOREGROUND_PIXEL (f));
5049
5050 /* Draw the empty space below the handle. Note that we can't
5051 clear zero-height areas; that means "clear to end of window." */
5052 if (end < inside_height)
5053 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), w,
5054 /* x, y, width, height, and exposures. */
5055 VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_LEFT_BORDER,
5056 VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_TOP_BORDER + end,
5057 inside_width, inside_height - end,
5058 False);
5059
5060 }
5061
5062 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
5063 }
5064
5065 #endif /* !USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
5066
5067 /* Destroy scroll bar BAR, and set its Emacs window's scroll bar to
5068 nil. */
5069
5070 static void
5071 x_scroll_bar_remove (struct scroll_bar *bar)
5072 {
5073 struct frame *f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (XWINDOW (bar->window)));
5074 BLOCK_INPUT;
5075
5076 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
5077 #ifdef USE_GTK
5078 xg_remove_scroll_bar (f, bar->x_window);
5079 #else /* not USE_GTK */
5080 XtDestroyWidget (SCROLL_BAR_X_WIDGET (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), bar));
5081 #endif /* not USE_GTK */
5082 #else
5083 XDestroyWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), bar->x_window);
5084 #endif
5085
5086 /* Disassociate this scroll bar from its window. */
5087 XWINDOW (bar->window)->vertical_scroll_bar = Qnil;
5088
5089 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
5090 }
5091
5092
5093 /* Set the handle of the vertical scroll bar for WINDOW to indicate
5094 that we are displaying PORTION characters out of a total of WHOLE
5095 characters, starting at POSITION. If WINDOW has no scroll bar,
5096 create one. */
5097
5098 static void
5099 XTset_vertical_scroll_bar (struct window *w, int portion, int whole, int position)
5100 {
5101 struct frame *f = XFRAME (w->frame);
5102 struct scroll_bar *bar;
5103 int top, height, left, sb_left, width, sb_width;
5104 int window_y, window_height;
5105 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
5106 int fringe_extended_p;
5107 #endif
5108
5109 /* Get window dimensions. */
5110 window_box (w, -1, 0, &window_y, 0, &window_height);
5111 top = window_y;
5112 width = WINDOW_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_COLS (w) * FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (f);
5113 height = window_height;
5114
5115 /* Compute the left edge of the scroll bar area. */
5116 left = WINDOW_SCROLL_BAR_AREA_X (w);
5117
5118 /* Compute the width of the scroll bar which might be less than
5119 the width of the area reserved for the scroll bar. */
5120 if (WINDOW_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH (w) > 0)
5121 sb_width = WINDOW_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH (w);
5122 else
5123 sb_width = width;
5124
5125 /* Compute the left edge of the scroll bar. */
5126 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
5127 if (WINDOW_HAS_VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_ON_RIGHT (w))
5128 sb_left = left + (WINDOW_RIGHTMOST_P (w) ? width - sb_width : 0);
5129 else
5130 sb_left = left + (WINDOW_LEFTMOST_P (w) ? 0 : width - sb_width);
5131 #else
5132 if (WINDOW_HAS_VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_ON_RIGHT (w))
5133 sb_left = left + width - sb_width;
5134 else
5135 sb_left = left;
5136 #endif
5137
5138 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
5139 if (WINDOW_HAS_VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_ON_LEFT (w))
5140 fringe_extended_p = (WINDOW_LEFTMOST_P (w)
5141 && WINDOW_LEFT_FRINGE_WIDTH (w)
5142 && (WINDOW_HAS_FRINGES_OUTSIDE_MARGINS (w)
5143 || WINDOW_LEFT_MARGIN_COLS (w) == 0));
5144 else
5145 fringe_extended_p = (WINDOW_RIGHTMOST_P (w)
5146 && WINDOW_RIGHT_FRINGE_WIDTH (w)
5147 && (WINDOW_HAS_FRINGES_OUTSIDE_MARGINS (w)
5148 || WINDOW_RIGHT_MARGIN_COLS (w) == 0));
5149 #endif
5150
5151 /* Does the scroll bar exist yet? */
5152 if (NILP (w->vertical_scroll_bar))
5153 {
5154 if (width > 0 && height > 0)
5155 {
5156 BLOCK_INPUT;
5157 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
5158 if (fringe_extended_p)
5159 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
5160 sb_left, top, sb_width, height, False);
5161 else
5162 #endif
5163 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
5164 left, top, width, height, False);
5165 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
5166 }
5167
5168 bar = x_scroll_bar_create (w, top, sb_left, sb_width, height);
5169 }
5170 else
5171 {
5172 /* It may just need to be moved and resized. */
5173 unsigned int mask = 0;
5174
5175 bar = XSCROLL_BAR (w->vertical_scroll_bar);
5176
5177 BLOCK_INPUT;
5178
5179 if (sb_left != bar->left)
5180 mask |= CWX;
5181 if (top != bar->top)
5182 mask |= CWY;
5183 if (sb_width != bar->width)
5184 mask |= CWWidth;
5185 if (height != bar->height)
5186 mask |= CWHeight;
5187
5188 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
5189
5190 /* Move/size the scroll bar widget. */
5191 if (mask || bar->fringe_extended_p != fringe_extended_p)
5192 {
5193 /* Since toolkit scroll bars are smaller than the space reserved
5194 for them on the frame, we have to clear "under" them. */
5195 if (width > 0 && height > 0)
5196 {
5197 if (fringe_extended_p)
5198 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
5199 sb_left, top, sb_width, height, False);
5200 else
5201 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
5202 left, top, width, height, False);
5203 }
5204 #ifdef USE_GTK
5205 xg_update_scrollbar_pos (f,
5206 bar->x_window,
5207 top,
5208 sb_left + VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM,
5209 sb_width - VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM *2,
5210 max (height, 1));
5211 #else /* not USE_GTK */
5212 XtConfigureWidget (SCROLL_BAR_X_WIDGET (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), bar),
5213 sb_left + VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM,
5214 top,
5215 sb_width - VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM * 2,
5216 max (height, 1), 0);
5217 #endif /* not USE_GTK */
5218 }
5219 #else /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
5220
5221 /* Clear areas not covered by the scroll bar because of
5222 VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM. */
5223 if (VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM)
5224 {
5225 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
5226 left, top, VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM,
5227 height, False);
5228 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
5229 left + width - VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM,
5230 top, VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM,
5231 height, False);
5232 }
5233
5234 /* Clear areas not covered by the scroll bar because it's not as
5235 wide as the area reserved for it. This makes sure a
5236 previous mode line display is cleared after C-x 2 C-x 1, for
5237 example. */
5238 {
5239 int area_width = WINDOW_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_COLS (w) * FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (f);
5240 int rest = area_width - sb_width;
5241 if (rest > 0 && height > 0)
5242 {
5243 if (WINDOW_HAS_VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_ON_LEFT (w))
5244 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
5245 left + area_width - rest, top,
5246 rest, height, False);
5247 else
5248 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
5249 left, top, rest, height, False);
5250 }
5251 }
5252
5253 /* Move/size the scroll bar window. */
5254 if (mask)
5255 {
5256 XWindowChanges wc;
5257
5258 wc.x = sb_left + VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM;
5259 wc.y = top;
5260 wc.width = sb_width - VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM * 2;
5261 wc.height = height;
5262 XConfigureWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), bar->x_window,
5263 mask, &wc);
5264 }
5265
5266 #endif /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
5267
5268 /* Remember new settings. */
5269 bar->left = sb_left;
5270 bar->top = top;
5271 bar->width = sb_width;
5272 bar->height = height;
5273
5274 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
5275 }
5276
5277 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
5278 bar->fringe_extended_p = fringe_extended_p;
5279
5280 x_set_toolkit_scroll_bar_thumb (bar, portion, position, whole);
5281 #else /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
5282 /* Set the scroll bar's current state, unless we're currently being
5283 dragged. */
5284 if (NILP (bar->dragging))
5285 {
5286 int top_range = VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_TOP_RANGE (f, height);
5287
5288 if (whole == 0)
5289 x_scroll_bar_set_handle (bar, 0, top_range, 0);
5290 else
5291 {
5292 int start = ((double) position * top_range) / whole;
5293 int end = ((double) (position + portion) * top_range) / whole;
5294 x_scroll_bar_set_handle (bar, start, end, 0);
5295 }
5296 }
5297 #endif /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
5298
5299 XSETVECTOR (w->vertical_scroll_bar, bar);
5300 }
5301
5302
5303 /* The following three hooks are used when we're doing a thorough
5304 redisplay of the frame. We don't explicitly know which scroll bars
5305 are going to be deleted, because keeping track of when windows go
5306 away is a real pain - "Can you say set-window-configuration, boys
5307 and girls?" Instead, we just assert at the beginning of redisplay
5308 that *all* scroll bars are to be removed, and then save a scroll bar
5309 from the fiery pit when we actually redisplay its window. */
5310
5311 /* Arrange for all scroll bars on FRAME to be removed at the next call
5312 to `*judge_scroll_bars_hook'. A scroll bar may be spared if
5313 `*redeem_scroll_bar_hook' is applied to its window before the judgment. */
5314
5315 static void
5316 XTcondemn_scroll_bars (FRAME_PTR frame)
5317 {
5318 /* Transfer all the scroll bars to FRAME_CONDEMNED_SCROLL_BARS. */
5319 while (! NILP (FRAME_SCROLL_BARS (frame)))
5320 {
5321 Lisp_Object bar;
5322 bar = FRAME_SCROLL_BARS (frame);
5323 FRAME_SCROLL_BARS (frame) = XSCROLL_BAR (bar)->next;
5324 XSCROLL_BAR (bar)->next = FRAME_CONDEMNED_SCROLL_BARS (frame);
5325 XSCROLL_BAR (bar)->prev = Qnil;
5326 if (! NILP (FRAME_CONDEMNED_SCROLL_BARS (frame)))
5327 XSCROLL_BAR (FRAME_CONDEMNED_SCROLL_BARS (frame))->prev = bar;
5328 FRAME_CONDEMNED_SCROLL_BARS (frame) = bar;
5329 }
5330 }
5331
5332
5333 /* Un-mark WINDOW's scroll bar for deletion in this judgment cycle.
5334 Note that WINDOW isn't necessarily condemned at all. */
5335
5336 static void
5337 XTredeem_scroll_bar (struct window *window)
5338 {
5339 struct scroll_bar *bar;
5340 struct frame *f;
5341
5342 /* We can't redeem this window's scroll bar if it doesn't have one. */
5343 if (NILP (window->vertical_scroll_bar))
5344 abort ();
5345
5346 bar = XSCROLL_BAR (window->vertical_scroll_bar);
5347
5348 /* Unlink it from the condemned list. */
5349 f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (window));
5350 if (NILP (bar->prev))
5351 {
5352 /* If the prev pointer is nil, it must be the first in one of
5353 the lists. */
5354 if (EQ (FRAME_SCROLL_BARS (f), window->vertical_scroll_bar))
5355 /* It's not condemned. Everything's fine. */
5356 return;
5357 else if (EQ (FRAME_CONDEMNED_SCROLL_BARS (f),
5358 window->vertical_scroll_bar))
5359 FRAME_CONDEMNED_SCROLL_BARS (f) = bar->next;
5360 else
5361 /* If its prev pointer is nil, it must be at the front of
5362 one or the other! */
5363 abort ();
5364 }
5365 else
5366 XSCROLL_BAR (bar->prev)->next = bar->next;
5367
5368 if (! NILP (bar->next))
5369 XSCROLL_BAR (bar->next)->prev = bar->prev;
5370
5371 bar->next = FRAME_SCROLL_BARS (f);
5372 bar->prev = Qnil;
5373 XSETVECTOR (FRAME_SCROLL_BARS (f), bar);
5374 if (! NILP (bar->next))
5375 XSETVECTOR (XSCROLL_BAR (bar->next)->prev, bar);
5376 }
5377
5378 /* Remove all scroll bars on FRAME that haven't been saved since the
5379 last call to `*condemn_scroll_bars_hook'. */
5380
5381 static void
5382 XTjudge_scroll_bars (FRAME_PTR f)
5383 {
5384 Lisp_Object bar, next;
5385
5386 bar = FRAME_CONDEMNED_SCROLL_BARS (f);
5387
5388 /* Clear out the condemned list now so we won't try to process any
5389 more events on the hapless scroll bars. */
5390 FRAME_CONDEMNED_SCROLL_BARS (f) = Qnil;
5391
5392 for (; ! NILP (bar); bar = next)
5393 {
5394 struct scroll_bar *b = XSCROLL_BAR (bar);
5395
5396 x_scroll_bar_remove (b);
5397
5398 next = b->next;
5399 b->next = b->prev = Qnil;
5400 }
5401
5402 /* Now there should be no references to the condemned scroll bars,
5403 and they should get garbage-collected. */
5404 }
5405
5406
5407 #ifndef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
5408 /* Handle an Expose or GraphicsExpose event on a scroll bar. This
5409 is a no-op when using toolkit scroll bars.
5410
5411 This may be called from a signal handler, so we have to ignore GC
5412 mark bits. */
5413
5414 static void
5415 x_scroll_bar_expose (struct scroll_bar *bar, XEvent *event)
5416 {
5417 Window w = bar->x_window;
5418 FRAME_PTR f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (XWINDOW (bar->window)));
5419 GC gc = f->output_data.x->normal_gc;
5420 int width_trim = VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM;
5421
5422 BLOCK_INPUT;
5423
5424 x_scroll_bar_set_handle (bar, bar->start, bar->end, 1);
5425
5426 /* Switch to scroll bar foreground color. */
5427 if (f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_foreground_pixel != -1)
5428 XSetForeground (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), gc,
5429 f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_foreground_pixel);
5430
5431 /* Draw a one-pixel border just inside the edges of the scroll bar. */
5432 XDrawRectangle (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), w, gc,
5433
5434 /* x, y, width, height */
5435 0, 0,
5436 bar->width - 1 - width_trim - width_trim,
5437 bar->height - 1);
5438
5439 /* Restore the foreground color of the GC if we changed it above. */
5440 if (f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_foreground_pixel != -1)
5441 XSetForeground (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), gc,
5442 FRAME_FOREGROUND_PIXEL (f));
5443
5444 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
5445
5446 }
5447 #endif /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
5448
5449 /* Handle a mouse click on the scroll bar BAR. If *EMACS_EVENT's kind
5450 is set to something other than NO_EVENT, it is enqueued.
5451
5452 This may be called from a signal handler, so we have to ignore GC
5453 mark bits. */
5454
5455
5456 static void
5457 x_scroll_bar_handle_click (struct scroll_bar *bar, XEvent *event, struct input_event *emacs_event)
5458 {
5459 if (! WINDOWP (bar->window))
5460 abort ();
5461
5462 emacs_event->kind = SCROLL_BAR_CLICK_EVENT;
5463 emacs_event->code = event->xbutton.button - Button1;
5464 emacs_event->modifiers
5465 = (x_x_to_emacs_modifiers (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO
5466 (XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (XWINDOW (bar->window)))),
5467 event->xbutton.state)
5468 | (event->type == ButtonRelease
5469 ? up_modifier
5470 : down_modifier));
5471 emacs_event->frame_or_window = bar->window;
5472 emacs_event->arg = Qnil;
5473 emacs_event->timestamp = event->xbutton.time;
5474 {
5475 int top_range
5476 = VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_TOP_RANGE (f, bar->height);
5477 int y = event->xbutton.y - VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_TOP_BORDER;
5478
5479 if (y < 0) y = 0;
5480 if (y > top_range) y = top_range;
5481
5482 if (y < bar->start)
5483 emacs_event->part = scroll_bar_above_handle;
5484 else if (y < bar->end + VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_MIN_HANDLE)
5485 emacs_event->part = scroll_bar_handle;
5486 else
5487 emacs_event->part = scroll_bar_below_handle;
5488
5489 #ifndef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
5490 /* If the user has released the handle, set it to its final position. */
5491 if (event->type == ButtonRelease
5492 && ! NILP (bar->dragging))
5493 {
5494 int new_start = y - XINT (bar->dragging);
5495 int new_end = new_start + bar->end - bar->start;
5496
5497 x_scroll_bar_set_handle (bar, new_start, new_end, 0);
5498 bar->dragging = Qnil;
5499 }
5500 #endif
5501
5502 XSETINT (emacs_event->x, y);
5503 XSETINT (emacs_event->y, top_range);
5504 }
5505 }
5506
5507 #ifndef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
5508
5509 /* Handle some mouse motion while someone is dragging the scroll bar.
5510
5511 This may be called from a signal handler, so we have to ignore GC
5512 mark bits. */
5513
5514 static void
5515 x_scroll_bar_note_movement (struct scroll_bar *bar, XEvent *event)
5516 {
5517 FRAME_PTR f = XFRAME (XWINDOW (bar->window)->frame);
5518
5519 last_mouse_movement_time = event->xmotion.time;
5520
5521 f->mouse_moved = 1;
5522 XSETVECTOR (last_mouse_scroll_bar, bar);
5523
5524 /* If we're dragging the bar, display it. */
5525 if (! NILP (bar->dragging))
5526 {
5527 /* Where should the handle be now? */
5528 int new_start = event->xmotion.y - XINT (bar->dragging);
5529
5530 if (new_start != bar->start)
5531 {
5532 int new_end = new_start + bar->end - bar->start;
5533
5534 x_scroll_bar_set_handle (bar, new_start, new_end, 0);
5535 }
5536 }
5537 }
5538
5539 #endif /* !USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
5540
5541 /* Return information to the user about the current position of the mouse
5542 on the scroll bar. */
5543
5544 static void
5545 x_scroll_bar_report_motion (FRAME_PTR *fp, Lisp_Object *bar_window, enum scroll_bar_part *part, Lisp_Object *x, Lisp_Object *y, long unsigned int *time)
5546 {
5547 struct scroll_bar *bar = XSCROLL_BAR (last_mouse_scroll_bar);
5548 Window w = bar->x_window;
5549 FRAME_PTR f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (XWINDOW (bar->window)));
5550 int win_x, win_y;
5551 Window dummy_window;
5552 int dummy_coord;
5553 unsigned int dummy_mask;
5554
5555 BLOCK_INPUT;
5556
5557 /* Get the mouse's position relative to the scroll bar window, and
5558 report that. */
5559 if (! XQueryPointer (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), w,
5560
5561 /* Root, child, root x and root y. */
5562 &dummy_window, &dummy_window,
5563 &dummy_coord, &dummy_coord,
5564
5565 /* Position relative to scroll bar. */
5566 &win_x, &win_y,
5567
5568 /* Mouse buttons and modifier keys. */
5569 &dummy_mask))
5570 ;
5571 else
5572 {
5573 int top_range
5574 = VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_TOP_RANGE (f, bar->height);
5575
5576 win_y -= VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_TOP_BORDER;
5577
5578 if (! NILP (bar->dragging))
5579 win_y -= XINT (bar->dragging);
5580
5581 if (win_y < 0)
5582 win_y = 0;
5583 if (win_y > top_range)
5584 win_y = top_range;
5585
5586 *fp = f;
5587 *bar_window = bar->window;
5588
5589 if (! NILP (bar->dragging))
5590 *part = scroll_bar_handle;
5591 else if (win_y < bar->start)
5592 *part = scroll_bar_above_handle;
5593 else if (win_y < bar->end + VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_MIN_HANDLE)
5594 *part = scroll_bar_handle;
5595 else
5596 *part = scroll_bar_below_handle;
5597
5598 XSETINT (*x, win_y);
5599 XSETINT (*y, top_range);
5600
5601 f->mouse_moved = 0;
5602 last_mouse_scroll_bar = Qnil;
5603 }
5604
5605 *time = last_mouse_movement_time;
5606
5607 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
5608 }
5609
5610
5611 /* The screen has been cleared so we may have changed foreground or
5612 background colors, and the scroll bars may need to be redrawn.
5613 Clear out the scroll bars, and ask for expose events, so we can
5614 redraw them. */
5615
5616 static void
5617 x_scroll_bar_clear (FRAME_PTR f)
5618 {
5619 #ifndef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
5620 Lisp_Object bar;
5621
5622 /* We can have scroll bars even if this is 0,
5623 if we just turned off scroll bar mode.
5624 But in that case we should not clear them. */
5625 if (FRAME_HAS_VERTICAL_SCROLL_BARS (f))
5626 for (bar = FRAME_SCROLL_BARS (f); VECTORP (bar);
5627 bar = XSCROLL_BAR (bar)->next)
5628 XClearArea (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f),
5629 XSCROLL_BAR (bar)->x_window,
5630 0, 0, 0, 0, True);
5631 #endif /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
5632 }
5633
5634 \f
5635 /* The main X event-reading loop - XTread_socket. */
5636
5637 /* This holds the state XLookupString needs to implement dead keys
5638 and other tricks known as "compose processing". _X Window System_
5639 says that a portable program can't use this, but Stephen Gildea assures
5640 me that letting the compiler initialize it to zeros will work okay.
5641
5642 This must be defined outside of XTread_socket, for the same reasons
5643 given for enter_timestamp, above. */
5644
5645 static XComposeStatus compose_status;
5646
5647 /* Record the last 100 characters stored
5648 to help debug the loss-of-chars-during-GC problem. */
5649
5650 static int temp_index;
5651 static short temp_buffer[100];
5652
5653 #define STORE_KEYSYM_FOR_DEBUG(keysym) \
5654 if (temp_index == sizeof temp_buffer / sizeof (short)) \
5655 temp_index = 0; \
5656 temp_buffer[temp_index++] = (keysym)
5657
5658 /* Set this to nonzero to fake an "X I/O error"
5659 on a particular display. */
5660
5661 struct x_display_info *XTread_socket_fake_io_error;
5662
5663 /* When we find no input here, we occasionally do a no-op command
5664 to verify that the X server is still running and we can still talk with it.
5665 We try all the open displays, one by one.
5666 This variable is used for cycling thru the displays. */
5667
5668 static struct x_display_info *next_noop_dpyinfo;
5669
5670 #define SET_SAVED_BUTTON_EVENT \
5671 do \
5672 { \
5673 if (f->output_data.x->saved_menu_event == 0) \
5674 f->output_data.x->saved_menu_event \
5675 = (XEvent *) xmalloc (sizeof (XEvent)); \
5676 *f->output_data.x->saved_menu_event = event; \
5677 inev.ie.kind = MENU_BAR_ACTIVATE_EVENT; \
5678 XSETFRAME (inev.ie.frame_or_window, f); \
5679 } \
5680 while (0)
5681
5682 enum
5683 {
5684 X_EVENT_NORMAL,
5685 X_EVENT_GOTO_OUT,
5686 X_EVENT_DROP
5687 };
5688
5689 /* Filter events for the current X input method.
5690 DPYINFO is the display this event is for.
5691 EVENT is the X event to filter.
5692
5693 Returns non-zero if the event was filtered, caller shall not process
5694 this event further.
5695 Returns zero if event is wasn't filtered. */
5696
5697 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
5698 static int
5699 x_filter_event (struct x_display_info *dpyinfo, XEvent *event)
5700 {
5701 /* XFilterEvent returns non-zero if the input method has
5702 consumed the event. We pass the frame's X window to
5703 XFilterEvent because that's the one for which the IC
5704 was created. */
5705
5706 struct frame *f1 = x_any_window_to_frame (dpyinfo,
5707 event->xclient.window);
5708
5709 return XFilterEvent (event, f1 ? FRAME_X_WINDOW (f1) : None);
5710 }
5711 #endif
5712
5713 #ifdef USE_GTK
5714 static int current_count;
5715 static int current_finish;
5716 static struct input_event *current_hold_quit;
5717
5718 /* This is the filter function invoked by the GTK event loop.
5719 It is invoked before the XEvent is translated to a GdkEvent,
5720 so we have a chance to act on the event before GTK. */
5721 static GdkFilterReturn
5722 event_handler_gdk (GdkXEvent *gxev, GdkEvent *ev, gpointer data)
5723 {
5724 XEvent *xev = (XEvent *) gxev;
5725
5726 BLOCK_INPUT;
5727 if (current_count >= 0)
5728 {
5729 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
5730
5731 dpyinfo = x_display_info_for_display (xev->xany.display);
5732
5733 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
5734 /* Filter events for the current X input method.
5735 GTK calls XFilterEvent but not for key press and release,
5736 so we do it here. */
5737 if ((xev->type == KeyPress || xev->type == KeyRelease)
5738 && dpyinfo
5739 && x_filter_event (dpyinfo, xev))
5740 {
5741 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
5742 return GDK_FILTER_REMOVE;
5743 }
5744 #endif
5745
5746 if (! dpyinfo)
5747 current_finish = X_EVENT_NORMAL;
5748 else
5749 current_count +=
5750 handle_one_xevent (dpyinfo, xev, &current_finish,
5751 current_hold_quit);
5752 }
5753 else
5754 current_finish = x_dispatch_event (xev, xev->xany.display);
5755
5756 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
5757
5758 if (current_finish == X_EVENT_GOTO_OUT || current_finish == X_EVENT_DROP)
5759 return GDK_FILTER_REMOVE;
5760
5761 return GDK_FILTER_CONTINUE;
5762 }
5763 #endif /* USE_GTK */
5764
5765
5766 static void xembed_send_message (struct frame *f, Time time,
5767 enum xembed_message message,
5768 long detail, long data1, long data2);
5769
5770 /* Handles the XEvent EVENT on display DPYINFO.
5771
5772 *FINISH is X_EVENT_GOTO_OUT if caller should stop reading events.
5773 *FINISH is zero if caller should continue reading events.
5774 *FINISH is X_EVENT_DROP if event should not be passed to the toolkit.
5775
5776 We return the number of characters stored into the buffer. */
5777
5778 static int
5779 handle_one_xevent (struct x_display_info *dpyinfo, XEvent *eventp, int *finish, struct input_event *hold_quit)
5780 {
5781 union {
5782 struct input_event ie;
5783 struct selection_input_event sie;
5784 } inev;
5785 int count = 0;
5786 int do_help = 0;
5787 int nbytes = 0;
5788 struct frame *f = NULL;
5789 struct coding_system coding;
5790 XEvent event = *eventp;
5791 Mouse_HLInfo *hlinfo = &dpyinfo->mouse_highlight;
5792
5793 *finish = X_EVENT_NORMAL;
5794
5795 EVENT_INIT (inev.ie);
5796 inev.ie.kind = NO_EVENT;
5797 inev.ie.arg = Qnil;
5798
5799 if (pending_event_wait.eventtype == event.type)
5800 pending_event_wait.eventtype = 0; /* Indicates we got it. */
5801
5802 switch (event.type)
5803 {
5804 case ClientMessage:
5805 {
5806 if (event.xclient.message_type
5807 == dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_protocols
5808 && event.xclient.format == 32)
5809 {
5810 if (event.xclient.data.l[0]
5811 == dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_take_focus)
5812 {
5813 /* Use x_any_window_to_frame because this
5814 could be the shell widget window
5815 if the frame has no title bar. */
5816 f = x_any_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xclient.window);
5817 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
5818 /* Not quite sure this is needed -pd */
5819 if (f && FRAME_XIC (f))
5820 XSetICFocus (FRAME_XIC (f));
5821 #endif
5822 #if 0 /* Emacs sets WM hints whose `input' field is `true'. This
5823 instructs the WM to set the input focus automatically for
5824 Emacs with a call to XSetInputFocus. Setting WM_TAKE_FOCUS
5825 tells the WM to send us a ClientMessage WM_TAKE_FOCUS after
5826 it has set the focus. So, XSetInputFocus below is not
5827 needed.
5828
5829 The call to XSetInputFocus below has also caused trouble. In
5830 cases where the XSetInputFocus done by the WM and the one
5831 below are temporally close (on a fast machine), the call
5832 below can generate additional FocusIn events which confuse
5833 Emacs. */
5834
5835 /* Since we set WM_TAKE_FOCUS, we must call
5836 XSetInputFocus explicitly. But not if f is null,
5837 since that might be an event for a deleted frame. */
5838 if (f)
5839 {
5840 Display *d = event.xclient.display;
5841 /* Catch and ignore errors, in case window has been
5842 iconified by a window manager such as GWM. */
5843 x_catch_errors (d);
5844 XSetInputFocus (d, event.xclient.window,
5845 /* The ICCCM says this is
5846 the only valid choice. */
5847 RevertToParent,
5848 event.xclient.data.l[1]);
5849 /* This is needed to detect the error
5850 if there is an error. */
5851 XSync (d, False);
5852 x_uncatch_errors ();
5853 }
5854 /* Not certain about handling scroll bars here */
5855 #endif /* 0 */
5856 goto done;
5857 }
5858
5859 if (event.xclient.data.l[0]
5860 == dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_save_yourself)
5861 {
5862 /* Save state modify the WM_COMMAND property to
5863 something which can reinstate us. This notifies
5864 the session manager, who's looking for such a
5865 PropertyNotify. Can restart processing when
5866 a keyboard or mouse event arrives. */
5867 /* If we have a session manager, don't set this.
5868 KDE will then start two Emacsen, one for the
5869 session manager and one for this. */
5870 #ifdef HAVE_X_SM
5871 if (! x_session_have_connection ())
5872 #endif
5873 {
5874 f = x_top_window_to_frame (dpyinfo,
5875 event.xclient.window);
5876 /* This is just so we only give real data once
5877 for a single Emacs process. */
5878 if (f == SELECTED_FRAME ())
5879 XSetCommand (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f),
5880 event.xclient.window,
5881 initial_argv, initial_argc);
5882 else if (f)
5883 XSetCommand (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f),
5884 event.xclient.window,
5885 0, 0);
5886 }
5887 goto done;
5888 }
5889
5890 if (event.xclient.data.l[0]
5891 == dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_delete_window)
5892 {
5893 f = x_any_window_to_frame (dpyinfo,
5894 event.xclient.window);
5895 if (!f)
5896 goto OTHER; /* May be a dialog that is to be removed */
5897
5898 inev.ie.kind = DELETE_WINDOW_EVENT;
5899 XSETFRAME (inev.ie.frame_or_window, f);
5900 goto done;
5901 }
5902
5903 goto done;
5904 }
5905
5906 if (event.xclient.message_type
5907 == dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_configure_denied)
5908 {
5909 goto done;
5910 }
5911
5912 if (event.xclient.message_type
5913 == dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_window_moved)
5914 {
5915 int new_x, new_y;
5916 f = x_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xclient.window);
5917
5918 new_x = event.xclient.data.s[0];
5919 new_y = event.xclient.data.s[1];
5920
5921 if (f)
5922 {
5923 f->left_pos = new_x;
5924 f->top_pos = new_y;
5925 }
5926 goto done;
5927 }
5928
5929 #ifdef HACK_EDITRES
5930 if (event.xclient.message_type
5931 == dpyinfo->Xatom_editres)
5932 {
5933 f = x_any_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xclient.window);
5934 if (f)
5935 _XEditResCheckMessages (f->output_data.x->widget, NULL,
5936 &event, NULL);
5937 goto done;
5938 }
5939 #endif /* HACK_EDITRES */
5940
5941 if ((event.xclient.message_type
5942 == dpyinfo->Xatom_DONE)
5943 || (event.xclient.message_type
5944 == dpyinfo->Xatom_PAGE))
5945 {
5946 /* Ghostview job completed. Kill it. We could
5947 reply with "Next" if we received "Page", but we
5948 currently never do because we are interested in
5949 images, only, which should have 1 page. */
5950 Pixmap pixmap = (Pixmap) event.xclient.data.l[1];
5951 f = x_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xclient.window);
5952 if (!f)
5953 goto OTHER;
5954 x_kill_gs_process (pixmap, f);
5955 expose_frame (f, 0, 0, 0, 0);
5956 goto done;
5957 }
5958
5959 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
5960 /* Scroll bar callbacks send a ClientMessage from which
5961 we construct an input_event. */
5962 if (event.xclient.message_type
5963 == dpyinfo->Xatom_Scrollbar)
5964 {
5965 x_scroll_bar_to_input_event (&event, &inev.ie);
5966 *finish = X_EVENT_GOTO_OUT;
5967 goto done;
5968 }
5969 #endif /* USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
5970
5971 /* XEmbed messages from the embedder (if any). */
5972 if (event.xclient.message_type
5973 == dpyinfo->Xatom_XEMBED)
5974 {
5975 enum xembed_message msg = event.xclient.data.l[1];
5976 if (msg == XEMBED_FOCUS_IN || msg == XEMBED_FOCUS_OUT)
5977 x_detect_focus_change (dpyinfo, &event, &inev.ie);
5978
5979 *finish = X_EVENT_GOTO_OUT;
5980 goto done;
5981 }
5982
5983 xft_settings_event (dpyinfo, &event);
5984
5985 f = x_any_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xclient.window);
5986 if (!f)
5987 goto OTHER;
5988 if (x_handle_dnd_message (f, &event.xclient, dpyinfo, &inev.ie))
5989 *finish = X_EVENT_DROP;
5990 }
5991 break;
5992
5993 case SelectionNotify:
5994 last_user_time = event.xselection.time;
5995 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
5996 if (! x_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xselection.requestor))
5997 goto OTHER;
5998 #endif /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
5999 x_handle_selection_notify (&event.xselection);
6000 break;
6001
6002 case SelectionClear: /* Someone has grabbed ownership. */
6003 last_user_time = event.xselectionclear.time;
6004 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
6005 if (! x_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xselectionclear.window))
6006 goto OTHER;
6007 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
6008 {
6009 XSelectionClearEvent *eventp = (XSelectionClearEvent *) &event;
6010
6011 inev.ie.kind = SELECTION_CLEAR_EVENT;
6012 SELECTION_EVENT_DISPLAY (&inev.sie) = eventp->display;
6013 SELECTION_EVENT_SELECTION (&inev.sie) = eventp->selection;
6014 SELECTION_EVENT_TIME (&inev.sie) = eventp->time;
6015 inev.ie.frame_or_window = Qnil;
6016 }
6017 break;
6018
6019 case SelectionRequest: /* Someone wants our selection. */
6020 last_user_time = event.xselectionrequest.time;
6021 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
6022 if (!x_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xselectionrequest.owner))
6023 goto OTHER;
6024 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
6025 {
6026 XSelectionRequestEvent *eventp
6027 = (XSelectionRequestEvent *) &event;
6028
6029 inev.ie.kind = SELECTION_REQUEST_EVENT;
6030 SELECTION_EVENT_DISPLAY (&inev.sie) = eventp->display;
6031 SELECTION_EVENT_REQUESTOR (&inev.sie) = eventp->requestor;
6032 SELECTION_EVENT_SELECTION (&inev.sie) = eventp->selection;
6033 SELECTION_EVENT_TARGET (&inev.sie) = eventp->target;
6034 SELECTION_EVENT_PROPERTY (&inev.sie) = eventp->property;
6035 SELECTION_EVENT_TIME (&inev.sie) = eventp->time;
6036 inev.ie.frame_or_window = Qnil;
6037 }
6038 break;
6039
6040 case PropertyNotify:
6041 last_user_time = event.xproperty.time;
6042 f = x_top_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xproperty.window);
6043 if (f && event.xproperty.atom == dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state)
6044 x_handle_net_wm_state (f, &event.xproperty);
6045
6046 x_handle_property_notify (&event.xproperty);
6047 xft_settings_event (dpyinfo, &event);
6048 goto OTHER;
6049
6050 case ReparentNotify:
6051 f = x_top_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xreparent.window);
6052 if (f)
6053 {
6054 int x, y;
6055 f->output_data.x->parent_desc = event.xreparent.parent;
6056 x_real_positions (f, &x, &y);
6057 f->left_pos = x;
6058 f->top_pos = y;
6059
6060 /* Perhaps reparented due to a WM restart. Reset this. */
6061 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->wm_type = X_WMTYPE_UNKNOWN;
6062 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->net_supported_window = 0;
6063 }
6064 goto OTHER;
6065
6066 case Expose:
6067 f = x_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xexpose.window);
6068 if (f)
6069 {
6070 #ifdef USE_GTK
6071 /* This seems to be needed for GTK 2.6. */
6072 x_clear_area (event.xexpose.display,
6073 event.xexpose.window,
6074 event.xexpose.x, event.xexpose.y,
6075 event.xexpose.width, event.xexpose.height,
6076 FALSE);
6077 #endif
6078 if (f->async_visible == 0)
6079 {
6080 f->async_visible = 1;
6081 f->async_iconified = 0;
6082 f->output_data.x->has_been_visible = 1;
6083 SET_FRAME_GARBAGED (f);
6084 }
6085 else
6086 expose_frame (f,
6087 event.xexpose.x, event.xexpose.y,
6088 event.xexpose.width, event.xexpose.height);
6089 }
6090 else
6091 {
6092 #ifndef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
6093 struct scroll_bar *bar;
6094 #endif
6095 #if defined USE_LUCID
6096 /* Submenus of the Lucid menu bar aren't widgets
6097 themselves, so there's no way to dispatch events
6098 to them. Recognize this case separately. */
6099 {
6100 Widget widget
6101 = x_window_to_menu_bar (event.xexpose.window);
6102 if (widget)
6103 xlwmenu_redisplay (widget);
6104 }
6105 #endif /* USE_LUCID */
6106
6107 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
6108 /* Dispatch event to the widget. */
6109 goto OTHER;
6110 #else /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
6111 bar = x_window_to_scroll_bar (event.xexpose.display,
6112 event.xexpose.window);
6113
6114 if (bar)
6115 x_scroll_bar_expose (bar, &event);
6116 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
6117 else
6118 goto OTHER;
6119 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
6120 #endif /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
6121 }
6122 break;
6123
6124 case GraphicsExpose: /* This occurs when an XCopyArea's
6125 source area was obscured or not
6126 available. */
6127 f = x_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xgraphicsexpose.drawable);
6128 if (f)
6129 {
6130 expose_frame (f,
6131 event.xgraphicsexpose.x, event.xgraphicsexpose.y,
6132 event.xgraphicsexpose.width,
6133 event.xgraphicsexpose.height);
6134 }
6135 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
6136 else
6137 goto OTHER;
6138 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
6139 break;
6140
6141 case NoExpose: /* This occurs when an XCopyArea's
6142 source area was completely
6143 available. */
6144 break;
6145
6146 case UnmapNotify:
6147 /* Redo the mouse-highlight after the tooltip has gone. */
6148 if (event.xmap.window == tip_window)
6149 {
6150 tip_window = 0;
6151 redo_mouse_highlight ();
6152 }
6153
6154 f = x_top_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xunmap.window);
6155 if (f) /* F may no longer exist if
6156 the frame was deleted. */
6157 {
6158 /* While a frame is unmapped, display generation is
6159 disabled; you don't want to spend time updating a
6160 display that won't ever be seen. */
6161 f->async_visible = 0;
6162 /* We can't distinguish, from the event, whether the window
6163 has become iconified or invisible. So assume, if it
6164 was previously visible, than now it is iconified.
6165 But x_make_frame_invisible clears both
6166 the visible flag and the iconified flag;
6167 and that way, we know the window is not iconified now. */
6168 if (FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f) || FRAME_ICONIFIED_P (f))
6169 {
6170 f->async_iconified = 1;
6171
6172 inev.ie.kind = ICONIFY_EVENT;
6173 XSETFRAME (inev.ie.frame_or_window, f);
6174 }
6175 }
6176 goto OTHER;
6177
6178 case MapNotify:
6179 if (event.xmap.window == tip_window)
6180 /* The tooltip has been drawn already. Avoid
6181 the SET_FRAME_GARBAGED below. */
6182 goto OTHER;
6183
6184 /* We use x_top_window_to_frame because map events can
6185 come for sub-windows and they don't mean that the
6186 frame is visible. */
6187 f = x_top_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xmap.window);
6188 if (f)
6189 {
6190 /* wait_reading_process_output will notice this and update
6191 the frame's display structures.
6192 If we where iconified, we should not set garbaged,
6193 because that stops redrawing on Expose events. This looks
6194 bad if we are called from a recursive event loop
6195 (x_dispatch_event), for example when a dialog is up. */
6196 if (! f->async_iconified)
6197 SET_FRAME_GARBAGED (f);
6198
6199 /* Check if fullscreen was specified before we where mapped the
6200 first time, i.e. from the command line. */
6201 if (!f->output_data.x->has_been_visible)
6202 x_check_fullscreen (f);
6203
6204 f->async_visible = 1;
6205 f->async_iconified = 0;
6206 f->output_data.x->has_been_visible = 1;
6207
6208 if (f->iconified)
6209 {
6210 inev.ie.kind = DEICONIFY_EVENT;
6211 XSETFRAME (inev.ie.frame_or_window, f);
6212 }
6213 else if (! NILP (Vframe_list)
6214 && ! NILP (XCDR (Vframe_list)))
6215 /* Force a redisplay sooner or later
6216 to update the frame titles
6217 in case this is the second frame. */
6218 record_asynch_buffer_change ();
6219
6220 #ifdef USE_GTK
6221 xg_frame_resized (f, -1, -1);
6222 #endif
6223 }
6224 goto OTHER;
6225
6226 case KeyPress:
6227
6228 last_user_time = event.xkey.time;
6229 ignore_next_mouse_click_timeout = 0;
6230
6231 #if defined (USE_X_TOOLKIT) || defined (USE_GTK)
6232 /* Dispatch KeyPress events when in menu. */
6233 if (popup_activated ())
6234 goto OTHER;
6235 #endif
6236
6237 f = x_any_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xkey.window);
6238
6239 /* If mouse-highlight is an integer, input clears out
6240 mouse highlighting. */
6241 if (!hlinfo->mouse_face_hidden && INTEGERP (Vmouse_highlight)
6242 && (f == 0
6243 || !EQ (f->tool_bar_window, hlinfo->mouse_face_window)))
6244 {
6245 clear_mouse_face (hlinfo);
6246 hlinfo->mouse_face_hidden = 1;
6247 }
6248
6249 #if defined USE_MOTIF && defined USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
6250 if (f == 0)
6251 {
6252 /* Scroll bars consume key events, but we want
6253 the keys to go to the scroll bar's frame. */
6254 Widget widget = XtWindowToWidget (dpyinfo->display,
6255 event.xkey.window);
6256 if (widget && XmIsScrollBar (widget))
6257 {
6258 widget = XtParent (widget);
6259 f = x_any_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, XtWindow (widget));
6260 }
6261 }
6262 #endif /* USE_MOTIF and USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
6263
6264 if (f != 0)
6265 {
6266 KeySym keysym, orig_keysym;
6267 /* al%imercury@uunet.uu.net says that making this 81
6268 instead of 80 fixed a bug whereby meta chars made
6269 his Emacs hang.
6270
6271 It seems that some version of XmbLookupString has
6272 a bug of not returning XBufferOverflow in
6273 status_return even if the input is too long to
6274 fit in 81 bytes. So, we must prepare sufficient
6275 bytes for copy_buffer. 513 bytes (256 chars for
6276 two-byte character set) seems to be a fairly good
6277 approximation. -- 2000.8.10 handa@etl.go.jp */
6278 unsigned char copy_buffer[513];
6279 unsigned char *copy_bufptr = copy_buffer;
6280 int copy_bufsiz = sizeof (copy_buffer);
6281 int modifiers;
6282 Lisp_Object coding_system = Qlatin_1;
6283 Lisp_Object c;
6284
6285 #ifdef USE_GTK
6286 /* Don't pass keys to GTK. A Tab will shift focus to the
6287 tool bar in GTK 2.4. Keys will still go to menus and
6288 dialogs because in that case popup_activated is TRUE
6289 (see above). */
6290 *finish = X_EVENT_DROP;
6291 #endif
6292
6293 event.xkey.state
6294 |= x_emacs_to_x_modifiers (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f),
6295 extra_keyboard_modifiers);
6296 modifiers = event.xkey.state;
6297
6298 /* This will have to go some day... */
6299
6300 /* make_lispy_event turns chars into control chars.
6301 Don't do it here because XLookupString is too eager. */
6302 event.xkey.state &= ~ControlMask;
6303 event.xkey.state &= ~(dpyinfo->meta_mod_mask
6304 | dpyinfo->super_mod_mask
6305 | dpyinfo->hyper_mod_mask
6306 | dpyinfo->alt_mod_mask);
6307
6308 /* In case Meta is ComposeCharacter,
6309 clear its status. According to Markus Ehrnsperger
6310 Markus.Ehrnsperger@lehrstuhl-bross.physik.uni-muenchen.de
6311 this enables ComposeCharacter to work whether or
6312 not it is combined with Meta. */
6313 if (modifiers & dpyinfo->meta_mod_mask)
6314 memset (&compose_status, 0, sizeof (compose_status));
6315
6316 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
6317 if (FRAME_XIC (f))
6318 {
6319 Status status_return;
6320
6321 coding_system = Vlocale_coding_system;
6322 nbytes = XmbLookupString (FRAME_XIC (f),
6323 &event.xkey, copy_bufptr,
6324 copy_bufsiz, &keysym,
6325 &status_return);
6326 if (status_return == XBufferOverflow)
6327 {
6328 copy_bufsiz = nbytes + 1;
6329 copy_bufptr = (unsigned char *) alloca (copy_bufsiz);
6330 nbytes = XmbLookupString (FRAME_XIC (f),
6331 &event.xkey, copy_bufptr,
6332 copy_bufsiz, &keysym,
6333 &status_return);
6334 }
6335 /* Xutf8LookupString is a new but already deprecated interface. -stef */
6336 if (status_return == XLookupNone)
6337 break;
6338 else if (status_return == XLookupChars)
6339 {
6340 keysym = NoSymbol;
6341 modifiers = 0;
6342 }
6343 else if (status_return != XLookupKeySym
6344 && status_return != XLookupBoth)
6345 abort ();
6346 }
6347 else
6348 nbytes = XLookupString (&event.xkey, copy_bufptr,
6349 copy_bufsiz, &keysym,
6350 &compose_status);
6351 #else
6352 nbytes = XLookupString (&event.xkey, copy_bufptr,
6353 copy_bufsiz, &keysym,
6354 &compose_status);
6355 #endif
6356
6357 /* If not using XIM/XIC, and a compose sequence is in progress,
6358 we break here. Otherwise, chars_matched is always 0. */
6359 if (compose_status.chars_matched > 0 && nbytes == 0)
6360 break;
6361
6362 memset (&compose_status, 0, sizeof (compose_status));
6363 orig_keysym = keysym;
6364
6365 /* Common for all keysym input events. */
6366 XSETFRAME (inev.ie.frame_or_window, f);
6367 inev.ie.modifiers
6368 = x_x_to_emacs_modifiers (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f), modifiers);
6369 inev.ie.timestamp = event.xkey.time;
6370
6371 /* First deal with keysyms which have defined
6372 translations to characters. */
6373 if (keysym >= 32 && keysym < 128)
6374 /* Avoid explicitly decoding each ASCII character. */
6375 {
6376 inev.ie.kind = ASCII_KEYSTROKE_EVENT;
6377 inev.ie.code = keysym;
6378 goto done_keysym;
6379 }
6380
6381 /* Keysyms directly mapped to Unicode characters. */
6382 if (keysym >= 0x01000000 && keysym <= 0x0110FFFF)
6383 {
6384 if (keysym < 0x01000080)
6385 inev.ie.kind = ASCII_KEYSTROKE_EVENT;
6386 else
6387 inev.ie.kind = MULTIBYTE_CHAR_KEYSTROKE_EVENT;
6388 inev.ie.code = keysym & 0xFFFFFF;
6389 goto done_keysym;
6390 }
6391
6392 /* Now non-ASCII. */
6393 if (HASH_TABLE_P (Vx_keysym_table)
6394 && (NATNUMP (c = Fgethash (make_number (keysym),
6395 Vx_keysym_table,
6396 Qnil))))
6397 {
6398 inev.ie.kind = (SINGLE_BYTE_CHAR_P (XFASTINT (c))
6399 ? ASCII_KEYSTROKE_EVENT
6400 : MULTIBYTE_CHAR_KEYSTROKE_EVENT);
6401 inev.ie.code = XFASTINT (c);
6402 goto done_keysym;
6403 }
6404
6405 /* Random non-modifier sorts of keysyms. */
6406 if (((keysym >= XK_BackSpace && keysym <= XK_Escape)
6407 || keysym == XK_Delete
6408 #ifdef XK_ISO_Left_Tab
6409 || (keysym >= XK_ISO_Left_Tab
6410 && keysym <= XK_ISO_Enter)
6411 #endif
6412 || IsCursorKey (keysym) /* 0xff50 <= x < 0xff60 */
6413 || IsMiscFunctionKey (keysym) /* 0xff60 <= x < VARIES */
6414 #ifdef HPUX
6415 /* This recognizes the "extended function
6416 keys". It seems there's no cleaner way.
6417 Test IsModifierKey to avoid handling
6418 mode_switch incorrectly. */
6419 || ((unsigned) (keysym) >= XK_Select
6420 && (unsigned)(keysym) < XK_KP_Space)
6421 #endif
6422 #ifdef XK_dead_circumflex
6423 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_circumflex
6424 #endif
6425 #ifdef XK_dead_grave
6426 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_grave
6427 #endif
6428 #ifdef XK_dead_tilde
6429 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_tilde
6430 #endif
6431 #ifdef XK_dead_diaeresis
6432 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_diaeresis
6433 #endif
6434 #ifdef XK_dead_macron
6435 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_macron
6436 #endif
6437 #ifdef XK_dead_degree
6438 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_degree
6439 #endif
6440 #ifdef XK_dead_acute
6441 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_acute
6442 #endif
6443 #ifdef XK_dead_cedilla
6444 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_cedilla
6445 #endif
6446 #ifdef XK_dead_breve
6447 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_breve
6448 #endif
6449 #ifdef XK_dead_ogonek
6450 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_ogonek
6451 #endif
6452 #ifdef XK_dead_caron
6453 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_caron
6454 #endif
6455 #ifdef XK_dead_doubleacute
6456 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_doubleacute
6457 #endif
6458 #ifdef XK_dead_abovedot
6459 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_abovedot
6460 #endif
6461 || IsKeypadKey (keysym) /* 0xff80 <= x < 0xffbe */
6462 || IsFunctionKey (keysym) /* 0xffbe <= x < 0xffe1 */
6463 /* Any "vendor-specific" key is ok. */
6464 || (orig_keysym & (1 << 28))
6465 || (keysym != NoSymbol && nbytes == 0))
6466 && ! (IsModifierKey (orig_keysym)
6467 /* The symbols from XK_ISO_Lock
6468 to XK_ISO_Last_Group_Lock
6469 don't have real modifiers but
6470 should be treated similarly to
6471 Mode_switch by Emacs. */
6472 #if defined XK_ISO_Lock && defined XK_ISO_Last_Group_Lock
6473 || ((unsigned)(orig_keysym)
6474 >= XK_ISO_Lock
6475 && (unsigned)(orig_keysym)
6476 <= XK_ISO_Last_Group_Lock)
6477 #endif
6478 ))
6479 {
6480 STORE_KEYSYM_FOR_DEBUG (keysym);
6481 /* make_lispy_event will convert this to a symbolic
6482 key. */
6483 inev.ie.kind = NON_ASCII_KEYSTROKE_EVENT;
6484 inev.ie.code = keysym;
6485 goto done_keysym;
6486 }
6487
6488 { /* Raw bytes, not keysym. */
6489 register int i;
6490 register int c;
6491 int nchars, len;
6492
6493 for (i = 0, nchars = 0; i < nbytes; i++)
6494 {
6495 if (ASCII_BYTE_P (copy_bufptr[i]))
6496 nchars++;
6497 STORE_KEYSYM_FOR_DEBUG (copy_bufptr[i]);
6498 }
6499
6500 if (nchars < nbytes)
6501 {
6502 /* Decode the input data. */
6503 int require;
6504
6505 /* The input should be decoded with `coding_system'
6506 which depends on which X*LookupString function
6507 we used just above and the locale. */
6508 setup_coding_system (coding_system, &coding);
6509 coding.src_multibyte = 0;
6510 coding.dst_multibyte = 1;
6511 /* The input is converted to events, thus we can't
6512 handle composition. Anyway, there's no XIM that
6513 gives us composition information. */
6514 coding.common_flags &= ~CODING_ANNOTATION_MASK;
6515
6516 require = MAX_MULTIBYTE_LENGTH * nbytes;
6517 coding.destination = alloca (require);
6518 coding.dst_bytes = require;
6519 coding.mode |= CODING_MODE_LAST_BLOCK;
6520 decode_coding_c_string (&coding, copy_bufptr, nbytes, Qnil);
6521 nbytes = coding.produced;
6522 nchars = coding.produced_char;
6523 copy_bufptr = coding.destination;
6524 }
6525
6526 /* Convert the input data to a sequence of
6527 character events. */
6528 for (i = 0; i < nbytes; i += len)
6529 {
6530 if (nchars == nbytes)
6531 c = copy_bufptr[i], len = 1;
6532 else
6533 c = STRING_CHAR_AND_LENGTH (copy_bufptr + i, len);
6534 inev.ie.kind = (SINGLE_BYTE_CHAR_P (c)
6535 ? ASCII_KEYSTROKE_EVENT
6536 : MULTIBYTE_CHAR_KEYSTROKE_EVENT);
6537 inev.ie.code = c;
6538 kbd_buffer_store_event_hold (&inev.ie, hold_quit);
6539 }
6540
6541 count += nchars;
6542
6543 inev.ie.kind = NO_EVENT; /* Already stored above. */
6544
6545 if (keysym == NoSymbol)
6546 break;
6547 }
6548 }
6549 done_keysym:
6550 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
6551 /* Don't dispatch this event since XtDispatchEvent calls
6552 XFilterEvent, and two calls in a row may freeze the
6553 client. */
6554 break;
6555 #else
6556 goto OTHER;
6557 #endif
6558
6559 case KeyRelease:
6560 last_user_time = event.xkey.time;
6561 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
6562 /* Don't dispatch this event since XtDispatchEvent calls
6563 XFilterEvent, and two calls in a row may freeze the
6564 client. */
6565 break;
6566 #else
6567 goto OTHER;
6568 #endif
6569
6570 case EnterNotify:
6571 last_user_time = event.xcrossing.time;
6572 x_detect_focus_change (dpyinfo, &event, &inev.ie);
6573
6574 f = x_any_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xcrossing.window);
6575
6576 if (f && x_mouse_click_focus_ignore_position)
6577 ignore_next_mouse_click_timeout = event.xmotion.time + 200;
6578
6579 /* EnterNotify counts as mouse movement,
6580 so update things that depend on mouse position. */
6581 if (f && !f->output_data.x->hourglass_p)
6582 note_mouse_movement (f, &event.xmotion);
6583 #ifdef USE_GTK
6584 /* We may get an EnterNotify on the buttons in the toolbar. In that
6585 case we moved out of any highlighted area and need to note this. */
6586 if (!f && last_mouse_glyph_frame)
6587 note_mouse_movement (last_mouse_glyph_frame, &event.xmotion);
6588 #endif
6589 goto OTHER;
6590
6591 case FocusIn:
6592 x_detect_focus_change (dpyinfo, &event, &inev.ie);
6593 goto OTHER;
6594
6595 case LeaveNotify:
6596 last_user_time = event.xcrossing.time;
6597 x_detect_focus_change (dpyinfo, &event, &inev.ie);
6598
6599 f = x_top_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xcrossing.window);
6600 if (f)
6601 {
6602 if (f == hlinfo->mouse_face_mouse_frame)
6603 {
6604 /* If we move outside the frame, then we're
6605 certainly no longer on any text in the frame. */
6606 clear_mouse_face (hlinfo);
6607 hlinfo->mouse_face_mouse_frame = 0;
6608 }
6609
6610 /* Generate a nil HELP_EVENT to cancel a help-echo.
6611 Do it only if there's something to cancel.
6612 Otherwise, the startup message is cleared when
6613 the mouse leaves the frame. */
6614 if (any_help_event_p)
6615 do_help = -1;
6616 }
6617 #ifdef USE_GTK
6618 /* See comment in EnterNotify above */
6619 else if (last_mouse_glyph_frame)
6620 note_mouse_movement (last_mouse_glyph_frame, &event.xmotion);
6621 #endif
6622 goto OTHER;
6623
6624 case FocusOut:
6625 x_detect_focus_change (dpyinfo, &event, &inev.ie);
6626 goto OTHER;
6627
6628 case MotionNotify:
6629 {
6630 last_user_time = event.xmotion.time;
6631 previous_help_echo_string = help_echo_string;
6632 help_echo_string = Qnil;
6633
6634 if (dpyinfo->grabbed && last_mouse_frame
6635 && FRAME_LIVE_P (last_mouse_frame))
6636 f = last_mouse_frame;
6637 else
6638 f = x_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xmotion.window);
6639
6640 if (hlinfo->mouse_face_hidden)
6641 {
6642 hlinfo->mouse_face_hidden = 0;
6643 clear_mouse_face (hlinfo);
6644 }
6645
6646 #ifdef USE_GTK
6647 if (f && xg_event_is_for_scrollbar (f, &event))
6648 f = 0;
6649 #endif
6650 if (f)
6651 {
6652
6653 /* Generate SELECT_WINDOW_EVENTs when needed.
6654 Don't let popup menus influence things (bug#1261). */
6655 if (!NILP (Vmouse_autoselect_window) && !popup_activated ())
6656 {
6657 Lisp_Object window;
6658
6659 window = window_from_coordinates (f,
6660 event.xmotion.x, event.xmotion.y,
6661 0, 0);
6662
6663 /* Window will be selected only when it is not selected now and
6664 last mouse movement event was not in it. Minibuffer window
6665 will be selected only when it is active. */
6666 if (WINDOWP (window)
6667 && !EQ (window, last_window)
6668 && !EQ (window, selected_window)
6669 /* For click-to-focus window managers
6670 create event iff we don't leave the
6671 selected frame. */
6672 && (focus_follows_mouse
6673 || (EQ (XWINDOW (window)->frame,
6674 XWINDOW (selected_window)->frame))))
6675 {
6676 inev.ie.kind = SELECT_WINDOW_EVENT;
6677 inev.ie.frame_or_window = window;
6678 }
6679
6680 last_window=window;
6681 }
6682 if (!note_mouse_movement (f, &event.xmotion))
6683 help_echo_string = previous_help_echo_string;
6684 }
6685 else
6686 {
6687 #ifndef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
6688 struct scroll_bar *bar
6689 = x_window_to_scroll_bar (event.xmotion.display,
6690 event.xmotion.window);
6691
6692 if (bar)
6693 x_scroll_bar_note_movement (bar, &event);
6694 #endif /* USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
6695
6696 /* If we move outside the frame, then we're
6697 certainly no longer on any text in the frame. */
6698 clear_mouse_face (hlinfo);
6699 }
6700
6701 /* If the contents of the global variable help_echo_string
6702 has changed, generate a HELP_EVENT. */
6703 if (!NILP (help_echo_string)
6704 || !NILP (previous_help_echo_string))
6705 do_help = 1;
6706 goto OTHER;
6707 }
6708
6709 case ConfigureNotify:
6710 f = x_top_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xconfigure.window);
6711 #ifdef USE_GTK
6712 if (!f
6713 && (f = x_any_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xconfigure.window))
6714 && event.xconfigure.window == FRAME_X_WINDOW (f))
6715 {
6716 xg_frame_resized (f, event.xconfigure.width,
6717 event.xconfigure.height);
6718 f = 0;
6719 }
6720 #endif
6721 if (f)
6722 {
6723 #ifndef USE_X_TOOLKIT
6724 #ifndef USE_GTK
6725 int rows = FRAME_PIXEL_HEIGHT_TO_TEXT_LINES (f, event.xconfigure.height);
6726 int columns = FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH_TO_TEXT_COLS (f, event.xconfigure.width);
6727
6728 /* In the toolkit version, change_frame_size
6729 is called by the code that handles resizing
6730 of the EmacsFrame widget. */
6731
6732 /* Even if the number of character rows and columns has
6733 not changed, the font size may have changed, so we need
6734 to check the pixel dimensions as well. */
6735 if (columns != FRAME_COLS (f)
6736 || rows != FRAME_LINES (f)
6737 || event.xconfigure.width != FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f)
6738 || event.xconfigure.height != FRAME_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f))
6739 {
6740 change_frame_size (f, rows, columns, 0, 1, 0);
6741 SET_FRAME_GARBAGED (f);
6742 cancel_mouse_face (f);
6743 }
6744
6745 FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f) = event.xconfigure.width;
6746 FRAME_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f) = event.xconfigure.height;
6747 #endif /* not USE_GTK */
6748 #endif
6749
6750 #ifdef USE_GTK
6751 /* GTK creates windows but doesn't map them.
6752 Only get real positions when mapped. */
6753 if (FRAME_GTK_OUTER_WIDGET (f)
6754 && gtk_widget_get_mapped (FRAME_GTK_OUTER_WIDGET (f)))
6755 #endif
6756 {
6757 x_real_positions (f, &f->left_pos, &f->top_pos);
6758 }
6759
6760 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
6761 if (FRAME_XIC (f) && (FRAME_XIC_STYLE (f) & XIMStatusArea))
6762 xic_set_statusarea (f);
6763 #endif
6764
6765 }
6766 goto OTHER;
6767
6768 case ButtonRelease:
6769 case ButtonPress:
6770 {
6771 /* If we decide we want to generate an event to be seen
6772 by the rest of Emacs, we put it here. */
6773 int tool_bar_p = 0;
6774
6775 memset (&compose_status, 0, sizeof (compose_status));
6776 last_mouse_glyph_frame = 0;
6777 last_user_time = event.xbutton.time;
6778
6779 if (dpyinfo->grabbed
6780 && last_mouse_frame
6781 && FRAME_LIVE_P (last_mouse_frame))
6782 f = last_mouse_frame;
6783 else
6784 f = x_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xbutton.window);
6785
6786 #ifdef USE_GTK
6787 if (f && xg_event_is_for_scrollbar (f, &event))
6788 f = 0;
6789 #endif
6790 if (f)
6791 {
6792 /* Is this in the tool-bar? */
6793 if (WINDOWP (f->tool_bar_window)
6794 && WINDOW_TOTAL_LINES (XWINDOW (f->tool_bar_window)))
6795 {
6796 Lisp_Object window;
6797 int x = event.xbutton.x;
6798 int y = event.xbutton.y;
6799
6800 window = window_from_coordinates (f, x, y, 0, 1);
6801 tool_bar_p = EQ (window, f->tool_bar_window);
6802
6803 if (tool_bar_p && event.xbutton.button < 4)
6804 {
6805 handle_tool_bar_click (f, x, y,
6806 event.xbutton.type == ButtonPress,
6807 x_x_to_emacs_modifiers (dpyinfo,
6808 event.xbutton.state));
6809 }
6810 }
6811
6812 if (!tool_bar_p)
6813 #if defined (USE_X_TOOLKIT) || defined (USE_GTK)
6814 if (! popup_activated ())
6815 #endif
6816 {
6817 if (ignore_next_mouse_click_timeout)
6818 {
6819 if (event.type == ButtonPress
6820 && (int)(event.xbutton.time - ignore_next_mouse_click_timeout) > 0)
6821 {
6822 ignore_next_mouse_click_timeout = 0;
6823 construct_mouse_click (&inev.ie, &event.xbutton, f);
6824 }
6825 if (event.type == ButtonRelease)
6826 ignore_next_mouse_click_timeout = 0;
6827 }
6828 else
6829 construct_mouse_click (&inev.ie, &event.xbutton, f);
6830 }
6831 if (FRAME_X_EMBEDDED_P (f))
6832 xembed_send_message (f, event.xbutton.time,
6833 XEMBED_REQUEST_FOCUS, 0, 0, 0);
6834 }
6835 else
6836 {
6837 struct scroll_bar *bar
6838 = x_window_to_scroll_bar (event.xbutton.display,
6839 event.xbutton.window);
6840
6841 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
6842 /* Make the "Ctrl-Mouse-2 splits window" work for toolkit
6843 scroll bars. */
6844 if (bar && event.xbutton.state & ControlMask)
6845 {
6846 x_scroll_bar_handle_click (bar, &event, &inev.ie);
6847 *finish = X_EVENT_DROP;
6848 }
6849 #else /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
6850 if (bar)
6851 x_scroll_bar_handle_click (bar, &event, &inev.ie);
6852 #endif /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
6853 }
6854
6855 if (event.type == ButtonPress)
6856 {
6857 dpyinfo->grabbed |= (1 << event.xbutton.button);
6858 last_mouse_frame = f;
6859
6860 if (!tool_bar_p)
6861 last_tool_bar_item = -1;
6862 }
6863 else
6864 dpyinfo->grabbed &= ~(1 << event.xbutton.button);
6865
6866 /* Ignore any mouse motion that happened before this event;
6867 any subsequent mouse-movement Emacs events should reflect
6868 only motion after the ButtonPress/Release. */
6869 if (f != 0)
6870 f->mouse_moved = 0;
6871
6872 #if defined (USE_X_TOOLKIT) || defined (USE_GTK)
6873 f = x_menubar_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, &event);
6874 /* For a down-event in the menu bar,
6875 don't pass it to Xt right now.
6876 Instead, save it away
6877 and we will pass it to Xt from kbd_buffer_get_event.
6878 That way, we can run some Lisp code first. */
6879 if (! popup_activated ()
6880 #ifdef USE_GTK
6881 /* Gtk+ menus only react to the first three buttons. */
6882 && event.xbutton.button < 3
6883 #endif
6884 && f && event.type == ButtonPress
6885 /* Verify the event is really within the menu bar
6886 and not just sent to it due to grabbing. */
6887 && event.xbutton.x >= 0
6888 && event.xbutton.x < FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f)
6889 && event.xbutton.y >= 0
6890 && event.xbutton.y < f->output_data.x->menubar_height
6891 && event.xbutton.same_screen)
6892 {
6893 SET_SAVED_BUTTON_EVENT;
6894 XSETFRAME (last_mouse_press_frame, f);
6895 *finish = X_EVENT_DROP;
6896 }
6897 else if (event.type == ButtonPress)
6898 {
6899 last_mouse_press_frame = Qnil;
6900 goto OTHER;
6901 }
6902 else
6903 goto OTHER;
6904 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT || USE_GTK */
6905 }
6906 break;
6907
6908 case CirculateNotify:
6909 goto OTHER;
6910
6911 case CirculateRequest:
6912 goto OTHER;
6913
6914 case VisibilityNotify:
6915 goto OTHER;
6916
6917 case MappingNotify:
6918 /* Someone has changed the keyboard mapping - update the
6919 local cache. */
6920 switch (event.xmapping.request)
6921 {
6922 case MappingModifier:
6923 x_find_modifier_meanings (dpyinfo);
6924 /* This is meant to fall through. */
6925 case MappingKeyboard:
6926 XRefreshKeyboardMapping (&event.xmapping);
6927 }
6928 goto OTHER;
6929
6930 case DestroyNotify:
6931 xft_settings_event (dpyinfo, &event);
6932 break;
6933
6934 default:
6935 OTHER:
6936 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
6937 BLOCK_INPUT;
6938 if (*finish != X_EVENT_DROP)
6939 XtDispatchEvent (&event);
6940 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
6941 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
6942 break;
6943 }
6944
6945 done:
6946 if (inev.ie.kind != NO_EVENT)
6947 {
6948 kbd_buffer_store_event_hold (&inev.ie, hold_quit);
6949 count++;
6950 }
6951
6952 if (do_help
6953 && !(hold_quit && hold_quit->kind != NO_EVENT))
6954 {
6955 Lisp_Object frame;
6956
6957 if (f)
6958 XSETFRAME (frame, f);
6959 else
6960 frame = Qnil;
6961
6962 if (do_help > 0)
6963 {
6964 any_help_event_p = 1;
6965 gen_help_event (help_echo_string, frame, help_echo_window,
6966 help_echo_object, help_echo_pos);
6967 }
6968 else
6969 {
6970 help_echo_string = Qnil;
6971 gen_help_event (Qnil, frame, Qnil, Qnil, 0);
6972 }
6973 count++;
6974 }
6975
6976 *eventp = event;
6977 return count;
6978 }
6979
6980
6981 /* Handles the XEvent EVENT on display DISPLAY.
6982 This is used for event loops outside the normal event handling,
6983 i.e. looping while a popup menu or a dialog is posted.
6984
6985 Returns the value handle_one_xevent sets in the finish argument. */
6986 int
6987 x_dispatch_event (XEvent *event, Display *display)
6988 {
6989 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
6990 int finish = X_EVENT_NORMAL;
6991
6992 dpyinfo = x_display_info_for_display (display);
6993
6994 if (dpyinfo)
6995 handle_one_xevent (dpyinfo, event, &finish, 0);
6996
6997 return finish;
6998 }
6999
7000
7001 /* Read events coming from the X server.
7002 This routine is called by the SIGIO handler.
7003 We return as soon as there are no more events to be read.
7004
7005 We return the number of characters stored into the buffer,
7006 thus pretending to be `read' (except the characters we store
7007 in the keyboard buffer can be multibyte, so are not necessarily
7008 C chars).
7009
7010 EXPECTED is nonzero if the caller knows input is available. */
7011
7012 static int
7013 XTread_socket (struct terminal *terminal, int expected, struct input_event *hold_quit)
7014 {
7015 int count = 0;
7016 XEvent event;
7017 int event_found = 0;
7018
7019 if (interrupt_input_blocked)
7020 {
7021 interrupt_input_pending = 1;
7022 #ifdef SYNC_INPUT
7023 pending_signals = 1;
7024 #endif
7025 return -1;
7026 }
7027
7028 interrupt_input_pending = 0;
7029 #ifdef SYNC_INPUT
7030 pending_signals = pending_atimers;
7031 #endif
7032 BLOCK_INPUT;
7033
7034 /* So people can tell when we have read the available input. */
7035 input_signal_count++;
7036
7037 ++handling_signal;
7038
7039 #ifdef HAVE_X_SM
7040 /* Only check session manager input for the primary display. */
7041 if (terminal->id == 1 && x_session_have_connection ())
7042 {
7043 struct input_event inev;
7044 BLOCK_INPUT;
7045 /* We don't need to EVENT_INIT (inev) here, as
7046 x_session_check_input copies an entire input_event. */
7047 if (x_session_check_input (&inev))
7048 {
7049 kbd_buffer_store_event_hold (&inev, hold_quit);
7050 count++;
7051 }
7052 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
7053 }
7054 #endif
7055
7056 /* For debugging, this gives a way to fake an I/O error. */
7057 if (terminal->display_info.x == XTread_socket_fake_io_error)
7058 {
7059 XTread_socket_fake_io_error = 0;
7060 x_io_error_quitter (terminal->display_info.x->display);
7061 }
7062
7063 #ifndef USE_GTK
7064 while (XPending (terminal->display_info.x->display))
7065 {
7066 int finish;
7067
7068 XNextEvent (terminal->display_info.x->display, &event);
7069
7070 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
7071 /* Filter events for the current X input method. */
7072 if (x_filter_event (terminal->display_info.x, &event))
7073 continue;
7074 #endif
7075 event_found = 1;
7076
7077 count += handle_one_xevent (terminal->display_info.x,
7078 &event, &finish, hold_quit);
7079
7080 if (finish == X_EVENT_GOTO_OUT)
7081 goto out;
7082 }
7083
7084 #else /* USE_GTK */
7085
7086 /* For GTK we must use the GTK event loop. But XEvents gets passed
7087 to our filter function above, and then to the big event switch.
7088 We use a bunch of globals to communicate with our filter function,
7089 that is kind of ugly, but it works.
7090
7091 There is no way to do one display at the time, GTK just does events
7092 from all displays. */
7093
7094 while (gtk_events_pending ())
7095 {
7096 current_count = count;
7097 current_hold_quit = hold_quit;
7098
7099 gtk_main_iteration ();
7100
7101 count = current_count;
7102 current_count = -1;
7103 current_hold_quit = 0;
7104
7105 if (current_finish == X_EVENT_GOTO_OUT)
7106 break;
7107 }
7108 #endif /* USE_GTK */
7109
7110 out:;
7111
7112 /* On some systems, an X bug causes Emacs to get no more events
7113 when the window is destroyed. Detect that. (1994.) */
7114 if (! event_found)
7115 {
7116 /* Emacs and the X Server eats up CPU time if XNoOp is done every time.
7117 One XNOOP in 100 loops will make Emacs terminate.
7118 B. Bretthauer, 1994 */
7119 x_noop_count++;
7120 if (x_noop_count >= 100)
7121 {
7122 x_noop_count=0;
7123
7124 if (next_noop_dpyinfo == 0)
7125 next_noop_dpyinfo = x_display_list;
7126
7127 XNoOp (next_noop_dpyinfo->display);
7128
7129 /* Each time we get here, cycle through the displays now open. */
7130 next_noop_dpyinfo = next_noop_dpyinfo->next;
7131 }
7132 }
7133
7134 /* If the focus was just given to an auto-raising frame,
7135 raise it now. */
7136 /* ??? This ought to be able to handle more than one such frame. */
7137 if (pending_autoraise_frame)
7138 {
7139 x_raise_frame (pending_autoraise_frame);
7140 pending_autoraise_frame = 0;
7141 }
7142
7143 --handling_signal;
7144 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
7145
7146 return count;
7147 }
7148
7149
7150
7151 \f
7152 /***********************************************************************
7153 Text Cursor
7154 ***********************************************************************/
7155
7156 /* Set clipping for output in glyph row ROW. W is the window in which
7157 we operate. GC is the graphics context to set clipping in.
7158
7159 ROW may be a text row or, e.g., a mode line. Text rows must be
7160 clipped to the interior of the window dedicated to text display,
7161 mode lines must be clipped to the whole window. */
7162
7163 static void
7164 x_clip_to_row (struct window *w, struct glyph_row *row, int area, GC gc)
7165 {
7166 struct frame *f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (w));
7167 XRectangle clip_rect;
7168 int window_x, window_y, window_width;
7169
7170 window_box (w, area, &window_x, &window_y, &window_width, 0);
7171
7172 clip_rect.x = window_x;
7173 clip_rect.y = WINDOW_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_Y (w, max (0, row->y));
7174 clip_rect.y = max (clip_rect.y, window_y);
7175 clip_rect.width = window_width;
7176 clip_rect.height = row->visible_height;
7177
7178 XSetClipRectangles (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), gc, 0, 0, &clip_rect, 1, Unsorted);
7179 }
7180
7181
7182 /* Draw a hollow box cursor on window W in glyph row ROW. */
7183
7184 static void
7185 x_draw_hollow_cursor (struct window *w, struct glyph_row *row)
7186 {
7187 struct frame *f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (w));
7188 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
7189 Display *dpy = FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f);
7190 int x, y, wd, h;
7191 XGCValues xgcv;
7192 struct glyph *cursor_glyph;
7193 GC gc;
7194
7195 /* Get the glyph the cursor is on. If we can't tell because
7196 the current matrix is invalid or such, give up. */
7197 cursor_glyph = get_phys_cursor_glyph (w);
7198 if (cursor_glyph == NULL)
7199 return;
7200
7201 /* Compute frame-relative coordinates for phys cursor. */
7202 get_phys_cursor_geometry (w, row, cursor_glyph, &x, &y, &h);
7203 wd = w->phys_cursor_width;
7204
7205 /* The foreground of cursor_gc is typically the same as the normal
7206 background color, which can cause the cursor box to be invisible. */
7207 xgcv.foreground = f->output_data.x->cursor_pixel;
7208 if (dpyinfo->scratch_cursor_gc)
7209 XChangeGC (dpy, dpyinfo->scratch_cursor_gc, GCForeground, &xgcv);
7210 else
7211 dpyinfo->scratch_cursor_gc = XCreateGC (dpy, FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
7212 GCForeground, &xgcv);
7213 gc = dpyinfo->scratch_cursor_gc;
7214
7215 /* Set clipping, draw the rectangle, and reset clipping again. */
7216 x_clip_to_row (w, row, TEXT_AREA, gc);
7217 XDrawRectangle (dpy, FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), gc, x, y, wd, h - 1);
7218 XSetClipMask (dpy, gc, None);
7219 }
7220
7221
7222 /* Draw a bar cursor on window W in glyph row ROW.
7223
7224 Implementation note: One would like to draw a bar cursor with an
7225 angle equal to the one given by the font property XA_ITALIC_ANGLE.
7226 Unfortunately, I didn't find a font yet that has this property set.
7227 --gerd. */
7228
7229 static void
7230 x_draw_bar_cursor (struct window *w, struct glyph_row *row, int width, enum text_cursor_kinds kind)
7231 {
7232 struct frame *f = XFRAME (w->frame);
7233 struct glyph *cursor_glyph;
7234
7235 /* If cursor is out of bounds, don't draw garbage. This can happen
7236 in mini-buffer windows when switching between echo area glyphs
7237 and mini-buffer. */
7238 cursor_glyph = get_phys_cursor_glyph (w);
7239 if (cursor_glyph == NULL)
7240 return;
7241
7242 /* If on an image, draw like a normal cursor. That's usually better
7243 visible than drawing a bar, esp. if the image is large so that
7244 the bar might not be in the window. */
7245 if (cursor_glyph->type == IMAGE_GLYPH)
7246 {
7247 struct glyph_row *row;
7248 row = MATRIX_ROW (w->current_matrix, w->phys_cursor.vpos);
7249 draw_phys_cursor_glyph (w, row, DRAW_CURSOR);
7250 }
7251 else
7252 {
7253 Display *dpy = FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f);
7254 Window window = FRAME_X_WINDOW (f);
7255 GC gc = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->scratch_cursor_gc;
7256 unsigned long mask = GCForeground | GCBackground | GCGraphicsExposures;
7257 struct face *face = FACE_FROM_ID (f, cursor_glyph->face_id);
7258 XGCValues xgcv;
7259
7260 /* If the glyph's background equals the color we normally draw
7261 the bars cursor in, the bar cursor in its normal color is
7262 invisible. Use the glyph's foreground color instead in this
7263 case, on the assumption that the glyph's colors are chosen so
7264 that the glyph is legible. */
7265 if (face->background == f->output_data.x->cursor_pixel)
7266 xgcv.background = xgcv.foreground = face->foreground;
7267 else
7268 xgcv.background = xgcv.foreground = f->output_data.x->cursor_pixel;
7269 xgcv.graphics_exposures = 0;
7270
7271 if (gc)
7272 XChangeGC (dpy, gc, mask, &xgcv);
7273 else
7274 {
7275 gc = XCreateGC (dpy, window, mask, &xgcv);
7276 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->scratch_cursor_gc = gc;
7277 }
7278
7279 x_clip_to_row (w, row, TEXT_AREA, gc);
7280
7281 if (kind == BAR_CURSOR)
7282 {
7283 int x = WINDOW_TEXT_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_X (w, w->phys_cursor.x);
7284
7285 if (width < 0)
7286 width = FRAME_CURSOR_WIDTH (f);
7287 width = min (cursor_glyph->pixel_width, width);
7288
7289 w->phys_cursor_width = width;
7290
7291 /* If the character under cursor is R2L, draw the bar cursor
7292 on the right of its glyph, rather than on the left. */
7293 if ((cursor_glyph->resolved_level & 1) != 0)
7294 x += cursor_glyph->pixel_width - width;
7295
7296 XFillRectangle (dpy, window, gc, x,
7297 WINDOW_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_Y (w, w->phys_cursor.y),
7298 width, row->height);
7299 }
7300 else
7301 {
7302 int dummy_x, dummy_y, dummy_h;
7303
7304 if (width < 0)
7305 width = row->height;
7306
7307 width = min (row->height, width);
7308
7309 get_phys_cursor_geometry (w, row, cursor_glyph, &dummy_x,
7310 &dummy_y, &dummy_h);
7311
7312 XFillRectangle (dpy, window, gc,
7313 WINDOW_TEXT_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_X (w, w->phys_cursor.x),
7314 WINDOW_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_Y (w, w->phys_cursor.y +
7315 row->height - width),
7316 w->phys_cursor_width, width);
7317 }
7318
7319 XSetClipMask (dpy, gc, None);
7320 }
7321 }
7322
7323
7324 /* RIF: Define cursor CURSOR on frame F. */
7325
7326 static void
7327 x_define_frame_cursor (struct frame *f, Cursor cursor)
7328 {
7329 if (!f->pointer_invisible
7330 && f->output_data.x->current_cursor != cursor)
7331 XDefineCursor (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), cursor);
7332 f->output_data.x->current_cursor = cursor;
7333 }
7334
7335
7336 /* RIF: Clear area on frame F. */
7337
7338 static void
7339 x_clear_frame_area (struct frame *f, int x, int y, int width, int height)
7340 {
7341 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
7342 x, y, width, height, False);
7343 #ifdef USE_GTK
7344 /* Must queue a redraw, because scroll bars might have been cleared. */
7345 if (FRAME_GTK_WIDGET (f))
7346 gtk_widget_queue_draw (FRAME_GTK_WIDGET (f));
7347 #endif
7348 }
7349
7350
7351 /* RIF: Draw cursor on window W. */
7352
7353 static void
7354 x_draw_window_cursor (struct window *w, struct glyph_row *glyph_row, int x, int y, int cursor_type, int cursor_width, int on_p, int active_p)
7355 {
7356 struct frame *f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (w));
7357
7358 if (on_p)
7359 {
7360 w->phys_cursor_type = cursor_type;
7361 w->phys_cursor_on_p = 1;
7362
7363 if (glyph_row->exact_window_width_line_p
7364 && (glyph_row->reversed_p
7365 ? (w->phys_cursor.hpos < 0)
7366 : (w->phys_cursor.hpos >= glyph_row->used[TEXT_AREA])))
7367 {
7368 glyph_row->cursor_in_fringe_p = 1;
7369 draw_fringe_bitmap (w, glyph_row, glyph_row->reversed_p);
7370 }
7371 else
7372 {
7373 switch (cursor_type)
7374 {
7375 case HOLLOW_BOX_CURSOR:
7376 x_draw_hollow_cursor (w, glyph_row);
7377 break;
7378
7379 case FILLED_BOX_CURSOR:
7380 draw_phys_cursor_glyph (w, glyph_row, DRAW_CURSOR);
7381 break;
7382
7383 case BAR_CURSOR:
7384 x_draw_bar_cursor (w, glyph_row, cursor_width, BAR_CURSOR);
7385 break;
7386
7387 case HBAR_CURSOR:
7388 x_draw_bar_cursor (w, glyph_row, cursor_width, HBAR_CURSOR);
7389 break;
7390
7391 case NO_CURSOR:
7392 w->phys_cursor_width = 0;
7393 break;
7394
7395 default:
7396 abort ();
7397 }
7398 }
7399
7400 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
7401 if (w == XWINDOW (f->selected_window))
7402 if (FRAME_XIC (f) && (FRAME_XIC_STYLE (f) & XIMPreeditPosition))
7403 xic_set_preeditarea (w, x, y);
7404 #endif
7405 }
7406
7407 #ifndef XFlush
7408 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
7409 #endif
7410 }
7411
7412 \f
7413 /* Icons. */
7414
7415 /* Make the x-window of frame F use the gnu icon bitmap. */
7416
7417 int
7418 x_bitmap_icon (struct frame *f, Lisp_Object file)
7419 {
7420 int bitmap_id;
7421
7422 if (FRAME_X_WINDOW (f) == 0)
7423 return 1;
7424
7425 /* Free up our existing icon bitmap and mask if any. */
7426 if (f->output_data.x->icon_bitmap > 0)
7427 x_destroy_bitmap (f, f->output_data.x->icon_bitmap);
7428 f->output_data.x->icon_bitmap = 0;
7429
7430 if (STRINGP (file))
7431 {
7432 #ifdef USE_GTK
7433 /* Use gtk_window_set_icon_from_file () if available,
7434 It's not restricted to bitmaps */
7435 if (xg_set_icon (f, file))
7436 return 0;
7437 #endif /* USE_GTK */
7438 bitmap_id = x_create_bitmap_from_file (f, file);
7439 x_create_bitmap_mask (f, bitmap_id);
7440 }
7441 else
7442 {
7443 /* Create the GNU bitmap and mask if necessary. */
7444 if (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->icon_bitmap_id < 0)
7445 {
7446 int rc = -1;
7447
7448 #ifdef USE_GTK
7449
7450 if (xg_set_icon (f, xg_default_icon_file)
7451 || xg_set_icon_from_xpm_data (f, gnu_xpm_bits))
7452 return 0;
7453
7454 #elif defined (HAVE_XPM) && defined (HAVE_X_WINDOWS)
7455
7456 rc = x_create_bitmap_from_xpm_data (f, gnu_xpm_bits);
7457 if (rc != -1)
7458 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->icon_bitmap_id = rc;
7459
7460 #endif
7461
7462 /* If all else fails, use the (black and white) xbm image. */
7463 if (rc == -1)
7464 {
7465 rc = x_create_bitmap_from_data (f, gnu_xbm_bits,
7466 gnu_xbm_width, gnu_xbm_height);
7467 if (rc == -1)
7468 return 1;
7469
7470 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->icon_bitmap_id = rc;
7471 x_create_bitmap_mask (f, FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->icon_bitmap_id);
7472 }
7473 }
7474
7475 /* The first time we create the GNU bitmap and mask,
7476 this increments the ref-count one extra time.
7477 As a result, the GNU bitmap and mask are never freed.
7478 That way, we don't have to worry about allocating it again. */
7479 x_reference_bitmap (f, FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->icon_bitmap_id);
7480
7481 bitmap_id = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->icon_bitmap_id;
7482 }
7483
7484 x_wm_set_icon_pixmap (f, bitmap_id);
7485 f->output_data.x->icon_bitmap = bitmap_id;
7486
7487 return 0;
7488 }
7489
7490
7491 /* Make the x-window of frame F use a rectangle with text.
7492 Use ICON_NAME as the text. */
7493
7494 int
7495 x_text_icon (struct frame *f, const char *icon_name)
7496 {
7497 if (FRAME_X_WINDOW (f) == 0)
7498 return 1;
7499
7500 {
7501 XTextProperty text;
7502 text.value = (unsigned char *) icon_name;
7503 text.encoding = XA_STRING;
7504 text.format = 8;
7505 text.nitems = strlen (icon_name);
7506 XSetWMIconName (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f), &text);
7507 }
7508
7509 if (f->output_data.x->icon_bitmap > 0)
7510 x_destroy_bitmap (f, f->output_data.x->icon_bitmap);
7511 f->output_data.x->icon_bitmap = 0;
7512 x_wm_set_icon_pixmap (f, 0);
7513
7514 return 0;
7515 }
7516 \f
7517 #define X_ERROR_MESSAGE_SIZE 200
7518
7519 /* If non-nil, this should be a string.
7520 It means catch X errors and store the error message in this string.
7521
7522 The reason we use a stack is that x_catch_error/x_uncatch_error can
7523 be called from a signal handler.
7524 */
7525
7526 struct x_error_message_stack {
7527 char string[X_ERROR_MESSAGE_SIZE];
7528 Display *dpy;
7529 struct x_error_message_stack *prev;
7530 };
7531 static struct x_error_message_stack *x_error_message;
7532
7533 /* An X error handler which stores the error message in
7534 *x_error_message. This is called from x_error_handler if
7535 x_catch_errors is in effect. */
7536
7537 static void
7538 x_error_catcher (Display *display, XErrorEvent *error)
7539 {
7540 XGetErrorText (display, error->error_code,
7541 x_error_message->string,
7542 X_ERROR_MESSAGE_SIZE);
7543 }
7544
7545 /* Begin trapping X errors for display DPY. Actually we trap X errors
7546 for all displays, but DPY should be the display you are actually
7547 operating on.
7548
7549 After calling this function, X protocol errors no longer cause
7550 Emacs to exit; instead, they are recorded in the string
7551 stored in *x_error_message.
7552
7553 Calling x_check_errors signals an Emacs error if an X error has
7554 occurred since the last call to x_catch_errors or x_check_errors.
7555
7556 Calling x_uncatch_errors resumes the normal error handling. */
7557
7558 void x_check_errors (Display *dpy, const char *format);
7559
7560 void
7561 x_catch_errors (Display *dpy)
7562 {
7563 struct x_error_message_stack *data = xmalloc (sizeof (*data));
7564
7565 /* Make sure any errors from previous requests have been dealt with. */
7566 XSync (dpy, False);
7567
7568 data->dpy = dpy;
7569 data->string[0] = 0;
7570 data->prev = x_error_message;
7571 x_error_message = data;
7572 }
7573
7574 /* Undo the last x_catch_errors call.
7575 DPY should be the display that was passed to x_catch_errors. */
7576
7577 void
7578 x_uncatch_errors (void)
7579 {
7580 struct x_error_message_stack *tmp;
7581
7582 BLOCK_INPUT;
7583
7584 /* The display may have been closed before this function is called.
7585 Check if it is still open before calling XSync. */
7586 if (x_display_info_for_display (x_error_message->dpy) != 0)
7587 XSync (x_error_message->dpy, False);
7588
7589 tmp = x_error_message;
7590 x_error_message = x_error_message->prev;
7591 xfree (tmp);
7592 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
7593 }
7594
7595 /* If any X protocol errors have arrived since the last call to
7596 x_catch_errors or x_check_errors, signal an Emacs error using
7597 sprintf (a buffer, FORMAT, the x error message text) as the text. */
7598
7599 void
7600 x_check_errors (Display *dpy, const char *format)
7601 {
7602 /* Make sure to catch any errors incurred so far. */
7603 XSync (dpy, False);
7604
7605 if (x_error_message->string[0])
7606 {
7607 char string[X_ERROR_MESSAGE_SIZE];
7608 memcpy (string, x_error_message->string, X_ERROR_MESSAGE_SIZE);
7609 x_uncatch_errors ();
7610 error (format, string);
7611 }
7612 }
7613
7614 /* Nonzero if we had any X protocol errors
7615 since we did x_catch_errors on DPY. */
7616
7617 int
7618 x_had_errors_p (Display *dpy)
7619 {
7620 /* Make sure to catch any errors incurred so far. */
7621 XSync (dpy, False);
7622
7623 return x_error_message->string[0] != 0;
7624 }
7625
7626 /* Forget about any errors we have had, since we did x_catch_errors on DPY. */
7627
7628 void
7629 x_clear_errors (Display *dpy)
7630 {
7631 x_error_message->string[0] = 0;
7632 }
7633
7634 #if 0 /* See comment in unwind_to_catch why calling this is a bad
7635 * idea. --lorentey */
7636 /* Close off all unclosed x_catch_errors calls. */
7637
7638 void
7639 x_fully_uncatch_errors (void)
7640 {
7641 while (x_error_message)
7642 x_uncatch_errors ();
7643 }
7644 #endif
7645
7646 /* Nonzero if x_catch_errors has been done and not yet canceled. */
7647
7648 int
7649 x_catching_errors (void)
7650 {
7651 return x_error_message != 0;
7652 }
7653
7654 #if 0
7655 static unsigned int x_wire_count;
7656 x_trace_wire (void)
7657 {
7658 fprintf (stderr, "Lib call: %d\n", ++x_wire_count);
7659 }
7660 #endif /* ! 0 */
7661
7662 \f
7663 /* Handle SIGPIPE, which can happen when the connection to a server
7664 simply goes away. SIGPIPE is handled by x_connection_signal.
7665 Don't need to do anything, because the write which caused the
7666 SIGPIPE will fail, causing Xlib to invoke the X IO error handler,
7667 which will do the appropriate cleanup for us. */
7668
7669 static SIGTYPE
7670 x_connection_signal (int signalnum) /* If we don't have an argument, */
7671 /* some compilers complain in signal calls. */
7672 {
7673 #ifdef USG
7674 /* USG systems forget handlers when they are used;
7675 must reestablish each time */
7676 signal (signalnum, x_connection_signal);
7677 #endif /* USG */
7678 }
7679
7680 \f
7681 /************************************************************************
7682 Handling X errors
7683 ************************************************************************/
7684
7685 /* Error message passed to x_connection_closed. */
7686
7687 static char *error_msg;
7688
7689 /* Function installed as fatal_error_signal_hook in
7690 x_connection_closed. Print the X error message, and exit normally,
7691 instead of dumping core when XtCloseDisplay fails. */
7692
7693 static void
7694 x_fatal_error_signal (void)
7695 {
7696 fprintf (stderr, "%s\n", error_msg);
7697 exit (70);
7698 }
7699
7700 /* Handle the loss of connection to display DPY. ERROR_MESSAGE is
7701 the text of an error message that lead to the connection loss. */
7702
7703 static SIGTYPE
7704 x_connection_closed (Display *dpy, const char *error_message)
7705 {
7706 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = x_display_info_for_display (dpy);
7707 Lisp_Object frame, tail;
7708 int index = SPECPDL_INDEX ();
7709
7710 error_msg = (char *) alloca (strlen (error_message) + 1);
7711 strcpy (error_msg, error_message);
7712 handling_signal = 0;
7713
7714 /* Prevent being called recursively because of an error condition
7715 below. Otherwise, we might end up with printing ``can't find per
7716 display information'' in the recursive call instead of printing
7717 the original message here. */
7718 x_catch_errors (dpy);
7719
7720 /* Inhibit redisplay while frames are being deleted. */
7721 specbind (Qinhibit_redisplay, Qt);
7722
7723 if (dpyinfo)
7724 {
7725 /* Protect display from being closed when we delete the last
7726 frame on it. */
7727 dpyinfo->reference_count++;
7728 dpyinfo->terminal->reference_count++;
7729 }
7730
7731 /* First delete frames whose mini-buffers are on frames
7732 that are on the dead display. */
7733 FOR_EACH_FRAME (tail, frame)
7734 {
7735 Lisp_Object minibuf_frame;
7736 minibuf_frame
7737 = WINDOW_FRAME (XWINDOW (FRAME_MINIBUF_WINDOW (XFRAME (frame))));
7738 if (FRAME_X_P (XFRAME (frame))
7739 && FRAME_X_P (XFRAME (minibuf_frame))
7740 && ! EQ (frame, minibuf_frame)
7741 && FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (XFRAME (minibuf_frame)) == dpyinfo)
7742 delete_frame (frame, Qnoelisp);
7743 }
7744
7745 /* Now delete all remaining frames on the dead display.
7746 We are now sure none of these is used as the mini-buffer
7747 for another frame that we need to delete. */
7748 FOR_EACH_FRAME (tail, frame)
7749 if (FRAME_X_P (XFRAME (frame))
7750 && FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (XFRAME (frame)) == dpyinfo)
7751 {
7752 /* Set this to t so that delete_frame won't get confused
7753 trying to find a replacement. */
7754 FRAME_KBOARD (XFRAME (frame))->Vdefault_minibuffer_frame = Qt;
7755 delete_frame (frame, Qnoelisp);
7756 }
7757
7758 /* If DPYINFO is null, this means we didn't open the display in the
7759 first place, so don't try to close it. */
7760 if (dpyinfo)
7761 {
7762 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
7763 /* We have to close the display to inform Xt that it doesn't
7764 exist anymore. If we don't, Xt will continue to wait for
7765 events from the display. As a consequence, a sequence of
7766
7767 M-x make-frame-on-display RET :1 RET
7768 ...kill the new frame, so that we get an IO error...
7769 M-x make-frame-on-display RET :1 RET
7770
7771 will indefinitely wait in Xt for events for display `:1',
7772 opened in the first call to make-frame-on-display.
7773
7774 Closing the display is reported to lead to a bus error on
7775 OpenWindows in certain situations. I suspect that is a bug
7776 in OpenWindows. I don't know how to circumvent it here. */
7777 fatal_error_signal_hook = x_fatal_error_signal;
7778 XtCloseDisplay (dpy);
7779 fatal_error_signal_hook = NULL;
7780 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
7781
7782 #ifdef USE_GTK
7783 /* A long-standing GTK bug prevents proper disconnect handling
7784 (https://bugzilla.gnome.org/show_bug.cgi?id=85715). Once,
7785 the resulting Glib error message loop filled a user's disk.
7786 To avoid this, kill Emacs unconditionally on disconnect. */
7787 shut_down_emacs (0, 0, Qnil);
7788 fprintf (stderr, "%s\n\
7789 When compiled with GTK, Emacs cannot recover from X disconnects.\n\
7790 This is a GTK bug: https://bugzilla.gnome.org/show_bug.cgi?id=85715\n\
7791 For details, see etc/PROBLEMS.\n",
7792 error_msg);
7793 abort ();
7794 #endif /* USE_GTK */
7795
7796 /* Indicate that this display is dead. */
7797 dpyinfo->display = 0;
7798
7799 dpyinfo->reference_count--;
7800 dpyinfo->terminal->reference_count--;
7801 if (dpyinfo->reference_count != 0)
7802 /* We have just closed all frames on this display. */
7803 abort ();
7804
7805 {
7806 Lisp_Object tmp;
7807 XSETTERMINAL (tmp, dpyinfo->terminal);
7808 Fdelete_terminal (tmp, Qnoelisp);
7809 }
7810 }
7811
7812 x_uncatch_errors ();
7813
7814 if (terminal_list == 0)
7815 {
7816 fprintf (stderr, "%s\n", error_msg);
7817 Fkill_emacs (make_number (70));
7818 /* NOTREACHED */
7819 }
7820
7821 /* Ordinary stack unwind doesn't deal with these. */
7822 #ifdef SIGIO
7823 sigunblock (sigmask (SIGIO));
7824 #endif
7825 sigunblock (sigmask (SIGALRM));
7826 TOTALLY_UNBLOCK_INPUT;
7827
7828 unbind_to (index, Qnil);
7829 clear_waiting_for_input ();
7830 /* Here, we absolutely have to use a non-local exit (e.g. signal, throw,
7831 longjmp), because returning from this function would get us back into
7832 Xlib's code which will directly call `exit'. */
7833 error ("%s", error_msg);
7834 }
7835
7836 /* We specifically use it before defining it, so that gcc doesn't inline it,
7837 otherwise gdb doesn't know how to properly put a breakpoint on it. */
7838 static void x_error_quitter (Display *, XErrorEvent *);
7839
7840 /* This is the first-level handler for X protocol errors.
7841 It calls x_error_quitter or x_error_catcher. */
7842
7843 static int
7844 x_error_handler (Display *display, XErrorEvent *error)
7845 {
7846 if (x_error_message)
7847 x_error_catcher (display, error);
7848 else
7849 x_error_quitter (display, error);
7850 return 0;
7851 }
7852
7853 /* This is the usual handler for X protocol errors.
7854 It kills all frames on the display that we got the error for.
7855 If that was the only one, it prints an error message and kills Emacs. */
7856
7857 /* .gdbinit puts a breakpoint here, so make sure it is not inlined. */
7858
7859 /* On older GCC versions, just putting x_error_quitter
7860 after x_error_handler prevents inlining into the former. */
7861
7862 static void NO_INLINE
7863 x_error_quitter (Display *display, XErrorEvent *error)
7864 {
7865 char buf[256], buf1[356];
7866
7867 /* Ignore BadName errors. They can happen because of fonts
7868 or colors that are not defined. */
7869
7870 if (error->error_code == BadName)
7871 return;
7872
7873 /* Note that there is no real way portable across R3/R4 to get the
7874 original error handler. */
7875
7876 XGetErrorText (display, error->error_code, buf, sizeof (buf));
7877 sprintf (buf1, "X protocol error: %s on protocol request %d",
7878 buf, error->request_code);
7879 x_connection_closed (display, buf1);
7880 }
7881
7882
7883 /* This is the handler for X IO errors, always.
7884 It kills all frames on the display that we lost touch with.
7885 If that was the only one, it prints an error message and kills Emacs. */
7886
7887 static int
7888 x_io_error_quitter (Display *display)
7889 {
7890 char buf[256];
7891
7892 sprintf (buf, "Connection lost to X server `%s'", DisplayString (display));
7893 x_connection_closed (display, buf);
7894 return 0;
7895 }
7896 \f
7897 /* Changing the font of the frame. */
7898
7899 /* Give frame F the font FONT-OBJECT as its default font. The return
7900 value is FONT-OBJECT. FONTSET is an ID of the fontset for the
7901 frame. If it is negative, generate a new fontset from
7902 FONT-OBJECT. */
7903
7904 Lisp_Object
7905 x_new_font (struct frame *f, Lisp_Object font_object, int fontset)
7906 {
7907 struct font *font = XFONT_OBJECT (font_object);
7908
7909 if (fontset < 0)
7910 fontset = fontset_from_font (font_object);
7911 FRAME_FONTSET (f) = fontset;
7912 if (FRAME_FONT (f) == font)
7913 /* This font is already set in frame F. There's nothing more to
7914 do. */
7915 return font_object;
7916
7917 FRAME_FONT (f) = font;
7918 FRAME_BASELINE_OFFSET (f) = font->baseline_offset;
7919 FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (f) = font->average_width;
7920 FRAME_SPACE_WIDTH (f) = font->space_width;
7921 FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (f) = FONT_HEIGHT (font);
7922
7923 compute_fringe_widths (f, 1);
7924
7925 /* Compute the scroll bar width in character columns. */
7926 if (FRAME_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH (f) > 0)
7927 {
7928 int wid = FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (f);
7929 FRAME_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_COLS (f)
7930 = (FRAME_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH (f) + wid-1) / wid;
7931 }
7932 else
7933 {
7934 int wid = FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (f);
7935 FRAME_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_COLS (f) = (14 + wid - 1) / wid;
7936 }
7937
7938 if (FRAME_X_WINDOW (f) != 0)
7939 {
7940 /* Don't change the size of a tip frame; there's no point in
7941 doing it because it's done in Fx_show_tip, and it leads to
7942 problems because the tip frame has no widget. */
7943 if (NILP (tip_frame) || XFRAME (tip_frame) != f)
7944 x_set_window_size (f, 0, FRAME_COLS (f), FRAME_LINES (f));
7945 }
7946
7947 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
7948 if (FRAME_XIC (f)
7949 && (FRAME_XIC_STYLE (f) & (XIMPreeditPosition | XIMStatusArea)))
7950 {
7951 BLOCK_INPUT;
7952 xic_set_xfontset (f, SSDATA (fontset_ascii (fontset)));
7953 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
7954 }
7955 #endif
7956
7957 return font_object;
7958 }
7959
7960 \f
7961 /***********************************************************************
7962 X Input Methods
7963 ***********************************************************************/
7964
7965 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
7966
7967 #ifdef HAVE_X11R6
7968
7969 /* XIM destroy callback function, which is called whenever the
7970 connection to input method XIM dies. CLIENT_DATA contains a
7971 pointer to the x_display_info structure corresponding to XIM. */
7972
7973 static void
7974 xim_destroy_callback (XIM xim, XPointer client_data, XPointer call_data)
7975 {
7976 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = (struct x_display_info *) client_data;
7977 Lisp_Object frame, tail;
7978
7979 BLOCK_INPUT;
7980
7981 /* No need to call XDestroyIC.. */
7982 FOR_EACH_FRAME (tail, frame)
7983 {
7984 struct frame *f = XFRAME (frame);
7985 if (FRAME_X_P (f) && FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f) == dpyinfo)
7986 {
7987 FRAME_XIC (f) = NULL;
7988 xic_free_xfontset (f);
7989 }
7990 }
7991
7992 /* No need to call XCloseIM. */
7993 dpyinfo->xim = NULL;
7994 XFree (dpyinfo->xim_styles);
7995 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
7996 }
7997
7998 #endif /* HAVE_X11R6 */
7999
8000 #ifdef HAVE_X11R6
8001 /* This isn't prototyped in OSF 5.0 or 5.1a. */
8002 extern char *XSetIMValues (XIM, ...);
8003 #endif
8004
8005 /* Open the connection to the XIM server on display DPYINFO.
8006 RESOURCE_NAME is the resource name Emacs uses. */
8007
8008 static void
8009 xim_open_dpy (struct x_display_info *dpyinfo, char *resource_name)
8010 {
8011 XIM xim;
8012
8013 #ifdef HAVE_XIM
8014 if (use_xim)
8015 {
8016 if (dpyinfo->xim)
8017 XCloseIM (dpyinfo->xim);
8018 xim = XOpenIM (dpyinfo->display, dpyinfo->xrdb, resource_name,
8019 emacs_class);
8020 dpyinfo->xim = xim;
8021
8022 if (xim)
8023 {
8024 #ifdef HAVE_X11R6
8025 XIMCallback destroy;
8026 #endif
8027
8028 /* Get supported styles and XIM values. */
8029 XGetIMValues (xim, XNQueryInputStyle, &dpyinfo->xim_styles, NULL);
8030
8031 #ifdef HAVE_X11R6
8032 destroy.callback = xim_destroy_callback;
8033 destroy.client_data = (XPointer)dpyinfo;
8034 XSetIMValues (xim, XNDestroyCallback, &destroy, NULL);
8035 #endif
8036 }
8037 }
8038
8039 else
8040 #endif /* HAVE_XIM */
8041 dpyinfo->xim = NULL;
8042 }
8043
8044
8045 #ifdef HAVE_X11R6_XIM
8046
8047 /* XIM instantiate callback function, which is called whenever an XIM
8048 server is available. DISPLAY is the display of the XIM.
8049 CLIENT_DATA contains a pointer to an xim_inst_t structure created
8050 when the callback was registered. */
8051
8052 static void
8053 xim_instantiate_callback (Display *display, XPointer client_data, XPointer call_data)
8054 {
8055 struct xim_inst_t *xim_inst = (struct xim_inst_t *) client_data;
8056 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = xim_inst->dpyinfo;
8057
8058 /* We don't support multiple XIM connections. */
8059 if (dpyinfo->xim)
8060 return;
8061
8062 xim_open_dpy (dpyinfo, xim_inst->resource_name);
8063
8064 /* Create XIC for the existing frames on the same display, as long
8065 as they have no XIC. */
8066 if (dpyinfo->xim && dpyinfo->reference_count > 0)
8067 {
8068 Lisp_Object tail, frame;
8069
8070 BLOCK_INPUT;
8071 FOR_EACH_FRAME (tail, frame)
8072 {
8073 struct frame *f = XFRAME (frame);
8074
8075 if (FRAME_X_P (f)
8076 && FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f) == xim_inst->dpyinfo)
8077 if (FRAME_XIC (f) == NULL)
8078 {
8079 create_frame_xic (f);
8080 if (FRAME_XIC_STYLE (f) & XIMStatusArea)
8081 xic_set_statusarea (f);
8082 if (FRAME_XIC_STYLE (f) & XIMPreeditPosition)
8083 {
8084 struct window *w = XWINDOW (f->selected_window);
8085 xic_set_preeditarea (w, w->cursor.x, w->cursor.y);
8086 }
8087 }
8088 }
8089
8090 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
8091 }
8092 }
8093
8094 #endif /* HAVE_X11R6_XIM */
8095
8096
8097 /* Open a connection to the XIM server on display DPYINFO.
8098 RESOURCE_NAME is the resource name for Emacs. On X11R5, open the
8099 connection only at the first time. On X11R6, open the connection
8100 in the XIM instantiate callback function. */
8101
8102 static void
8103 xim_initialize (struct x_display_info *dpyinfo, char *resource_name)
8104 {
8105 dpyinfo->xim = NULL;
8106 #ifdef HAVE_XIM
8107 if (use_xim)
8108 {
8109 #ifdef HAVE_X11R6_XIM
8110 struct xim_inst_t *xim_inst;
8111 int len;
8112
8113 xim_inst = (struct xim_inst_t *) xmalloc (sizeof (struct xim_inst_t));
8114 dpyinfo->xim_callback_data = xim_inst;
8115 xim_inst->dpyinfo = dpyinfo;
8116 len = strlen (resource_name);
8117 xim_inst->resource_name = (char *) xmalloc (len + 1);
8118 memcpy (xim_inst->resource_name, resource_name, len + 1);
8119 XRegisterIMInstantiateCallback (dpyinfo->display, dpyinfo->xrdb,
8120 resource_name, emacs_class,
8121 xim_instantiate_callback,
8122 /* This is XPointer in XFree86
8123 but (XPointer *) on Tru64, at
8124 least, hence the configure test. */
8125 (XRegisterIMInstantiateCallback_arg6) xim_inst);
8126 #else /* not HAVE_X11R6_XIM */
8127 xim_open_dpy (dpyinfo, resource_name);
8128 #endif /* not HAVE_X11R6_XIM */
8129 }
8130 #endif /* HAVE_XIM */
8131 }
8132
8133
8134 /* Close the connection to the XIM server on display DPYINFO. */
8135
8136 static void
8137 xim_close_dpy (struct x_display_info *dpyinfo)
8138 {
8139 #ifdef HAVE_XIM
8140 if (use_xim)
8141 {
8142 #ifdef HAVE_X11R6_XIM
8143 if (dpyinfo->display)
8144 XUnregisterIMInstantiateCallback (dpyinfo->display, dpyinfo->xrdb,
8145 NULL, emacs_class,
8146 xim_instantiate_callback, NULL);
8147 xfree (dpyinfo->xim_callback_data->resource_name);
8148 xfree (dpyinfo->xim_callback_data);
8149 #endif /* HAVE_X11R6_XIM */
8150 if (dpyinfo->display)
8151 XCloseIM (dpyinfo->xim);
8152 dpyinfo->xim = NULL;
8153 XFree (dpyinfo->xim_styles);
8154 }
8155 #endif /* HAVE_XIM */
8156 }
8157
8158 #endif /* not HAVE_X11R6_XIM */
8159
8160
8161 \f
8162 /* Calculate the absolute position in frame F
8163 from its current recorded position values and gravity. */
8164
8165 void
8166 x_calc_absolute_position (struct frame *f)
8167 {
8168 int flags = f->size_hint_flags;
8169
8170 /* We have nothing to do if the current position
8171 is already for the top-left corner. */
8172 if (! ((flags & XNegative) || (flags & YNegative)))
8173 return;
8174
8175 /* Treat negative positions as relative to the leftmost bottommost
8176 position that fits on the screen. */
8177 if (flags & XNegative)
8178 f->left_pos = x_display_pixel_width (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f))
8179 - FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f) + f->left_pos;
8180
8181 {
8182 int height = FRAME_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f);
8183
8184 #if defined USE_X_TOOLKIT && defined USE_MOTIF
8185 /* Something is fishy here. When using Motif, starting Emacs with
8186 `-g -0-0', the frame appears too low by a few pixels.
8187
8188 This seems to be so because initially, while Emacs is starting,
8189 the column widget's height and the frame's pixel height are
8190 different. The column widget's height is the right one. In
8191 later invocations, when Emacs is up, the frame's pixel height
8192 is right, though.
8193
8194 It's not obvious where the initial small difference comes from.
8195 2000-12-01, gerd. */
8196
8197 XtVaGetValues (f->output_data.x->column_widget, XtNheight, &height, NULL);
8198 #endif
8199
8200 if (flags & YNegative)
8201 f->top_pos = x_display_pixel_height (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f))
8202 - height + f->top_pos;
8203 }
8204
8205 /* The left_pos and top_pos
8206 are now relative to the top and left screen edges,
8207 so the flags should correspond. */
8208 f->size_hint_flags &= ~ (XNegative | YNegative);
8209 }
8210
8211 /* CHANGE_GRAVITY is 1 when calling from Fset_frame_position,
8212 to really change the position, and 0 when calling from
8213 x_make_frame_visible (in that case, XOFF and YOFF are the current
8214 position values). It is -1 when calling from x_set_frame_parameters,
8215 which means, do adjust for borders but don't change the gravity. */
8216
8217 void
8218 x_set_offset (struct frame *f, register int xoff, register int yoff, int change_gravity)
8219 {
8220 int modified_top, modified_left;
8221
8222 if (change_gravity > 0)
8223 {
8224 FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->left_before_move = f->left_pos;
8225 FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->top_before_move = f->top_pos;
8226
8227 f->top_pos = yoff;
8228 f->left_pos = xoff;
8229 f->size_hint_flags &= ~ (XNegative | YNegative);
8230 if (xoff < 0)
8231 f->size_hint_flags |= XNegative;
8232 if (yoff < 0)
8233 f->size_hint_flags |= YNegative;
8234 f->win_gravity = NorthWestGravity;
8235 }
8236 x_calc_absolute_position (f);
8237
8238 BLOCK_INPUT;
8239 x_wm_set_size_hint (f, (long) 0, 0);
8240
8241 modified_left = f->left_pos;
8242 modified_top = f->top_pos;
8243
8244 if (change_gravity != 0 && FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->wm_type == X_WMTYPE_A)
8245 {
8246 /* Some WMs (twm, wmaker at least) has an offset that is smaller
8247 than the WM decorations. So we use the calculated offset instead
8248 of the WM decoration sizes here (x/y_pixels_outer_diff). */
8249 modified_left += FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->move_offset_left;
8250 modified_top += FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->move_offset_top;
8251 }
8252
8253 XMoveWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f),
8254 modified_left, modified_top);
8255
8256 x_sync_with_move (f, f->left_pos, f->top_pos,
8257 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->wm_type == X_WMTYPE_UNKNOWN
8258 ? 1 : 0);
8259
8260 /* change_gravity is non-zero when this function is called from Lisp to
8261 programmatically move a frame. In that case, we call
8262 x_check_expected_move to discover if we have a "Type A" or "Type B"
8263 window manager, and, for a "Type A" window manager, adjust the position
8264 of the frame.
8265
8266 We call x_check_expected_move if a programmatic move occurred, and
8267 either the window manager type (A/B) is unknown or it is Type A but we
8268 need to compute the top/left offset adjustment for this frame. */
8269
8270 if (change_gravity != 0 &&
8271 (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->wm_type == X_WMTYPE_UNKNOWN
8272 || (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->wm_type == X_WMTYPE_A
8273 && (FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->move_offset_left == 0
8274 && FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->move_offset_top == 0))))
8275 x_check_expected_move (f, modified_left, modified_top);
8276
8277 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
8278 }
8279
8280 /* Return non-zero if _NET_SUPPORTING_WM_CHECK window exists and _NET_SUPPORTED
8281 on the root window for frame F contains ATOMNAME.
8282 This is how a WM check shall be done according to the Window Manager
8283 Specification/Extended Window Manager Hints at
8284 http://freedesktop.org/wiki/Specifications/wm-spec. */
8285
8286 static int
8287 wm_supports (struct frame *f, Atom want_atom)
8288 {
8289 Atom actual_type;
8290 unsigned long actual_size, bytes_remaining;
8291 int i, rc, actual_format;
8292 Window wmcheck_window;
8293 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
8294 Window target_window = dpyinfo->root_window;
8295 long max_len = 65536;
8296 Display *dpy = FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f);
8297 unsigned char *tmp_data = NULL;
8298 Atom target_type = XA_WINDOW;
8299
8300 BLOCK_INPUT;
8301
8302 x_catch_errors (dpy);
8303 rc = XGetWindowProperty (dpy, target_window,
8304 dpyinfo->Xatom_net_supporting_wm_check,
8305 0, max_len, False, target_type,
8306 &actual_type, &actual_format, &actual_size,
8307 &bytes_remaining, &tmp_data);
8308
8309 if (rc != Success || actual_type != XA_WINDOW || x_had_errors_p (dpy))
8310 {
8311 if (tmp_data) XFree (tmp_data);
8312 x_uncatch_errors ();
8313 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
8314 return 0;
8315 }
8316
8317 wmcheck_window = *(Window *) tmp_data;
8318 XFree (tmp_data);
8319
8320 /* Check if window exists. */
8321 XSelectInput (dpy, wmcheck_window, StructureNotifyMask);
8322 x_sync (f);
8323 if (x_had_errors_p (dpy))
8324 {
8325 x_uncatch_errors ();
8326 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
8327 return 0;
8328 }
8329
8330 if (dpyinfo->net_supported_window != wmcheck_window)
8331 {
8332 /* Window changed, reload atoms */
8333 if (dpyinfo->net_supported_atoms != NULL)
8334 XFree (dpyinfo->net_supported_atoms);
8335 dpyinfo->net_supported_atoms = NULL;
8336 dpyinfo->nr_net_supported_atoms = 0;
8337 dpyinfo->net_supported_window = 0;
8338
8339 target_type = XA_ATOM;
8340 tmp_data = NULL;
8341 rc = XGetWindowProperty (dpy, target_window,
8342 dpyinfo->Xatom_net_supported,
8343 0, max_len, False, target_type,
8344 &actual_type, &actual_format, &actual_size,
8345 &bytes_remaining, &tmp_data);
8346
8347 if (rc != Success || actual_type != XA_ATOM || x_had_errors_p (dpy))
8348 {
8349 if (tmp_data) XFree (tmp_data);
8350 x_uncatch_errors ();
8351 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
8352 return 0;
8353 }
8354
8355 dpyinfo->net_supported_atoms = (Atom *)tmp_data;
8356 dpyinfo->nr_net_supported_atoms = actual_size;
8357 dpyinfo->net_supported_window = wmcheck_window;
8358 }
8359
8360 rc = 0;
8361
8362 for (i = 0; rc == 0 && i < dpyinfo->nr_net_supported_atoms; ++i)
8363 rc = dpyinfo->net_supported_atoms[i] == want_atom;
8364
8365 x_uncatch_errors ();
8366 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
8367
8368 return rc;
8369 }
8370
8371 static void
8372 set_wm_state (Lisp_Object frame, int add, Atom atom, Atom value)
8373 {
8374 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (XFRAME (frame));
8375
8376 x_send_client_event (frame, make_number (0), frame,
8377 dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state,
8378 make_number (32),
8379 /* 1 = add, 0 = remove */
8380 Fcons
8381 (make_number (add ? 1 : 0),
8382 Fcons
8383 (make_fixnum_or_float (atom),
8384 value != 0
8385 ? Fcons (make_fixnum_or_float (value), Qnil)
8386 : Qnil)));
8387 }
8388
8389 void
8390 x_set_sticky (struct frame *f, Lisp_Object new_value, Lisp_Object old_value)
8391 {
8392 Lisp_Object frame;
8393 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
8394
8395 XSETFRAME (frame, f);
8396
8397 set_wm_state (frame, NILP (new_value) ? 0 : 1,
8398 dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_sticky, None);
8399 }
8400
8401 /* Return the current _NET_WM_STATE.
8402 SIZE_STATE is set to one of the FULLSCREEN_* values.
8403 STICKY is set to 1 if the sticky state is set, 0 if not. */
8404
8405 static void
8406 get_current_wm_state (struct frame *f,
8407 Window window,
8408 int *size_state,
8409 int *sticky)
8410 {
8411 Atom actual_type;
8412 unsigned long actual_size, bytes_remaining;
8413 int i, rc, actual_format;
8414 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
8415 long max_len = 65536;
8416 Display *dpy = FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f);
8417 unsigned char *tmp_data = NULL;
8418 Atom target_type = XA_ATOM;
8419
8420 *sticky = 0;
8421 *size_state = FULLSCREEN_NONE;
8422
8423 BLOCK_INPUT;
8424 x_catch_errors (dpy);
8425 rc = XGetWindowProperty (dpy, window, dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state,
8426 0, max_len, False, target_type,
8427 &actual_type, &actual_format, &actual_size,
8428 &bytes_remaining, &tmp_data);
8429
8430 if (rc != Success || actual_type != target_type || x_had_errors_p (dpy))
8431 {
8432 if (tmp_data) XFree (tmp_data);
8433 x_uncatch_errors ();
8434 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
8435 return;
8436 }
8437
8438 x_uncatch_errors ();
8439
8440 for (i = 0; i < actual_size; ++i)
8441 {
8442 Atom a = ((Atom*)tmp_data)[i];
8443 if (a == dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_maximized_horz)
8444 {
8445 if (*size_state == FULLSCREEN_HEIGHT)
8446 *size_state = FULLSCREEN_MAXIMIZED;
8447 else
8448 *size_state = FULLSCREEN_WIDTH;
8449 }
8450 else if (a == dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_maximized_vert)
8451 {
8452 if (*size_state == FULLSCREEN_WIDTH)
8453 *size_state = FULLSCREEN_MAXIMIZED;
8454 else
8455 *size_state = FULLSCREEN_HEIGHT;
8456 }
8457 else if (a == dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_fullscreen)
8458 *size_state = FULLSCREEN_BOTH;
8459 else if (a == dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_sticky)
8460 *sticky = 1;
8461 }
8462
8463 if (tmp_data) XFree (tmp_data);
8464 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
8465 }
8466
8467 /* Do fullscreen as specified in extended window manager hints */
8468
8469 static int
8470 do_ewmh_fullscreen (struct frame *f)
8471 {
8472 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
8473 int have_net_atom = wm_supports (f, dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state);
8474 int cur, dummy;
8475
8476 get_current_wm_state (f, FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f), &cur, &dummy);
8477
8478 /* Some window managers don't say they support _NET_WM_STATE, but they do say
8479 they support _NET_WM_STATE_FULLSCREEN. Try that also. */
8480 if (!have_net_atom)
8481 have_net_atom = wm_supports (f, dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_fullscreen);
8482
8483 if (have_net_atom && cur != f->want_fullscreen)
8484 {
8485 Lisp_Object frame;
8486
8487 XSETFRAME (frame, f);
8488
8489 /* Keep number of calls to set_wm_state as low as possible.
8490 Some window managers, or possible Gtk+, hangs when too many
8491 are sent at once. */
8492 switch (f->want_fullscreen)
8493 {
8494 case FULLSCREEN_BOTH:
8495 if (cur == FULLSCREEN_WIDTH || cur == FULLSCREEN_MAXIMIZED
8496 || cur == FULLSCREEN_HEIGHT)
8497 set_wm_state (frame, 0, dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_maximized_horz,
8498 dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_maximized_vert);
8499 set_wm_state (frame, 1, dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_fullscreen, None);
8500 break;
8501 case FULLSCREEN_WIDTH:
8502 if (cur == FULLSCREEN_BOTH || cur == FULLSCREEN_HEIGHT
8503 || cur == FULLSCREEN_MAXIMIZED)
8504 set_wm_state (frame, 0, dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_fullscreen,
8505 dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_maximized_vert);
8506 if (cur != FULLSCREEN_MAXIMIZED)
8507 set_wm_state (frame, 1, dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_maximized_horz, None);
8508 break;
8509 case FULLSCREEN_HEIGHT:
8510 if (cur == FULLSCREEN_BOTH || cur == FULLSCREEN_WIDTH
8511 || cur == FULLSCREEN_MAXIMIZED)
8512 set_wm_state (frame, 0, dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_fullscreen,
8513 dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_maximized_horz);
8514 if (cur != FULLSCREEN_MAXIMIZED)
8515 set_wm_state (frame, 1, dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_maximized_vert, None);
8516 break;
8517 case FULLSCREEN_MAXIMIZED:
8518 if (cur == FULLSCREEN_BOTH)
8519 set_wm_state (frame, 0, dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_fullscreen, None);
8520 set_wm_state (frame, 1, dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_maximized_horz,
8521 dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_maximized_vert);
8522 break;
8523 case FULLSCREEN_NONE:
8524 if (cur == FULLSCREEN_BOTH)
8525 set_wm_state (frame, 0, dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_fullscreen, None);
8526 else
8527 set_wm_state (frame, 0, dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_maximized_horz,
8528 dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_maximized_vert);
8529 }
8530
8531 f->want_fullscreen = FULLSCREEN_NONE;
8532
8533 }
8534
8535 return have_net_atom;
8536 }
8537
8538 static void
8539 XTfullscreen_hook (FRAME_PTR f)
8540 {
8541 if (f->async_visible)
8542 {
8543 BLOCK_INPUT;
8544 x_check_fullscreen (f);
8545 x_sync (f);
8546 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
8547 }
8548 }
8549
8550
8551 static void
8552 x_handle_net_wm_state (struct frame *f, XPropertyEvent *event)
8553 {
8554 int value = FULLSCREEN_NONE;
8555 Lisp_Object lval;
8556 int sticky = 0;
8557
8558 get_current_wm_state (f, event->window, &value, &sticky);
8559 lval = Qnil;
8560 switch (value)
8561 {
8562 case FULLSCREEN_WIDTH:
8563 lval = Qfullwidth;
8564 break;
8565 case FULLSCREEN_HEIGHT:
8566 lval = Qfullheight;
8567 break;
8568 case FULLSCREEN_BOTH:
8569 lval = Qfullboth;
8570 break;
8571 case FULLSCREEN_MAXIMIZED:
8572 lval = Qmaximized;
8573 break;
8574 }
8575
8576 store_frame_param (f, Qfullscreen, lval);
8577 store_frame_param (f, Qsticky, sticky ? Qt : Qnil);
8578 }
8579
8580 /* Check if we need to resize the frame due to a fullscreen request.
8581 If so needed, resize the frame. */
8582 static void
8583 x_check_fullscreen (struct frame *f)
8584 {
8585 if (do_ewmh_fullscreen (f))
8586 return;
8587
8588 if (f->output_data.x->parent_desc != FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->root_window)
8589 return; /* Only fullscreen without WM or with EWM hints (above). */
8590
8591 /* Setting fullscreen to nil doesn't do anything. We could save the
8592 last non-fullscreen size and restore it, but it seems like a
8593 lot of work for this unusual case (no window manager running). */
8594
8595 if (f->want_fullscreen != FULLSCREEN_NONE)
8596 {
8597 int width = FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f), height = FRAME_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f);
8598 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
8599
8600 switch (f->want_fullscreen)
8601 {
8602 /* No difference between these two when there is no WM */
8603 case FULLSCREEN_BOTH:
8604 case FULLSCREEN_MAXIMIZED:
8605 width = x_display_pixel_width (dpyinfo);
8606 height = x_display_pixel_height (dpyinfo);
8607 break;
8608 case FULLSCREEN_WIDTH:
8609 width = x_display_pixel_width (dpyinfo);
8610 break;
8611 case FULLSCREEN_HEIGHT:
8612 height = x_display_pixel_height (dpyinfo);
8613 }
8614
8615 XResizeWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f),
8616 width, height);
8617 }
8618 }
8619
8620 /* This function is called by x_set_offset to determine whether the window
8621 manager interfered with the positioning of the frame. Type A window
8622 managers position the surrounding window manager decorations a small
8623 amount above and left of the user-supplied position. Type B window
8624 managers position the surrounding window manager decorations at the
8625 user-specified position. If we detect a Type A window manager, we
8626 compensate by moving the window right and down by the proper amount. */
8627
8628 static void
8629 x_check_expected_move (struct frame *f, int expected_left, int expected_top)
8630 {
8631 int current_left = 0, current_top = 0;
8632
8633 /* x_real_positions returns the left and top offsets of the outermost
8634 window manager window around the frame. */
8635
8636 x_real_positions (f, &current_left, &current_top);
8637
8638 if (current_left != expected_left || current_top != expected_top)
8639 {
8640 /* It's a "Type A" window manager. */
8641
8642 int adjusted_left;
8643 int adjusted_top;
8644
8645 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->wm_type = X_WMTYPE_A;
8646 FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->move_offset_left = expected_left - current_left;
8647 FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->move_offset_top = expected_top - current_top;
8648
8649 /* Now fix the mispositioned frame's location. */
8650
8651 adjusted_left = expected_left + FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->move_offset_left;
8652 adjusted_top = expected_top + FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->move_offset_top;
8653
8654 XMoveWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f),
8655 adjusted_left, adjusted_top);
8656
8657 x_sync_with_move (f, expected_left, expected_top, 0);
8658 }
8659 else
8660 /* It's a "Type B" window manager. We don't have to adjust the
8661 frame's position. */
8662
8663 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->wm_type = X_WMTYPE_B;
8664 }
8665
8666
8667 /* Wait for XGetGeometry to return up-to-date position information for a
8668 recently-moved frame. Call this immediately after calling XMoveWindow.
8669 If FUZZY is non-zero, then LEFT and TOP are just estimates of where the
8670 frame has been moved to, so we use a fuzzy position comparison instead
8671 of an exact comparison. */
8672
8673 static void
8674 x_sync_with_move (struct frame *f, int left, int top, int fuzzy)
8675 {
8676 int count = 0;
8677
8678 while (count++ < 50)
8679 {
8680 int current_left = 0, current_top = 0;
8681
8682 /* In theory, this call to XSync only needs to happen once, but in
8683 practice, it doesn't seem to work, hence the need for the surrounding
8684 loop. */
8685
8686 XSync (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), False);
8687 x_real_positions (f, &current_left, &current_top);
8688
8689 if (fuzzy)
8690 {
8691 /* The left fuzz-factor is 10 pixels. The top fuzz-factor is 40
8692 pixels. */
8693
8694 if (eabs (current_left - left) <= 10
8695 && eabs (current_top - top) <= 40)
8696 return;
8697 }
8698 else if (current_left == left && current_top == top)
8699 return;
8700 }
8701
8702 /* As a last resort, just wait 0.5 seconds and hope that XGetGeometry
8703 will then return up-to-date position info. */
8704
8705 wait_reading_process_output (0, 500000, 0, 0, Qnil, NULL, 0);
8706 }
8707
8708
8709 /* Wait for an event on frame F matching EVENTTYPE. */
8710 void
8711 x_wait_for_event (struct frame *f, int eventtype)
8712 {
8713 int level = interrupt_input_blocked;
8714
8715 SELECT_TYPE fds;
8716 EMACS_TIME tmo, tmo_at, time_now;
8717 int fd = ConnectionNumber (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
8718
8719 pending_event_wait.f = f;
8720 pending_event_wait.eventtype = eventtype;
8721
8722 /* Set timeout to 0.1 second. Hopefully not noticable.
8723 Maybe it should be configurable. */
8724 EMACS_SET_SECS_USECS (tmo, 0, 100000);
8725 EMACS_GET_TIME (tmo_at);
8726 EMACS_ADD_TIME (tmo_at, tmo_at, tmo);
8727
8728 while (pending_event_wait.eventtype)
8729 {
8730 interrupt_input_pending = 1;
8731 TOTALLY_UNBLOCK_INPUT;
8732 /* XTread_socket is called after unblock. */
8733 BLOCK_INPUT;
8734 interrupt_input_blocked = level;
8735
8736 FD_ZERO (&fds);
8737 FD_SET (fd, &fds);
8738
8739 EMACS_GET_TIME (time_now);
8740 EMACS_SUB_TIME (tmo, tmo_at, time_now);
8741
8742 if (EMACS_TIME_NEG_P (tmo) || select (fd+1, &fds, NULL, NULL, &tmo) == 0)
8743 break; /* Timeout */
8744 }
8745 pending_event_wait.f = 0;
8746 pending_event_wait.eventtype = 0;
8747 }
8748
8749
8750 /* Change the size of frame F's X window to COLS/ROWS in the case F
8751 doesn't have a widget. If CHANGE_GRAVITY is 1, we change to
8752 top-left-corner window gravity for this size change and subsequent
8753 size changes. Otherwise we leave the window gravity unchanged. */
8754
8755 static void
8756 x_set_window_size_1 (struct frame *f, int change_gravity, int cols, int rows)
8757 {
8758 int pixelwidth, pixelheight;
8759
8760 check_frame_size (f, &rows, &cols);
8761 f->scroll_bar_actual_width
8762 = (!FRAME_HAS_VERTICAL_SCROLL_BARS (f)
8763 ? 0
8764 : FRAME_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_COLS (f) * FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (f));
8765
8766 compute_fringe_widths (f, 0);
8767
8768 pixelwidth = FRAME_TEXT_COLS_TO_PIXEL_WIDTH (f, cols)
8769 + FRAME_TOOLBAR_WIDTH (f);
8770 pixelheight = FRAME_TEXT_LINES_TO_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f, rows)
8771 + FRAME_MENUBAR_HEIGHT (f) + FRAME_TOOLBAR_HEIGHT (f);
8772
8773 if (change_gravity) f->win_gravity = NorthWestGravity;
8774 x_wm_set_size_hint (f, (long) 0, 0);
8775 XResizeWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f),
8776 pixelwidth, pixelheight);
8777
8778
8779 /* We've set {FRAME,PIXEL}_{WIDTH,HEIGHT} to the values we hope to
8780 receive in the ConfigureNotify event; if we get what we asked
8781 for, then the event won't cause the screen to become garbaged, so
8782 we have to make sure to do it here. */
8783 SET_FRAME_GARBAGED (f);
8784
8785 /* Now, strictly speaking, we can't be sure that this is accurate,
8786 but the window manager will get around to dealing with the size
8787 change request eventually, and we'll hear how it went when the
8788 ConfigureNotify event gets here.
8789
8790 We could just not bother storing any of this information here,
8791 and let the ConfigureNotify event set everything up, but that
8792 might be kind of confusing to the Lisp code, since size changes
8793 wouldn't be reported in the frame parameters until some random
8794 point in the future when the ConfigureNotify event arrives.
8795
8796 We pass 1 for DELAY since we can't run Lisp code inside of
8797 a BLOCK_INPUT. */
8798
8799 /* But the ConfigureNotify may in fact never arrive, and then this is
8800 not right if the frame is visible. Instead wait (with timeout)
8801 for the ConfigureNotify. */
8802 if (f->async_visible)
8803 x_wait_for_event (f, ConfigureNotify);
8804 else
8805 {
8806 change_frame_size (f, rows, cols, 0, 1, 0);
8807 FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f) = pixelwidth;
8808 FRAME_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f) = pixelheight;
8809 x_sync (f);
8810 }
8811 }
8812
8813
8814 /* Call this to change the size of frame F's x-window.
8815 If CHANGE_GRAVITY is 1, we change to top-left-corner window gravity
8816 for this size change and subsequent size changes.
8817 Otherwise we leave the window gravity unchanged. */
8818
8819 void
8820 x_set_window_size (struct frame *f, int change_gravity, int cols, int rows)
8821 {
8822 BLOCK_INPUT;
8823
8824 if (NILP (tip_frame) || XFRAME (tip_frame) != f)
8825 {
8826 int r, c;
8827
8828 /* When the frame is maximized/fullscreen or running under for
8829 example Xmonad, x_set_window_size_1 will be a no-op.
8830 In that case, the right thing to do is extend rows/cols to
8831 the current frame size. We do that first if x_set_window_size_1
8832 turns out to not be a no-op (there is no way to know).
8833 The size will be adjusted again if the frame gets a
8834 ConfigureNotify event as a result of x_set_window_size. */
8835 int pixelh = FRAME_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f);
8836 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
8837 /* The menu bar is not part of text lines. The tool bar
8838 is however. */
8839 pixelh -= FRAME_MENUBAR_HEIGHT (f);
8840 #endif
8841 r = FRAME_PIXEL_HEIGHT_TO_TEXT_LINES (f, pixelh);
8842 /* Update f->scroll_bar_actual_width because it is used in
8843 FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH_TO_TEXT_COLS. */
8844 f->scroll_bar_actual_width
8845 = FRAME_SCROLL_BAR_COLS (f) * FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (f);
8846 c = FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH_TO_TEXT_COLS (f, FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f));
8847 change_frame_size (f, r, c, 0, 1, 0);
8848 }
8849
8850 #ifdef USE_GTK
8851 if (FRAME_GTK_WIDGET (f))
8852 xg_frame_set_char_size (f, cols, rows);
8853 else
8854 x_set_window_size_1 (f, change_gravity, cols, rows);
8855 #else /* not USE_GTK */
8856
8857 x_set_window_size_1 (f, change_gravity, cols, rows);
8858
8859 #endif /* not USE_GTK */
8860
8861 /* If cursor was outside the new size, mark it as off. */
8862 mark_window_cursors_off (XWINDOW (f->root_window));
8863
8864 /* Clear out any recollection of where the mouse highlighting was,
8865 since it might be in a place that's outside the new frame size.
8866 Actually checking whether it is outside is a pain in the neck,
8867 so don't try--just let the highlighting be done afresh with new size. */
8868 cancel_mouse_face (f);
8869
8870 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
8871 }
8872 \f
8873 /* Mouse warping. */
8874
8875 void
8876 x_set_mouse_position (struct frame *f, int x, int y)
8877 {
8878 int pix_x, pix_y;
8879
8880 pix_x = FRAME_COL_TO_PIXEL_X (f, x) + FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (f) / 2;
8881 pix_y = FRAME_LINE_TO_PIXEL_Y (f, y) + FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (f) / 2;
8882
8883 if (pix_x < 0) pix_x = 0;
8884 if (pix_x > FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f)) pix_x = FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f);
8885
8886 if (pix_y < 0) pix_y = 0;
8887 if (pix_y > FRAME_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f)) pix_y = FRAME_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f);
8888
8889 BLOCK_INPUT;
8890
8891 XWarpPointer (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), None, FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
8892 0, 0, 0, 0, pix_x, pix_y);
8893 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
8894 }
8895
8896 /* Move the mouse to position pixel PIX_X, PIX_Y relative to frame F. */
8897
8898 void
8899 x_set_mouse_pixel_position (struct frame *f, int pix_x, int pix_y)
8900 {
8901 BLOCK_INPUT;
8902
8903 XWarpPointer (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), None, FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
8904 0, 0, 0, 0, pix_x, pix_y);
8905 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
8906 }
8907 \f
8908 /* focus shifting, raising and lowering. */
8909
8910 void
8911 x_focus_on_frame (struct frame *f)
8912 {
8913 #if 0
8914 /* I don't think that the ICCCM allows programs to do things like this
8915 without the interaction of the window manager. Whatever you end up
8916 doing with this code, do it to x_unfocus_frame too. */
8917 XSetInputFocus (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
8918 RevertToPointerRoot, CurrentTime);
8919 #endif /* ! 0 */
8920 }
8921
8922 void
8923 x_unfocus_frame (struct frame *f)
8924 {
8925 #if 0
8926 /* Look at the remarks in x_focus_on_frame. */
8927 if (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->x_focus_frame == f)
8928 XSetInputFocus (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), PointerRoot,
8929 RevertToPointerRoot, CurrentTime);
8930 #endif /* ! 0 */
8931 }
8932
8933 /* Raise frame F. */
8934
8935 void
8936 x_raise_frame (struct frame *f)
8937 {
8938 BLOCK_INPUT;
8939 if (f->async_visible)
8940 XRaiseWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f));
8941
8942 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
8943 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
8944 }
8945
8946 /* Lower frame F. */
8947
8948 void
8949 x_lower_frame (struct frame *f)
8950 {
8951 if (f->async_visible)
8952 {
8953 BLOCK_INPUT;
8954 XLowerWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f));
8955 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
8956 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
8957 }
8958 }
8959
8960 /* Activate frame with Extended Window Manager Hints */
8961
8962 void
8963 x_ewmh_activate_frame (FRAME_PTR f)
8964 {
8965 /* See Window Manager Specification/Extended Window Manager Hints at
8966 http://freedesktop.org/wiki/Specifications/wm-spec */
8967
8968 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
8969 if (f->async_visible && wm_supports (f, dpyinfo->Xatom_net_active_window))
8970 {
8971 Lisp_Object frame;
8972 XSETFRAME (frame, f);
8973 x_send_client_event (frame, make_number (0), frame,
8974 dpyinfo->Xatom_net_active_window,
8975 make_number (32),
8976 Fcons (make_number (1),
8977 Fcons (make_number (last_user_time),
8978 Qnil)));
8979 }
8980 }
8981
8982 static void
8983 XTframe_raise_lower (FRAME_PTR f, int raise_flag)
8984 {
8985 if (raise_flag)
8986 x_raise_frame (f);
8987 else
8988 x_lower_frame (f);
8989 }
8990 \f
8991 /* XEmbed implementation. */
8992
8993 static void
8994 xembed_set_info (struct frame *f, enum xembed_info flags)
8995 {
8996 unsigned long data[2];
8997 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
8998
8999 data[0] = XEMBED_VERSION;
9000 data[1] = flags;
9001
9002 XChangeProperty (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f),
9003 dpyinfo->Xatom_XEMBED_INFO, dpyinfo->Xatom_XEMBED_INFO,
9004 32, PropModeReplace, (unsigned char *) data, 2);
9005 }
9006
9007 static void
9008 xembed_send_message (struct frame *f, Time time, enum xembed_message message, long int detail, long int data1, long int data2)
9009 {
9010 XEvent event;
9011
9012 event.xclient.type = ClientMessage;
9013 event.xclient.window = FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->parent_desc;
9014 event.xclient.message_type = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->Xatom_XEMBED;
9015 event.xclient.format = 32;
9016 event.xclient.data.l[0] = time;
9017 event.xclient.data.l[1] = message;
9018 event.xclient.data.l[2] = detail;
9019 event.xclient.data.l[3] = data1;
9020 event.xclient.data.l[4] = data2;
9021
9022 XSendEvent (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->parent_desc,
9023 False, NoEventMask, &event);
9024 XSync (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), False);
9025 }
9026 \f
9027 /* Change of visibility. */
9028
9029 /* This tries to wait until the frame is really visible.
9030 However, if the window manager asks the user where to position
9031 the frame, this will return before the user finishes doing that.
9032 The frame will not actually be visible at that time,
9033 but it will become visible later when the window manager
9034 finishes with it. */
9035
9036 void
9037 x_make_frame_visible (struct frame *f)
9038 {
9039 Lisp_Object type;
9040 int original_top, original_left;
9041 int retry_count = 2;
9042
9043 retry:
9044
9045 BLOCK_INPUT;
9046
9047 type = x_icon_type (f);
9048 if (!NILP (type))
9049 x_bitmap_icon (f, type);
9050
9051 if (! FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f))
9052 {
9053 /* We test FRAME_GARBAGED_P here to make sure we don't
9054 call x_set_offset a second time
9055 if we get to x_make_frame_visible a second time
9056 before the window gets really visible. */
9057 if (! FRAME_ICONIFIED_P (f)
9058 && ! FRAME_X_EMBEDDED_P (f)
9059 && ! f->output_data.x->asked_for_visible)
9060 x_set_offset (f, f->left_pos, f->top_pos, 0);
9061
9062 f->output_data.x->asked_for_visible = 1;
9063
9064 if (! EQ (Vx_no_window_manager, Qt))
9065 x_wm_set_window_state (f, NormalState);
9066 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
9067 if (FRAME_X_EMBEDDED_P (f))
9068 xembed_set_info (f, XEMBED_MAPPED);
9069 else
9070 {
9071 /* This was XtPopup, but that did nothing for an iconified frame. */
9072 XtMapWidget (f->output_data.x->widget);
9073 }
9074 #else /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
9075 #ifdef USE_GTK
9076 gtk_widget_show_all (FRAME_GTK_OUTER_WIDGET (f));
9077 gtk_window_deiconify (GTK_WINDOW (FRAME_GTK_OUTER_WIDGET (f)));
9078 #else
9079 if (FRAME_X_EMBEDDED_P (f))
9080 xembed_set_info (f, XEMBED_MAPPED);
9081 else
9082 XMapRaised (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f));
9083 #endif /* not USE_GTK */
9084 #endif /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
9085 }
9086
9087 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
9088
9089 /* Synchronize to ensure Emacs knows the frame is visible
9090 before we do anything else. We do this loop with input not blocked
9091 so that incoming events are handled. */
9092 {
9093 Lisp_Object frame;
9094 int count;
9095 /* This must be before UNBLOCK_INPUT
9096 since events that arrive in response to the actions above
9097 will set it when they are handled. */
9098 int previously_visible = f->output_data.x->has_been_visible;
9099
9100 original_left = f->left_pos;
9101 original_top = f->top_pos;
9102
9103 /* This must come after we set COUNT. */
9104 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
9105
9106 /* We unblock here so that arriving X events are processed. */
9107
9108 /* Now move the window back to where it was "supposed to be".
9109 But don't do it if the gravity is negative.
9110 When the gravity is negative, this uses a position
9111 that is 3 pixels too low. Perhaps that's really the border width.
9112
9113 Don't do this if the window has never been visible before,
9114 because the window manager may choose the position
9115 and we don't want to override it. */
9116
9117 if (! FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f)
9118 && ! FRAME_ICONIFIED_P (f)
9119 && ! FRAME_X_EMBEDDED_P (f)
9120 && f->win_gravity == NorthWestGravity
9121 && previously_visible)
9122 {
9123 Drawable rootw;
9124 int x, y;
9125 unsigned int width, height, border, depth;
9126
9127 BLOCK_INPUT;
9128
9129 /* On some window managers (such as FVWM) moving an existing
9130 window, even to the same place, causes the window manager
9131 to introduce an offset. This can cause the window to move
9132 to an unexpected location. Check the geometry (a little
9133 slow here) and then verify that the window is in the right
9134 place. If the window is not in the right place, move it
9135 there, and take the potential window manager hit. */
9136 XGetGeometry (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f),
9137 &rootw, &x, &y, &width, &height, &border, &depth);
9138
9139 if (original_left != x || original_top != y)
9140 XMoveWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f),
9141 original_left, original_top);
9142
9143 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
9144 }
9145
9146 XSETFRAME (frame, f);
9147
9148 /* Wait until the frame is visible. Process X events until a
9149 MapNotify event has been seen, or until we think we won't get a
9150 MapNotify at all.. */
9151 for (count = input_signal_count + 10;
9152 input_signal_count < count && !FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f);)
9153 {
9154 /* Force processing of queued events. */
9155 x_sync (f);
9156
9157 /* Machines that do polling rather than SIGIO have been
9158 observed to go into a busy-wait here. So we'll fake an
9159 alarm signal to let the handler know that there's something
9160 to be read. We used to raise a real alarm, but it seems
9161 that the handler isn't always enabled here. This is
9162 probably a bug. */
9163 if (input_polling_used ())
9164 {
9165 /* It could be confusing if a real alarm arrives while
9166 processing the fake one. Turn it off and let the
9167 handler reset it. */
9168 int old_poll_suppress_count = poll_suppress_count;
9169 poll_suppress_count = 1;
9170 poll_for_input_1 ();
9171 poll_suppress_count = old_poll_suppress_count;
9172 }
9173
9174 /* See if a MapNotify event has been processed. */
9175 FRAME_SAMPLE_VISIBILITY (f);
9176 }
9177
9178 /* 2000-09-28: In
9179
9180 (let ((f (selected-frame)))
9181 (iconify-frame f)
9182 (raise-frame f))
9183
9184 the frame is not raised with various window managers on
9185 FreeBSD, GNU/Linux and Solaris. It turns out that, for some
9186 unknown reason, the call to XtMapWidget is completely ignored.
9187 Mapping the widget a second time works. */
9188
9189 if (!FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f) && --retry_count > 0)
9190 goto retry;
9191 }
9192 }
9193
9194 /* Change from mapped state to withdrawn state. */
9195
9196 /* Make the frame visible (mapped and not iconified). */
9197
9198 void
9199 x_make_frame_invisible (struct frame *f)
9200 {
9201 Window window;
9202
9203 /* Use the frame's outermost window, not the one we normally draw on. */
9204 window = FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f);
9205
9206 /* Don't keep the highlight on an invisible frame. */
9207 if (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->x_highlight_frame == f)
9208 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->x_highlight_frame = 0;
9209
9210 BLOCK_INPUT;
9211
9212 /* Before unmapping the window, update the WM_SIZE_HINTS property to claim
9213 that the current position of the window is user-specified, rather than
9214 program-specified, so that when the window is mapped again, it will be
9215 placed at the same location, without forcing the user to position it
9216 by hand again (they have already done that once for this window.) */
9217 x_wm_set_size_hint (f, (long) 0, 1);
9218
9219 #ifdef USE_GTK
9220 if (FRAME_GTK_OUTER_WIDGET (f))
9221 gtk_widget_hide (FRAME_GTK_OUTER_WIDGET (f));
9222 else
9223 #else
9224 if (FRAME_X_EMBEDDED_P (f))
9225 xembed_set_info (f, 0);
9226 else
9227 #endif
9228 {
9229
9230 if (! XWithdrawWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), window,
9231 DefaultScreen (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f))))
9232 {
9233 UNBLOCK_INPUT_RESIGNAL;
9234 error ("Can't notify window manager of window withdrawal");
9235 }
9236 }
9237
9238 /* We can't distinguish this from iconification
9239 just by the event that we get from the server.
9240 So we can't win using the usual strategy of letting
9241 FRAME_SAMPLE_VISIBILITY set this. So do it by hand,
9242 and synchronize with the server to make sure we agree. */
9243 f->visible = 0;
9244 FRAME_ICONIFIED_P (f) = 0;
9245 f->async_visible = 0;
9246 f->async_iconified = 0;
9247
9248 x_sync (f);
9249
9250 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
9251 }
9252
9253 /* Change window state from mapped to iconified. */
9254
9255 void
9256 x_iconify_frame (struct frame *f)
9257 {
9258 int result;
9259 Lisp_Object type;
9260
9261 /* Don't keep the highlight on an invisible frame. */
9262 if (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->x_highlight_frame == f)
9263 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->x_highlight_frame = 0;
9264
9265 if (f->async_iconified)
9266 return;
9267
9268 BLOCK_INPUT;
9269
9270 FRAME_SAMPLE_VISIBILITY (f);
9271
9272 type = x_icon_type (f);
9273 if (!NILP (type))
9274 x_bitmap_icon (f, type);
9275
9276 #ifdef USE_GTK
9277 if (FRAME_GTK_OUTER_WIDGET (f))
9278 {
9279 if (! FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f))
9280 gtk_widget_show_all (FRAME_GTK_OUTER_WIDGET (f));
9281
9282 gtk_window_iconify (GTK_WINDOW (FRAME_GTK_OUTER_WIDGET (f)));
9283 f->iconified = 1;
9284 f->visible = 1;
9285 f->async_iconified = 1;
9286 f->async_visible = 0;
9287 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
9288 return;
9289 }
9290 #endif
9291
9292 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
9293
9294 if (! FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f))
9295 {
9296 if (! EQ (Vx_no_window_manager, Qt))
9297 x_wm_set_window_state (f, IconicState);
9298 /* This was XtPopup, but that did nothing for an iconified frame. */
9299 XtMapWidget (f->output_data.x->widget);
9300 /* The server won't give us any event to indicate
9301 that an invisible frame was changed to an icon,
9302 so we have to record it here. */
9303 f->iconified = 1;
9304 f->visible = 1;
9305 f->async_iconified = 1;
9306 f->async_visible = 0;
9307 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
9308 return;
9309 }
9310
9311 result = XIconifyWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f),
9312 XtWindow (f->output_data.x->widget),
9313 DefaultScreen (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f)));
9314 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
9315
9316 if (!result)
9317 error ("Can't notify window manager of iconification");
9318
9319 f->async_iconified = 1;
9320 f->async_visible = 0;
9321
9322
9323 BLOCK_INPUT;
9324 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
9325 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
9326 #else /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
9327
9328 /* Make sure the X server knows where the window should be positioned,
9329 in case the user deiconifies with the window manager. */
9330 if (! FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f)
9331 && ! FRAME_ICONIFIED_P (f)
9332 && ! FRAME_X_EMBEDDED_P (f))
9333 x_set_offset (f, f->left_pos, f->top_pos, 0);
9334
9335 /* Since we don't know which revision of X we're running, we'll use both
9336 the X11R3 and X11R4 techniques. I don't know if this is a good idea. */
9337
9338 /* X11R4: send a ClientMessage to the window manager using the
9339 WM_CHANGE_STATE type. */
9340 {
9341 XEvent message;
9342
9343 message.xclient.window = FRAME_X_WINDOW (f);
9344 message.xclient.type = ClientMessage;
9345 message.xclient.message_type = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->Xatom_wm_change_state;
9346 message.xclient.format = 32;
9347 message.xclient.data.l[0] = IconicState;
9348
9349 if (! XSendEvent (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f),
9350 DefaultRootWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f)),
9351 False,
9352 SubstructureRedirectMask | SubstructureNotifyMask,
9353 &message))
9354 {
9355 UNBLOCK_INPUT_RESIGNAL;
9356 error ("Can't notify window manager of iconification");
9357 }
9358 }
9359
9360 /* X11R3: set the initial_state field of the window manager hints to
9361 IconicState. */
9362 x_wm_set_window_state (f, IconicState);
9363
9364 if (!FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f))
9365 {
9366 /* If the frame was withdrawn, before, we must map it. */
9367 XMapRaised (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f));
9368 }
9369
9370 f->async_iconified = 1;
9371 f->async_visible = 0;
9372
9373 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
9374 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
9375 #endif /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
9376 }
9377
9378 \f
9379 /* Free X resources of frame F. */
9380
9381 void
9382 x_free_frame_resources (struct frame *f)
9383 {
9384 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
9385 Lisp_Object bar;
9386 struct scroll_bar *b;
9387 Mouse_HLInfo *hlinfo = &dpyinfo->mouse_highlight;
9388
9389 BLOCK_INPUT;
9390
9391 /* If a display connection is dead, don't try sending more
9392 commands to the X server. */
9393 if (dpyinfo->display)
9394 {
9395 /* We must free faces before destroying windows because some
9396 font-driver (e.g. xft) access a window while finishing a
9397 face. */
9398 if (FRAME_FACE_CACHE (f))
9399 free_frame_faces (f);
9400
9401 if (f->output_data.x->icon_desc)
9402 XDestroyWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), f->output_data.x->icon_desc);
9403
9404 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
9405 /* Explicitly destroy the scroll bars of the frame. Without
9406 this, we get "BadDrawable" errors from the toolkit later on,
9407 presumably from expose events generated for the disappearing
9408 toolkit scroll bars. */
9409 for (bar = FRAME_SCROLL_BARS (f); !NILP (bar); bar = b->next)
9410 {
9411 b = XSCROLL_BAR (bar);
9412 x_scroll_bar_remove (b);
9413 }
9414 #endif
9415
9416 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
9417 if (FRAME_XIC (f))
9418 free_frame_xic (f);
9419 #endif
9420
9421 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
9422 if (f->output_data.x->widget)
9423 {
9424 XtDestroyWidget (f->output_data.x->widget);
9425 f->output_data.x->widget = NULL;
9426 }
9427 /* Tooltips don't have widgets, only a simple X window, even if
9428 we are using a toolkit. */
9429 else if (FRAME_X_WINDOW (f))
9430 XDestroyWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f));
9431
9432 free_frame_menubar (f);
9433 #else /* !USE_X_TOOLKIT */
9434
9435 #ifdef USE_GTK
9436 xg_free_frame_widgets (f);
9437 #endif /* USE_GTK */
9438
9439 if (FRAME_X_WINDOW (f))
9440 XDestroyWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f));
9441 #endif /* !USE_X_TOOLKIT */
9442
9443 unload_color (f, FRAME_FOREGROUND_PIXEL (f));
9444 unload_color (f, FRAME_BACKGROUND_PIXEL (f));
9445 unload_color (f, f->output_data.x->cursor_pixel);
9446 unload_color (f, f->output_data.x->cursor_foreground_pixel);
9447 unload_color (f, f->output_data.x->border_pixel);
9448 unload_color (f, f->output_data.x->mouse_pixel);
9449
9450 if (f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_background_pixel != -1)
9451 unload_color (f, f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_background_pixel);
9452 if (f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_foreground_pixel != -1)
9453 unload_color (f, f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_foreground_pixel);
9454 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
9455 /* Scrollbar shadow colors. */
9456 if (f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_top_shadow_pixel != -1)
9457 unload_color (f, f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_top_shadow_pixel);
9458 if (f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_bottom_shadow_pixel != -1)
9459 unload_color (f, f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_bottom_shadow_pixel);
9460 #endif /* USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
9461 if (f->output_data.x->white_relief.allocated_p)
9462 unload_color (f, f->output_data.x->white_relief.pixel);
9463 if (f->output_data.x->black_relief.allocated_p)
9464 unload_color (f, f->output_data.x->black_relief.pixel);
9465
9466 x_free_gcs (f);
9467 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
9468 }
9469
9470 xfree (f->output_data.x->saved_menu_event);
9471 xfree (f->output_data.x);
9472 f->output_data.x = NULL;
9473
9474 if (f == dpyinfo->x_focus_frame)
9475 dpyinfo->x_focus_frame = 0;
9476 if (f == dpyinfo->x_focus_event_frame)
9477 dpyinfo->x_focus_event_frame = 0;
9478 if (f == dpyinfo->x_highlight_frame)
9479 dpyinfo->x_highlight_frame = 0;
9480
9481 if (f == hlinfo->mouse_face_mouse_frame)
9482 {
9483 hlinfo->mouse_face_beg_row
9484 = hlinfo->mouse_face_beg_col = -1;
9485 hlinfo->mouse_face_end_row
9486 = hlinfo->mouse_face_end_col = -1;
9487 hlinfo->mouse_face_window = Qnil;
9488 hlinfo->mouse_face_deferred_gc = 0;
9489 hlinfo->mouse_face_mouse_frame = 0;
9490 }
9491
9492 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
9493 }
9494
9495
9496 /* Destroy the X window of frame F. */
9497
9498 void
9499 x_destroy_window (struct frame *f)
9500 {
9501 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
9502
9503 /* If a display connection is dead, don't try sending more
9504 commands to the X server. */
9505 if (dpyinfo->display != 0)
9506 x_free_frame_resources (f);
9507
9508 dpyinfo->reference_count--;
9509 }
9510
9511 \f
9512 /* Setting window manager hints. */
9513
9514 /* Set the normal size hints for the window manager, for frame F.
9515 FLAGS is the flags word to use--or 0 meaning preserve the flags
9516 that the window now has.
9517 If USER_POSITION is nonzero, we set the USPosition
9518 flag (this is useful when FLAGS is 0).
9519 The GTK version is in gtkutils.c */
9520
9521 #ifndef USE_GTK
9522 void
9523 x_wm_set_size_hint (struct frame *f, long flags, int user_position)
9524 {
9525 XSizeHints size_hints;
9526 Window window = FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f);
9527
9528 /* Setting PMaxSize caused various problems. */
9529 size_hints.flags = PResizeInc | PMinSize /* | PMaxSize */;
9530
9531 size_hints.x = f->left_pos;
9532 size_hints.y = f->top_pos;
9533
9534 size_hints.height = FRAME_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f);
9535 size_hints.width = FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f);
9536
9537 size_hints.width_inc = FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (f);
9538 size_hints.height_inc = FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (f);
9539 size_hints.max_width = x_display_pixel_width (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f))
9540 - FRAME_TEXT_COLS_TO_PIXEL_WIDTH (f, 0);
9541 size_hints.max_height = x_display_pixel_height (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f))
9542 - FRAME_TEXT_LINES_TO_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f, 0);
9543
9544 /* Calculate the base and minimum sizes. */
9545 {
9546 int base_width, base_height;
9547 int min_rows = 0, min_cols = 0;
9548
9549 base_width = FRAME_TEXT_COLS_TO_PIXEL_WIDTH (f, 0);
9550 base_height = FRAME_TEXT_LINES_TO_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f, 0);
9551
9552 check_frame_size (f, &min_rows, &min_cols);
9553
9554 /* The window manager uses the base width hints to calculate the
9555 current number of rows and columns in the frame while
9556 resizing; min_width and min_height aren't useful for this
9557 purpose, since they might not give the dimensions for a
9558 zero-row, zero-column frame.
9559
9560 We use the base_width and base_height members if we have
9561 them; otherwise, we set the min_width and min_height members
9562 to the size for a zero x zero frame. */
9563
9564 size_hints.flags |= PBaseSize;
9565 size_hints.base_width = base_width;
9566 size_hints.base_height = base_height + FRAME_MENUBAR_HEIGHT (f);
9567 size_hints.min_width = base_width + min_cols * size_hints.width_inc;
9568 size_hints.min_height = base_height + min_rows * size_hints.height_inc;
9569 }
9570
9571 /* If we don't need the old flags, we don't need the old hint at all. */
9572 if (flags)
9573 {
9574 size_hints.flags |= flags;
9575 goto no_read;
9576 }
9577
9578 {
9579 XSizeHints hints; /* Sometimes I hate X Windows... */
9580 long supplied_return;
9581 int value;
9582
9583 value = XGetWMNormalHints (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), window, &hints,
9584 &supplied_return);
9585
9586 if (flags)
9587 size_hints.flags |= flags;
9588 else
9589 {
9590 if (value == 0)
9591 hints.flags = 0;
9592 if (hints.flags & PSize)
9593 size_hints.flags |= PSize;
9594 if (hints.flags & PPosition)
9595 size_hints.flags |= PPosition;
9596 if (hints.flags & USPosition)
9597 size_hints.flags |= USPosition;
9598 if (hints.flags & USSize)
9599 size_hints.flags |= USSize;
9600 }
9601 }
9602
9603 no_read:
9604
9605 #ifdef PWinGravity
9606 size_hints.win_gravity = f->win_gravity;
9607 size_hints.flags |= PWinGravity;
9608
9609 if (user_position)
9610 {
9611 size_hints.flags &= ~ PPosition;
9612 size_hints.flags |= USPosition;
9613 }
9614 #endif /* PWinGravity */
9615
9616 XSetWMNormalHints (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), window, &size_hints);
9617 }
9618 #endif /* not USE_GTK */
9619
9620 /* Used for IconicState or NormalState */
9621
9622 void
9623 x_wm_set_window_state (struct frame *f, int state)
9624 {
9625 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
9626 Arg al[1];
9627
9628 XtSetArg (al[0], XtNinitialState, state);
9629 XtSetValues (f->output_data.x->widget, al, 1);
9630 #else /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
9631 Window window = FRAME_X_WINDOW (f);
9632
9633 f->output_data.x->wm_hints.flags |= StateHint;
9634 f->output_data.x->wm_hints.initial_state = state;
9635
9636 XSetWMHints (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), window, &f->output_data.x->wm_hints);
9637 #endif /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
9638 }
9639
9640 void
9641 x_wm_set_icon_pixmap (struct frame *f, int pixmap_id)
9642 {
9643 Pixmap icon_pixmap, icon_mask;
9644
9645 #if !defined USE_X_TOOLKIT && !defined USE_GTK
9646 Window window = FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f);
9647 #endif
9648
9649 if (pixmap_id > 0)
9650 {
9651 icon_pixmap = x_bitmap_pixmap (f, pixmap_id);
9652 f->output_data.x->wm_hints.icon_pixmap = icon_pixmap;
9653 icon_mask = x_bitmap_mask (f, pixmap_id);
9654 f->output_data.x->wm_hints.icon_mask = icon_mask;
9655 }
9656 else
9657 {
9658 /* It seems there is no way to turn off use of an icon
9659 pixmap. */
9660 return;
9661 }
9662
9663
9664 #ifdef USE_GTK
9665 {
9666 xg_set_frame_icon (f, icon_pixmap, icon_mask);
9667 return;
9668 }
9669
9670 #elif defined (USE_X_TOOLKIT) /* same as in x_wm_set_window_state. */
9671
9672 {
9673 Arg al[1];
9674 XtSetArg (al[0], XtNiconPixmap, icon_pixmap);
9675 XtSetValues (f->output_data.x->widget, al, 1);
9676 XtSetArg (al[0], XtNiconMask, icon_mask);
9677 XtSetValues (f->output_data.x->widget, al, 1);
9678 }
9679
9680 #else /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT && not USE_GTK */
9681
9682 f->output_data.x->wm_hints.flags |= (IconPixmapHint | IconMaskHint);
9683 XSetWMHints (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), window, &f->output_data.x->wm_hints);
9684
9685 #endif /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT && not USE_GTK */
9686 }
9687
9688 void
9689 x_wm_set_icon_position (struct frame *f, int icon_x, int icon_y)
9690 {
9691 Window window = FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f);
9692
9693 f->output_data.x->wm_hints.flags |= IconPositionHint;
9694 f->output_data.x->wm_hints.icon_x = icon_x;
9695 f->output_data.x->wm_hints.icon_y = icon_y;
9696
9697 XSetWMHints (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), window, &f->output_data.x->wm_hints);
9698 }
9699
9700 \f
9701 /***********************************************************************
9702 Fonts
9703 ***********************************************************************/
9704
9705 #if GLYPH_DEBUG
9706
9707 /* Check that FONT is valid on frame F. It is if it can be found in F's
9708 font table. */
9709
9710 static void
9711 x_check_font (struct frame *f, struct font *font)
9712 {
9713 Lisp_Object frame;
9714
9715 xassert (font != NULL && ! NILP (font->props[FONT_TYPE_INDEX]));
9716 if (font->driver->check)
9717 xassert (font->driver->check (f, font) == 0);
9718 }
9719
9720 #endif /* GLYPH_DEBUG != 0 */
9721
9722 \f
9723 /***********************************************************************
9724 Initialization
9725 ***********************************************************************/
9726
9727 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
9728 static XrmOptionDescRec emacs_options[] = {
9729 {"-geometry", ".geometry", XrmoptionSepArg, NULL},
9730 {"-iconic", ".iconic", XrmoptionNoArg, (XtPointer) "yes"},
9731
9732 {"-internal-border-width", "*EmacsScreen.internalBorderWidth",
9733 XrmoptionSepArg, NULL},
9734 {"-ib", "*EmacsScreen.internalBorderWidth", XrmoptionSepArg, NULL},
9735
9736 {"-T", "*EmacsShell.title", XrmoptionSepArg, (XtPointer) NULL},
9737 {"-wn", "*EmacsShell.title", XrmoptionSepArg, (XtPointer) NULL},
9738 {"-title", "*EmacsShell.title", XrmoptionSepArg, (XtPointer) NULL},
9739 {"-iconname", "*EmacsShell.iconName", XrmoptionSepArg, (XtPointer) NULL},
9740 {"-in", "*EmacsShell.iconName", XrmoptionSepArg, (XtPointer) NULL},
9741 {"-mc", "*pointerColor", XrmoptionSepArg, (XtPointer) NULL},
9742 {"-cr", "*cursorColor", XrmoptionSepArg, (XtPointer) NULL}
9743 };
9744
9745 /* Whether atimer for Xt timeouts is activated or not. */
9746
9747 static int x_timeout_atimer_activated_flag;
9748
9749 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
9750
9751 static int x_initialized;
9752
9753 #ifdef HAVE_X_SM
9754 static int x_session_initialized;
9755 #endif
9756
9757 /* Test whether two display-name strings agree up to the dot that separates
9758 the screen number from the server number. */
9759 static int
9760 same_x_server (const char *name1, const char *name2)
9761 {
9762 int seen_colon = 0;
9763 const unsigned char *system_name = SDATA (Vsystem_name);
9764 int system_name_length = strlen (system_name);
9765 int length_until_period = 0;
9766
9767 while (system_name[length_until_period] != 0
9768 && system_name[length_until_period] != '.')
9769 length_until_period++;
9770
9771 /* Treat `unix' like an empty host name. */
9772 if (! strncmp (name1, "unix:", 5))
9773 name1 += 4;
9774 if (! strncmp (name2, "unix:", 5))
9775 name2 += 4;
9776 /* Treat this host's name like an empty host name. */
9777 if (! strncmp (name1, system_name, system_name_length)
9778 && name1[system_name_length] == ':')
9779 name1 += system_name_length;
9780 if (! strncmp (name2, system_name, system_name_length)
9781 && name2[system_name_length] == ':')
9782 name2 += system_name_length;
9783 /* Treat this host's domainless name like an empty host name. */
9784 if (! strncmp (name1, system_name, length_until_period)
9785 && name1[length_until_period] == ':')
9786 name1 += length_until_period;
9787 if (! strncmp (name2, system_name, length_until_period)
9788 && name2[length_until_period] == ':')
9789 name2 += length_until_period;
9790
9791 for (; *name1 != '\0' && *name1 == *name2; name1++, name2++)
9792 {
9793 if (*name1 == ':')
9794 seen_colon++;
9795 if (seen_colon && *name1 == '.')
9796 return 1;
9797 }
9798 return (seen_colon
9799 && (*name1 == '.' || *name1 == '\0')
9800 && (*name2 == '.' || *name2 == '\0'));
9801 }
9802
9803 /* Count number of set bits in mask and number of bits to shift to
9804 get to the first bit. With MASK 0x7e0, *BITS is set to 6, and *OFFSET
9805 to 5. */
9806 static void
9807 get_bits_and_offset (long unsigned int mask, int *bits, int *offset)
9808 {
9809 int nr = 0;
9810 int off = 0;
9811
9812 while (!(mask & 1))
9813 {
9814 off++;
9815 mask >>= 1;
9816 }
9817
9818 while (mask & 1)
9819 {
9820 nr++;
9821 mask >>= 1;
9822 }
9823
9824 *offset = off;
9825 *bits = nr;
9826 }
9827
9828 /* Return 1 if display DISPLAY is available for use, 0 otherwise.
9829 But don't permanently open it, just test its availability. */
9830
9831 int
9832 x_display_ok (const char *display)
9833 {
9834 int dpy_ok = 1;
9835 Display *dpy;
9836
9837 dpy = XOpenDisplay (display);
9838 if (dpy)
9839 XCloseDisplay (dpy);
9840 else
9841 dpy_ok = 0;
9842 return dpy_ok;
9843 }
9844
9845 #ifdef USE_GTK
9846 static void
9847 my_log_handler (const gchar *log_domain, GLogLevelFlags log_level, const gchar *message, gpointer user_data)
9848 {
9849 if (!strstr (message, "g_set_prgname"))
9850 fprintf (stderr, "%s-WARNING **: %s\n", log_domain, message);
9851 }
9852 #endif
9853
9854 /* Open a connection to X display DISPLAY_NAME, and return
9855 the structure that describes the open display.
9856 If we cannot contact the display, return null. */
9857
9858 struct x_display_info *
9859 x_term_init (Lisp_Object display_name, char *xrm_option, char *resource_name)
9860 {
9861 int connection;
9862 Display *dpy;
9863 struct terminal *terminal;
9864 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
9865 XrmDatabase xrdb;
9866 Mouse_HLInfo *hlinfo;
9867
9868 BLOCK_INPUT;
9869
9870 if (!x_initialized)
9871 {
9872 x_initialize ();
9873 ++x_initialized;
9874 }
9875
9876 if (! x_display_ok (SSDATA (display_name)))
9877 error ("Display %s can't be opened", SDATA (display_name));
9878
9879 #ifdef USE_GTK
9880 {
9881 #define NUM_ARGV 10
9882 int argc;
9883 char *argv[NUM_ARGV];
9884 char **argv2 = argv;
9885 guint id;
9886
9887 if (x_initialized++ > 1)
9888 {
9889 xg_display_open (SDATA (display_name), &dpy);
9890 }
9891 else
9892 {
9893 static char display_opt[] = "--display";
9894 static char name_opt[] = "--name";
9895
9896 for (argc = 0; argc < NUM_ARGV; ++argc)
9897 argv[argc] = 0;
9898
9899 argc = 0;
9900 argv[argc++] = initial_argv[0];
9901
9902 if (! NILP (display_name))
9903 {
9904 argv[argc++] = display_opt;
9905 argv[argc++] = SDATA (display_name);
9906 }
9907
9908 argv[argc++] = name_opt;
9909 argv[argc++] = resource_name;
9910
9911 XSetLocaleModifiers ("");
9912
9913 /* Work around GLib bug that outputs a faulty warning. See
9914 https://bugzilla.gnome.org/show_bug.cgi?id=563627. */
9915 id = g_log_set_handler ("GLib", G_LOG_LEVEL_WARNING | G_LOG_FLAG_FATAL
9916 | G_LOG_FLAG_RECURSION, my_log_handler, NULL);
9917 gtk_init (&argc, &argv2);
9918 g_log_remove_handler ("GLib", id);
9919
9920 /* gtk_init does set_locale. We must fix locale after calling it. */
9921 fixup_locale ();
9922 xg_initialize ();
9923
9924 dpy = GDK_DISPLAY ();
9925
9926 /* NULL window -> events for all windows go to our function */
9927 gdk_window_add_filter (NULL, event_handler_gdk, NULL);
9928
9929 /* Load our own gtkrc if it exists. */
9930 {
9931 const char *file = "~/.emacs.d/gtkrc";
9932 Lisp_Object s, abs_file;
9933
9934 s = make_string (file, strlen (file));
9935 abs_file = Fexpand_file_name (s, Qnil);
9936
9937 if (! NILP (abs_file) && !NILP (Ffile_readable_p (abs_file)))
9938 gtk_rc_parse (SDATA (abs_file));
9939 }
9940
9941 XSetErrorHandler (x_error_handler);
9942 XSetIOErrorHandler (x_io_error_quitter);
9943 }
9944 }
9945 #else /* not USE_GTK */
9946 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
9947 /* weiner@footloose.sps.mot.com reports that this causes
9948 errors with X11R5:
9949 X protocol error: BadAtom (invalid Atom parameter)
9950 on protocol request 18skiloaf.
9951 So let's not use it until R6. */
9952 #ifdef HAVE_X11XTR6
9953 XtSetLanguageProc (NULL, NULL, NULL);
9954 #endif
9955
9956 {
9957 int argc = 0;
9958 char *argv[3];
9959
9960 argv[0] = "";
9961 argc = 1;
9962 if (xrm_option)
9963 {
9964 argv[argc++] = "-xrm";
9965 argv[argc++] = xrm_option;
9966 }
9967 turn_on_atimers (0);
9968 dpy = XtOpenDisplay (Xt_app_con, SSDATA (display_name),
9969 resource_name, EMACS_CLASS,
9970 emacs_options, XtNumber (emacs_options),
9971 &argc, argv);
9972 turn_on_atimers (1);
9973
9974 #ifdef HAVE_X11XTR6
9975 /* I think this is to compensate for XtSetLanguageProc. */
9976 fixup_locale ();
9977 #endif
9978 }
9979
9980 #else /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
9981 XSetLocaleModifiers ("");
9982 dpy = XOpenDisplay (SDATA (display_name));
9983 #endif /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
9984 #endif /* not USE_GTK*/
9985
9986 /* Detect failure. */
9987 if (dpy == 0)
9988 {
9989 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
9990 return 0;
9991 }
9992
9993 /* We have definitely succeeded. Record the new connection. */
9994
9995 dpyinfo = (struct x_display_info *) xmalloc (sizeof (struct x_display_info));
9996 memset (dpyinfo, 0, sizeof *dpyinfo);
9997 hlinfo = &dpyinfo->mouse_highlight;
9998
9999 terminal = x_create_terminal (dpyinfo);
10000
10001 {
10002 struct x_display_info *share;
10003 Lisp_Object tail;
10004
10005 for (share = x_display_list, tail = x_display_name_list; share;
10006 share = share->next, tail = XCDR (tail))
10007 if (same_x_server (SSDATA (XCAR (XCAR (tail))),
10008 SSDATA (display_name)))
10009 break;
10010 if (share)
10011 terminal->kboard = share->terminal->kboard;
10012 else
10013 {
10014 terminal->kboard = (KBOARD *) xmalloc (sizeof (KBOARD));
10015 init_kboard (terminal->kboard);
10016 terminal->kboard->Vwindow_system = Qx;
10017
10018 /* Add the keyboard to the list before running Lisp code (via
10019 Qvendor_specific_keysyms below), since these are not traced
10020 via terminals but only through all_kboards. */
10021 terminal->kboard->next_kboard = all_kboards;
10022 all_kboards = terminal->kboard;
10023
10024 if (!EQ (XSYMBOL (Qvendor_specific_keysyms)->function, Qunbound))
10025 {
10026 char *vendor = ServerVendor (dpy);
10027
10028 /* Protect terminal from GC before removing it from the
10029 list of terminals. */
10030 struct gcpro gcpro1;
10031 Lisp_Object gcpro_term;
10032 XSETTERMINAL (gcpro_term, terminal);
10033 GCPRO1 (gcpro_term);
10034
10035 /* Temporarily hide the partially initialized terminal. */
10036 terminal_list = terminal->next_terminal;
10037 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
10038 terminal->kboard->Vsystem_key_alist
10039 = call1 (Qvendor_specific_keysyms,
10040 vendor ? build_string (vendor) : empty_unibyte_string);
10041 BLOCK_INPUT;
10042 terminal->next_terminal = terminal_list;
10043 terminal_list = terminal;
10044 UNGCPRO;
10045 }
10046
10047 /* Don't let the initial kboard remain current longer than necessary.
10048 That would cause problems if a file loaded on startup tries to
10049 prompt in the mini-buffer. */
10050 if (current_kboard == initial_kboard)
10051 current_kboard = terminal->kboard;
10052 }
10053 terminal->kboard->reference_count++;
10054 }
10055
10056 /* Put this display on the chain. */
10057 dpyinfo->next = x_display_list;
10058 x_display_list = dpyinfo;
10059
10060 /* Put it on x_display_name_list as well, to keep them parallel. */
10061 x_display_name_list = Fcons (Fcons (display_name, Qnil),
10062 x_display_name_list);
10063 dpyinfo->name_list_element = XCAR (x_display_name_list);
10064
10065 dpyinfo->display = dpy;
10066
10067 /* Set the name of the terminal. */
10068 terminal->name = (char *) xmalloc (SBYTES (display_name) + 1);
10069 strncpy (terminal->name, SSDATA (display_name), SBYTES (display_name));
10070 terminal->name[SBYTES (display_name)] = 0;
10071
10072 #if 0
10073 XSetAfterFunction (x_current_display, x_trace_wire);
10074 #endif /* ! 0 */
10075
10076 dpyinfo->x_id_name
10077 = (char *) xmalloc (SBYTES (Vinvocation_name)
10078 + SBYTES (Vsystem_name)
10079 + 2);
10080 sprintf (dpyinfo->x_id_name, "%s@%s",
10081 SDATA (Vinvocation_name), SDATA (Vsystem_name));
10082
10083 /* Figure out which modifier bits mean what. */
10084 x_find_modifier_meanings (dpyinfo);
10085
10086 /* Get the scroll bar cursor. */
10087 #ifdef USE_GTK
10088 /* We must create a GTK cursor, it is required for GTK widgets. */
10089 dpyinfo->xg_cursor = xg_create_default_cursor (dpyinfo->display);
10090 #endif /* USE_GTK */
10091
10092 dpyinfo->vertical_scroll_bar_cursor
10093 = XCreateFontCursor (dpyinfo->display, XC_sb_v_double_arrow);
10094
10095 xrdb = x_load_resources (dpyinfo->display, xrm_option,
10096 resource_name, EMACS_CLASS);
10097 #ifdef HAVE_XRMSETDATABASE
10098 XrmSetDatabase (dpyinfo->display, xrdb);
10099 #else
10100 dpyinfo->display->db = xrdb;
10101 #endif
10102 /* Put the rdb where we can find it in a way that works on
10103 all versions. */
10104 dpyinfo->xrdb = xrdb;
10105
10106 dpyinfo->screen = ScreenOfDisplay (dpyinfo->display,
10107 DefaultScreen (dpyinfo->display));
10108 select_visual (dpyinfo);
10109 dpyinfo->cmap = DefaultColormapOfScreen (dpyinfo->screen);
10110 dpyinfo->root_window = RootWindowOfScreen (dpyinfo->screen);
10111 dpyinfo->client_leader_window = 0;
10112 dpyinfo->grabbed = 0;
10113 dpyinfo->reference_count = 0;
10114 dpyinfo->icon_bitmap_id = -1;
10115 dpyinfo->n_fonts = 0;
10116 dpyinfo->bitmaps = 0;
10117 dpyinfo->bitmaps_size = 0;
10118 dpyinfo->bitmaps_last = 0;
10119 dpyinfo->scratch_cursor_gc = 0;
10120 hlinfo->mouse_face_mouse_frame = 0;
10121 hlinfo->mouse_face_deferred_gc = 0;
10122 hlinfo->mouse_face_beg_row = hlinfo->mouse_face_beg_col = -1;
10123 hlinfo->mouse_face_end_row = hlinfo->mouse_face_end_col = -1;
10124 hlinfo->mouse_face_face_id = DEFAULT_FACE_ID;
10125 hlinfo->mouse_face_window = Qnil;
10126 hlinfo->mouse_face_overlay = Qnil;
10127 hlinfo->mouse_face_mouse_x = hlinfo->mouse_face_mouse_y = 0;
10128 hlinfo->mouse_face_defer = 0;
10129 hlinfo->mouse_face_hidden = 0;
10130 dpyinfo->x_focus_frame = 0;
10131 dpyinfo->x_focus_event_frame = 0;
10132 dpyinfo->x_highlight_frame = 0;
10133 dpyinfo->wm_type = X_WMTYPE_UNKNOWN;
10134
10135 /* See if we can construct pixel values from RGB values. */
10136 dpyinfo->red_bits = dpyinfo->blue_bits = dpyinfo->green_bits = 0;
10137 dpyinfo->red_offset = dpyinfo->blue_offset = dpyinfo->green_offset = 0;
10138
10139 if (dpyinfo->visual->class == TrueColor)
10140 {
10141 get_bits_and_offset (dpyinfo->visual->red_mask,
10142 &dpyinfo->red_bits, &dpyinfo->red_offset);
10143 get_bits_and_offset (dpyinfo->visual->blue_mask,
10144 &dpyinfo->blue_bits, &dpyinfo->blue_offset);
10145 get_bits_and_offset (dpyinfo->visual->green_mask,
10146 &dpyinfo->green_bits, &dpyinfo->green_offset);
10147 }
10148
10149 /* See if a private colormap is requested. */
10150 if (dpyinfo->visual == DefaultVisualOfScreen (dpyinfo->screen))
10151 {
10152 if (dpyinfo->visual->class == PseudoColor)
10153 {
10154 Lisp_Object value;
10155 value = display_x_get_resource (dpyinfo,
10156 build_string ("privateColormap"),
10157 build_string ("PrivateColormap"),
10158 Qnil, Qnil);
10159 if (STRINGP (value)
10160 && (!strcmp (SSDATA (value), "true")
10161 || !strcmp (SSDATA (value), "on")))
10162 dpyinfo->cmap = XCopyColormapAndFree (dpyinfo->display, dpyinfo->cmap);
10163 }
10164 }
10165 else
10166 dpyinfo->cmap = XCreateColormap (dpyinfo->display, dpyinfo->root_window,
10167 dpyinfo->visual, AllocNone);
10168
10169 #ifdef HAVE_XFT
10170 {
10171 /* If we are using Xft, check dpi value in X resources.
10172 It is better we use it as well, since Xft will use it, as will all
10173 Gnome applications. If our real DPI is smaller or larger than the
10174 one Xft uses, our font will look smaller or larger than other
10175 for other applications, even if it is the same font name (monospace-10
10176 for example). */
10177 char *v = XGetDefault (dpyinfo->display, "Xft", "dpi");
10178 double d;
10179 if (v != NULL && sscanf (v, "%lf", &d) == 1)
10180 dpyinfo->resy = dpyinfo->resx = d;
10181 }
10182 #endif
10183
10184 if (dpyinfo->resy < 1)
10185 {
10186 int screen_number = XScreenNumberOfScreen (dpyinfo->screen);
10187 double pixels = DisplayHeight (dpyinfo->display, screen_number);
10188 double mm = DisplayHeightMM (dpyinfo->display, screen_number);
10189 /* Mac OS X 10.3's Xserver sometimes reports 0.0mm. */
10190 dpyinfo->resy = (mm < 1) ? 100 : pixels * 25.4 / mm;
10191 pixels = DisplayWidth (dpyinfo->display, screen_number);
10192 mm = DisplayWidthMM (dpyinfo->display, screen_number);
10193 /* Mac OS X 10.3's Xserver sometimes reports 0.0mm. */
10194 dpyinfo->resx = (mm < 1) ? 100 : pixels * 25.4 / mm;
10195 }
10196
10197 {
10198 const struct
10199 {
10200 const char *name;
10201 Atom *atom;
10202 } atom_refs[] = {
10203 { "WM_PROTOCOLS", &dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_protocols },
10204 { "WM_TAKE_FOCUS", &dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_take_focus },
10205 { "WM_SAVE_YOURSELF", &dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_save_yourself },
10206 { "WM_DELETE_WINDOW", &dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_delete_window },
10207 { "WM_CHANGE_STATE", &dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_change_state },
10208 { "WM_CONFIGURE_DENIED", &dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_configure_denied },
10209 { "WM_MOVED", &dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_window_moved },
10210 { "WM_CLIENT_LEADER", &dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_client_leader },
10211 { "Editres", &dpyinfo->Xatom_editres },
10212 { "CLIPBOARD", &dpyinfo->Xatom_CLIPBOARD },
10213 { "TIMESTAMP", &dpyinfo->Xatom_TIMESTAMP },
10214 { "TEXT", &dpyinfo->Xatom_TEXT },
10215 { "COMPOUND_TEXT", &dpyinfo->Xatom_COMPOUND_TEXT },
10216 { "UTF8_STRING", &dpyinfo->Xatom_UTF8_STRING },
10217 { "DELETE", &dpyinfo->Xatom_DELETE },
10218 { "MULTIPLE", &dpyinfo->Xatom_MULTIPLE },
10219 { "INCR", &dpyinfo->Xatom_INCR },
10220 { "_EMACS_TMP_", &dpyinfo->Xatom_EMACS_TMP },
10221 { "TARGETS", &dpyinfo->Xatom_TARGETS },
10222 { "NULL", &dpyinfo->Xatom_NULL },
10223 { "ATOM_PAIR", &dpyinfo->Xatom_ATOM_PAIR },
10224 { "_XEMBED_INFO", &dpyinfo->Xatom_XEMBED_INFO },
10225 /* For properties of font. */
10226 { "PIXEL_SIZE", &dpyinfo->Xatom_PIXEL_SIZE },
10227 { "AVERAGE_WIDTH", &dpyinfo->Xatom_AVERAGE_WIDTH },
10228 { "_MULE_BASELINE_OFFSET", &dpyinfo->Xatom_MULE_BASELINE_OFFSET },
10229 { "_MULE_RELATIVE_COMPOSE", &dpyinfo->Xatom_MULE_RELATIVE_COMPOSE },
10230 { "_MULE_DEFAULT_ASCENT", &dpyinfo->Xatom_MULE_DEFAULT_ASCENT },
10231 /* Ghostscript support. */
10232 { "DONE", &dpyinfo->Xatom_DONE },
10233 { "PAGE", &dpyinfo->Xatom_PAGE },
10234 { "SCROLLBAR", &dpyinfo->Xatom_Scrollbar },
10235 { "_XEMBED", &dpyinfo->Xatom_XEMBED },
10236 /* EWMH */
10237 { "_NET_WM_STATE", &dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state },
10238 { "_NET_WM_STATE_FULLSCREEN", &dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_fullscreen },
10239 { "_NET_WM_STATE_MAXIMIZED_HORZ",
10240 &dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_maximized_horz },
10241 { "_NET_WM_STATE_MAXIMIZED_VERT",
10242 &dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_maximized_vert },
10243 { "_NET_WM_STATE_STICKY", &dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_sticky },
10244 { "_NET_WM_WINDOW_TYPE", &dpyinfo->Xatom_net_window_type },
10245 { "_NET_WM_WINDOW_TYPE_TOOLTIP",
10246 &dpyinfo->Xatom_net_window_type_tooltip },
10247 { "_NET_WM_ICON_NAME", &dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_icon_name },
10248 { "_NET_WM_NAME", &dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_name },
10249 { "_NET_SUPPORTED", &dpyinfo->Xatom_net_supported },
10250 { "_NET_SUPPORTING_WM_CHECK", &dpyinfo->Xatom_net_supporting_wm_check },
10251 { "_NET_WM_WINDOW_OPACITY", &dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_window_opacity },
10252 { "_NET_ACTIVE_WINDOW", &dpyinfo->Xatom_net_active_window },
10253 { "_NET_FRAME_EXTENTS", &dpyinfo->Xatom_net_frame_extents },
10254 /* Session management */
10255 { "SM_CLIENT_ID", &dpyinfo->Xatom_SM_CLIENT_ID },
10256 { "_XSETTINGS_SETTINGS", &dpyinfo->Xatom_xsettings_prop },
10257 { "MANAGER", &dpyinfo->Xatom_xsettings_mgr },
10258 };
10259
10260 int i;
10261 const int atom_count = sizeof (atom_refs) / sizeof (atom_refs[0]);
10262 /* 1 for _XSETTINGS_SN */
10263 const int total_atom_count = 1 + atom_count;
10264 Atom *atoms_return = xmalloc (sizeof (Atom) * total_atom_count);
10265 char **atom_names = xmalloc (sizeof (char *) * total_atom_count);
10266 char xsettings_atom_name[64];
10267
10268 for (i = 0; i < atom_count; i++)
10269 atom_names[i] = (char *) atom_refs[i].name;
10270
10271 /* Build _XSETTINGS_SN atom name */
10272 snprintf (xsettings_atom_name, sizeof (xsettings_atom_name),
10273 "_XSETTINGS_S%d", XScreenNumberOfScreen (dpyinfo->screen));
10274 atom_names[i] = xsettings_atom_name;
10275
10276 XInternAtoms (dpyinfo->display, atom_names, total_atom_count,
10277 False, atoms_return);
10278
10279 for (i = 0; i < atom_count; i++)
10280 *atom_refs[i].atom = atoms_return[i];
10281
10282 /* Manual copy of last atom */
10283 dpyinfo->Xatom_xsettings_sel = atoms_return[i];
10284
10285 xfree (atom_names);
10286 xfree (atoms_return);
10287 }
10288
10289 dpyinfo->x_dnd_atoms_size = 8;
10290 dpyinfo->x_dnd_atoms_length = 0;
10291 dpyinfo->x_dnd_atoms = xmalloc (sizeof (*dpyinfo->x_dnd_atoms)
10292 * dpyinfo->x_dnd_atoms_size);
10293
10294 dpyinfo->net_supported_atoms = NULL;
10295 dpyinfo->nr_net_supported_atoms = 0;
10296 dpyinfo->net_supported_window = 0;
10297
10298 connection = ConnectionNumber (dpyinfo->display);
10299 dpyinfo->connection = connection;
10300
10301 {
10302 dpyinfo->gray
10303 = XCreatePixmapFromBitmapData (dpyinfo->display, dpyinfo->root_window,
10304 gray_bitmap_bits,
10305 gray_bitmap_width, gray_bitmap_height,
10306 (unsigned long) 1, (unsigned long) 0, 1);
10307 }
10308
10309 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
10310 xim_initialize (dpyinfo, resource_name);
10311 #endif
10312
10313 xsettings_initialize (dpyinfo);
10314
10315 /* This is only needed for distinguishing keyboard and process input. */
10316 if (connection != 0)
10317 add_keyboard_wait_descriptor (connection);
10318
10319 #ifdef F_SETOWN
10320 fcntl (connection, F_SETOWN, getpid ());
10321 #endif /* ! defined (F_SETOWN) */
10322
10323 #ifdef SIGIO
10324 if (interrupt_input)
10325 init_sigio (connection);
10326 #endif /* ! defined (SIGIO) */
10327
10328 #ifdef USE_LUCID
10329 {
10330 Display *dpy = dpyinfo->display;
10331 XrmValue d, fr, to;
10332 Font font;
10333
10334 d.addr = (XPointer)&dpy;
10335 d.size = sizeof (Display *);
10336 fr.addr = XtDefaultFont;
10337 fr.size = sizeof (XtDefaultFont);
10338 to.size = sizeof (Font *);
10339 to.addr = (XPointer)&font;
10340 x_catch_errors (dpy);
10341 if (!XtCallConverter (dpy, XtCvtStringToFont, &d, 1, &fr, &to, NULL))
10342 abort ();
10343 if (x_had_errors_p (dpy) || !XQueryFont (dpy, font))
10344 XrmPutLineResource (&xrdb, "Emacs.dialog.*.font: 9x15");
10345 x_uncatch_errors ();
10346 }
10347 #endif
10348
10349 /* See if we should run in synchronous mode. This is useful
10350 for debugging X code. */
10351 {
10352 Lisp_Object value;
10353 value = display_x_get_resource (dpyinfo,
10354 build_string ("synchronous"),
10355 build_string ("Synchronous"),
10356 Qnil, Qnil);
10357 if (STRINGP (value)
10358 && (!strcmp (SSDATA (value), "true")
10359 || !strcmp (SSDATA (value), "on")))
10360 XSynchronize (dpyinfo->display, True);
10361 }
10362
10363 {
10364 Lisp_Object value;
10365 value = display_x_get_resource (dpyinfo,
10366 build_string ("useXIM"),
10367 build_string ("UseXIM"),
10368 Qnil, Qnil);
10369 #ifdef USE_XIM
10370 if (STRINGP (value)
10371 && (!strcmp (SSDATA (value), "false")
10372 || !strcmp (SSDATA (value), "off")))
10373 use_xim = 0;
10374 #else
10375 if (STRINGP (value)
10376 && (!strcmp (SSDATA (value), "true")
10377 || !strcmp (SSDATA (value), "on")))
10378 use_xim = 1;
10379 #endif
10380 }
10381
10382 #ifdef HAVE_X_SM
10383 /* Only do this for the very first display in the Emacs session.
10384 Ignore X session management when Emacs was first started on a
10385 tty. */
10386 if (terminal->id == 1)
10387 x_session_initialize (dpyinfo);
10388 #endif
10389
10390 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
10391
10392 return dpyinfo;
10393 }
10394 \f
10395 /* Get rid of display DPYINFO, deleting all frames on it,
10396 and without sending any more commands to the X server. */
10397
10398 void
10399 x_delete_display (struct x_display_info *dpyinfo)
10400 {
10401 struct terminal *t;
10402
10403 /* Close all frames and delete the generic struct terminal for this
10404 X display. */
10405 for (t = terminal_list; t; t = t->next_terminal)
10406 if (t->type == output_x_window && t->display_info.x == dpyinfo)
10407 {
10408 #ifdef HAVE_X_SM
10409 /* Close X session management when we close its display. */
10410 if (t->id == 1 && x_session_have_connection ())
10411 x_session_close ();
10412 #endif
10413 delete_terminal (t);
10414 break;
10415 }
10416
10417 delete_keyboard_wait_descriptor (dpyinfo->connection);
10418
10419 /* Discard this display from x_display_name_list and x_display_list.
10420 We can't use Fdelq because that can quit. */
10421 if (! NILP (x_display_name_list)
10422 && EQ (XCAR (x_display_name_list), dpyinfo->name_list_element))
10423 x_display_name_list = XCDR (x_display_name_list);
10424 else
10425 {
10426 Lisp_Object tail;
10427
10428 tail = x_display_name_list;
10429 while (CONSP (tail) && CONSP (XCDR (tail)))
10430 {
10431 if (EQ (XCAR (XCDR (tail)), dpyinfo->name_list_element))
10432 {
10433 XSETCDR (tail, XCDR (XCDR (tail)));
10434 break;
10435 }
10436 tail = XCDR (tail);
10437 }
10438 }
10439
10440 if (next_noop_dpyinfo == dpyinfo)
10441 next_noop_dpyinfo = dpyinfo->next;
10442
10443 if (x_display_list == dpyinfo)
10444 x_display_list = dpyinfo->next;
10445 else
10446 {
10447 struct x_display_info *tail;
10448
10449 for (tail = x_display_list; tail; tail = tail->next)
10450 if (tail->next == dpyinfo)
10451 tail->next = tail->next->next;
10452 }
10453
10454 xfree (dpyinfo->x_id_name);
10455 xfree (dpyinfo->x_dnd_atoms);
10456 xfree (dpyinfo->color_cells);
10457 xfree (dpyinfo);
10458 }
10459
10460 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
10461
10462 /* Atimer callback function for TIMER. Called every 0.1s to process
10463 Xt timeouts, if needed. We must avoid calling XtAppPending as
10464 much as possible because that function does an implicit XFlush
10465 that slows us down. */
10466
10467 static void
10468 x_process_timeouts (struct atimer *timer)
10469 {
10470 BLOCK_INPUT;
10471 x_timeout_atimer_activated_flag = 0;
10472 if (toolkit_scroll_bar_interaction || popup_activated ())
10473 {
10474 while (XtAppPending (Xt_app_con) & XtIMTimer)
10475 XtAppProcessEvent (Xt_app_con, XtIMTimer);
10476 /* Reactivate the atimer for next time. */
10477 x_activate_timeout_atimer ();
10478 }
10479 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
10480 }
10481
10482 /* Install an asynchronous timer that processes Xt timeout events
10483 every 0.1s as long as either `toolkit_scroll_bar_interaction' or
10484 `popup_activated_flag' (in xmenu.c) is set. Make sure to call this
10485 function whenever these variables are set. This is necessary
10486 because some widget sets use timeouts internally, for example the
10487 LessTif menu bar, or the Xaw3d scroll bar. When Xt timeouts aren't
10488 processed, these widgets don't behave normally. */
10489
10490 void
10491 x_activate_timeout_atimer (void)
10492 {
10493 BLOCK_INPUT;
10494 if (!x_timeout_atimer_activated_flag)
10495 {
10496 EMACS_TIME interval;
10497
10498 EMACS_SET_SECS_USECS (interval, 0, 100000);
10499 start_atimer (ATIMER_RELATIVE, interval, x_process_timeouts, 0);
10500 x_timeout_atimer_activated_flag = 1;
10501 }
10502 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
10503 }
10504
10505 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
10506
10507 \f
10508 /* Set up use of X before we make the first connection. */
10509
10510 extern frame_parm_handler x_frame_parm_handlers[];
10511
10512 static struct redisplay_interface x_redisplay_interface =
10513 {
10514 x_frame_parm_handlers,
10515 x_produce_glyphs,
10516 x_write_glyphs,
10517 x_insert_glyphs,
10518 x_clear_end_of_line,
10519 x_scroll_run,
10520 x_after_update_window_line,
10521 x_update_window_begin,
10522 x_update_window_end,
10523 x_cursor_to,
10524 x_flush,
10525 #ifdef XFlush
10526 x_flush,
10527 #else
10528 0, /* flush_display_optional */
10529 #endif
10530 x_clear_window_mouse_face,
10531 x_get_glyph_overhangs,
10532 x_fix_overlapping_area,
10533 x_draw_fringe_bitmap,
10534 0, /* define_fringe_bitmap */
10535 0, /* destroy_fringe_bitmap */
10536 x_compute_glyph_string_overhangs,
10537 x_draw_glyph_string,
10538 x_define_frame_cursor,
10539 x_clear_frame_area,
10540 x_draw_window_cursor,
10541 x_draw_vertical_window_border,
10542 x_shift_glyphs_for_insert
10543 };
10544
10545
10546 /* This function is called when the last frame on a display is deleted. */
10547 void
10548 x_delete_terminal (struct terminal *terminal)
10549 {
10550 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = terminal->display_info.x;
10551
10552 /* Protect against recursive calls. delete_frame in
10553 delete_terminal calls us back when it deletes our last frame. */
10554 if (!terminal->name)
10555 return;
10556
10557 BLOCK_INPUT;
10558 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
10559 /* We must close our connection to the XIM server before closing the
10560 X display. */
10561 if (dpyinfo->xim)
10562 xim_close_dpy (dpyinfo);
10563 #endif
10564
10565 /* If called from x_connection_closed, the display may already be closed
10566 and dpyinfo->display was set to 0 to indicate that. */
10567 if (dpyinfo->display)
10568 {
10569 x_destroy_all_bitmaps (dpyinfo);
10570 XSetCloseDownMode (dpyinfo->display, DestroyAll);
10571
10572 /* Whether or not XCloseDisplay destroys the associated resource
10573 database depends on the version of libX11. To avoid both
10574 crash and memory leak, we dissociate the database from the
10575 display and then destroy dpyinfo->xrdb ourselves.
10576
10577 Unfortunately, the above strategy does not work in some
10578 situations due to a bug in newer versions of libX11: because
10579 XrmSetDatabase doesn't clear the flag XlibDisplayDfltRMDB if
10580 dpy->db is NULL, XCloseDisplay destroys the associated
10581 database whereas it has not been created by XGetDefault
10582 (Bug#21974 in freedesktop.org Bugzilla). As a workaround, we
10583 don't destroy the database here in order to avoid the crash
10584 in the above situations for now, though that may cause memory
10585 leaks in other situations. */
10586 #if 0
10587 #ifdef HAVE_XRMSETDATABASE
10588 XrmSetDatabase (dpyinfo->display, NULL);
10589 #else
10590 dpyinfo->display->db = NULL;
10591 #endif
10592 /* We used to call XrmDestroyDatabase from x_delete_display, but
10593 some older versions of libX11 crash if we call it after
10594 closing all the displays. */
10595 XrmDestroyDatabase (dpyinfo->xrdb);
10596 #endif
10597
10598 #ifdef USE_GTK
10599 xg_display_close (dpyinfo->display);
10600 #else
10601 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
10602 XtCloseDisplay (dpyinfo->display);
10603 #else
10604 XCloseDisplay (dpyinfo->display);
10605 #endif
10606 #endif /* ! USE_GTK */
10607 }
10608
10609 /* Mark as dead. */
10610 dpyinfo->display = NULL;
10611 x_delete_display (dpyinfo);
10612 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
10613 }
10614
10615 /* Create a struct terminal, initialize it with the X11 specific
10616 functions and make DISPLAY->TERMINAL point to it. */
10617
10618 static struct terminal *
10619 x_create_terminal (struct x_display_info *dpyinfo)
10620 {
10621 struct terminal *terminal;
10622
10623 terminal = create_terminal ();
10624
10625 terminal->type = output_x_window;
10626 terminal->display_info.x = dpyinfo;
10627 dpyinfo->terminal = terminal;
10628
10629 /* kboard is initialized in x_term_init. */
10630
10631 terminal->clear_frame_hook = x_clear_frame;
10632 terminal->ins_del_lines_hook = x_ins_del_lines;
10633 terminal->delete_glyphs_hook = x_delete_glyphs;
10634 terminal->ring_bell_hook = XTring_bell;
10635 terminal->toggle_invisible_pointer_hook = XTtoggle_invisible_pointer;
10636 terminal->reset_terminal_modes_hook = XTreset_terminal_modes;
10637 terminal->set_terminal_modes_hook = XTset_terminal_modes;
10638 terminal->update_begin_hook = x_update_begin;
10639 terminal->update_end_hook = x_update_end;
10640 terminal->set_terminal_window_hook = XTset_terminal_window;
10641 terminal->read_socket_hook = XTread_socket;
10642 terminal->frame_up_to_date_hook = XTframe_up_to_date;
10643 terminal->mouse_position_hook = XTmouse_position;
10644 terminal->frame_rehighlight_hook = XTframe_rehighlight;
10645 terminal->frame_raise_lower_hook = XTframe_raise_lower;
10646 terminal->fullscreen_hook = XTfullscreen_hook;
10647 terminal->set_vertical_scroll_bar_hook = XTset_vertical_scroll_bar;
10648 terminal->condemn_scroll_bars_hook = XTcondemn_scroll_bars;
10649 terminal->redeem_scroll_bar_hook = XTredeem_scroll_bar;
10650 terminal->judge_scroll_bars_hook = XTjudge_scroll_bars;
10651
10652 terminal->delete_frame_hook = x_destroy_window;
10653 terminal->delete_terminal_hook = x_delete_terminal;
10654
10655 terminal->rif = &x_redisplay_interface;
10656 terminal->scroll_region_ok = 1; /* We'll scroll partial frames. */
10657 terminal->char_ins_del_ok = 1;
10658 terminal->line_ins_del_ok = 1; /* We'll just blt 'em. */
10659 terminal->fast_clear_end_of_line = 1; /* X does this well. */
10660 terminal->memory_below_frame = 0; /* We don't remember what scrolls
10661 off the bottom. */
10662
10663 return terminal;
10664 }
10665
10666 void
10667 x_initialize (void)
10668 {
10669 baud_rate = 19200;
10670
10671 x_noop_count = 0;
10672 last_tool_bar_item = -1;
10673 any_help_event_p = 0;
10674 ignore_next_mouse_click_timeout = 0;
10675 #ifdef HAVE_X_SM
10676 x_session_initialized = 0;
10677 #endif
10678
10679 #ifdef USE_GTK
10680 current_count = -1;
10681 #endif
10682
10683 /* Try to use interrupt input; if we can't, then start polling. */
10684 Fset_input_interrupt_mode (Qt);
10685
10686 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
10687 XtToolkitInitialize ();
10688
10689 Xt_app_con = XtCreateApplicationContext ();
10690
10691 /* Register a converter from strings to pixels, which uses
10692 Emacs' color allocation infrastructure. */
10693 XtAppSetTypeConverter (Xt_app_con,
10694 XtRString, XtRPixel, cvt_string_to_pixel,
10695 cvt_string_to_pixel_args,
10696 XtNumber (cvt_string_to_pixel_args),
10697 XtCacheByDisplay, cvt_pixel_dtor);
10698
10699 XtAppSetFallbackResources (Xt_app_con, Xt_default_resources);
10700 #endif
10701
10702 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
10703 #ifndef USE_GTK
10704 xaw3d_arrow_scroll = False;
10705 xaw3d_pick_top = True;
10706 #endif
10707 #endif
10708
10709 pending_autoraise_frame = 0;
10710 pending_event_wait.f = 0;
10711 pending_event_wait.eventtype = 0;
10712
10713 /* Note that there is no real way portable across R3/R4 to get the
10714 original error handler. */
10715 XSetErrorHandler (x_error_handler);
10716 XSetIOErrorHandler (x_io_error_quitter);
10717
10718 signal (SIGPIPE, x_connection_signal);
10719
10720 xgselect_initialize ();
10721 }
10722
10723
10724 void
10725 syms_of_xterm (void)
10726 {
10727 x_error_message = NULL;
10728
10729 staticpro (&x_display_name_list);
10730 x_display_name_list = Qnil;
10731
10732 staticpro (&last_mouse_scroll_bar);
10733 last_mouse_scroll_bar = Qnil;
10734
10735 staticpro (&Qvendor_specific_keysyms);
10736 Qvendor_specific_keysyms = intern_c_string ("vendor-specific-keysyms");
10737
10738 staticpro (&Qlatin_1);
10739 Qlatin_1 = intern_c_string ("latin-1");
10740
10741 staticpro (&last_mouse_press_frame);
10742 last_mouse_press_frame = Qnil;
10743
10744 #ifdef USE_GTK
10745 xg_default_icon_file = make_pure_c_string ("icons/hicolor/scalable/apps/emacs.svg");
10746 staticpro (&xg_default_icon_file);
10747
10748 Qx_gtk_map_stock = intern_c_string ("x-gtk-map-stock");
10749 staticpro (&Qx_gtk_map_stock);
10750 #endif
10751
10752 DEFVAR_BOOL ("x-use-underline-position-properties",
10753 x_use_underline_position_properties,
10754 doc: /* *Non-nil means make use of UNDERLINE_POSITION font properties.
10755 A value of nil means ignore them. If you encounter fonts with bogus
10756 UNDERLINE_POSITION font properties, for example 7x13 on XFree prior
10757 to 4.1, set this to nil. You can also use `underline-minimum-offset'
10758 to override the font's UNDERLINE_POSITION for small font display
10759 sizes. */);
10760 x_use_underline_position_properties = 1;
10761
10762 DEFVAR_BOOL ("x-underline-at-descent-line",
10763 x_underline_at_descent_line,
10764 doc: /* *Non-nil means to draw the underline at the same place as the descent line.
10765 A value of nil means to draw the underline according to the value of the
10766 variable `x-use-underline-position-properties', which is usually at the
10767 baseline level. The default value is nil. */);
10768 x_underline_at_descent_line = 0;
10769
10770 DEFVAR_BOOL ("x-mouse-click-focus-ignore-position",
10771 x_mouse_click_focus_ignore_position,
10772 doc: /* Non-nil means that a mouse click to focus a frame does not move point.
10773 This variable is only used when the window manager requires that you
10774 click on a frame to select it (give it focus). In that case, a value
10775 of nil, means that the selected window and cursor position changes to
10776 reflect the mouse click position, while a non-nil value means that the
10777 selected window or cursor position is preserved. */);
10778 x_mouse_click_focus_ignore_position = 0;
10779
10780 DEFVAR_LISP ("x-toolkit-scroll-bars", Vx_toolkit_scroll_bars,
10781 doc: /* Which toolkit scroll bars Emacs uses, if any.
10782 A value of nil means Emacs doesn't use toolkit scroll bars.
10783 With the X Window system, the value is a symbol describing the
10784 X toolkit. Possible values are: gtk, motif, xaw, or xaw3d.
10785 With MS Windows, the value is t. */);
10786 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
10787 #ifdef USE_MOTIF
10788 Vx_toolkit_scroll_bars = intern_c_string ("motif");
10789 #elif defined HAVE_XAW3D
10790 Vx_toolkit_scroll_bars = intern_c_string ("xaw3d");
10791 #elif USE_GTK
10792 Vx_toolkit_scroll_bars = intern_c_string ("gtk");
10793 #else
10794 Vx_toolkit_scroll_bars = intern_c_string ("xaw");
10795 #endif
10796 #else
10797 Vx_toolkit_scroll_bars = Qnil;
10798 #endif
10799
10800 staticpro (&last_mouse_motion_frame);
10801 last_mouse_motion_frame = Qnil;
10802
10803 Qmodifier_value = intern_c_string ("modifier-value");
10804 Qalt = intern_c_string ("alt");
10805 Fput (Qalt, Qmodifier_value, make_number (alt_modifier));
10806 Qhyper = intern_c_string ("hyper");
10807 Fput (Qhyper, Qmodifier_value, make_number (hyper_modifier));
10808 Qmeta = intern_c_string ("meta");
10809 Fput (Qmeta, Qmodifier_value, make_number (meta_modifier));
10810 Qsuper = intern_c_string ("super");
10811 Fput (Qsuper, Qmodifier_value, make_number (super_modifier));
10812
10813 DEFVAR_LISP ("x-alt-keysym", Vx_alt_keysym,
10814 doc: /* Which keys Emacs uses for the alt modifier.
10815 This should be one of the symbols `alt', `hyper', `meta', `super'.
10816 For example, `alt' means use the Alt_L and Alt_R keysyms. The default
10817 is nil, which is the same as `alt'. */);
10818 Vx_alt_keysym = Qnil;
10819
10820 DEFVAR_LISP ("x-hyper-keysym", Vx_hyper_keysym,
10821 doc: /* Which keys Emacs uses for the hyper modifier.
10822 This should be one of the symbols `alt', `hyper', `meta', `super'.
10823 For example, `hyper' means use the Hyper_L and Hyper_R keysyms. The
10824 default is nil, which is the same as `hyper'. */);
10825 Vx_hyper_keysym = Qnil;
10826
10827 DEFVAR_LISP ("x-meta-keysym", Vx_meta_keysym,
10828 doc: /* Which keys Emacs uses for the meta modifier.
10829 This should be one of the symbols `alt', `hyper', `meta', `super'.
10830 For example, `meta' means use the Meta_L and Meta_R keysyms. The
10831 default is nil, which is the same as `meta'. */);
10832 Vx_meta_keysym = Qnil;
10833
10834 DEFVAR_LISP ("x-super-keysym", Vx_super_keysym,
10835 doc: /* Which keys Emacs uses for the super modifier.
10836 This should be one of the symbols `alt', `hyper', `meta', `super'.
10837 For example, `super' means use the Super_L and Super_R keysyms. The
10838 default is nil, which is the same as `super'. */);
10839 Vx_super_keysym = Qnil;
10840
10841 DEFVAR_LISP ("x-keysym-table", Vx_keysym_table,
10842 doc: /* Hash table of character codes indexed by X keysym codes. */);
10843 Vx_keysym_table = make_hash_table (Qeql, make_number (900),
10844 make_float (DEFAULT_REHASH_SIZE),
10845 make_float (DEFAULT_REHASH_THRESHOLD),
10846 Qnil, Qnil, Qnil);
10847 }
10848
10849 #endif /* HAVE_X_WINDOWS */